[Title 21 CFR 101]
[Code of Federal Regulations (annual edition) - April 1, 1996 Edition]
[Title 21 - FOOD AND DRUGS]
[Chapter I - FOOD AND DRUG ADMINISTRATION, DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES--CONTINUED]
[Subchapter B - FOOD FOR HUMAN CONSUMPTION]
[Part 101 - FOOD LABELING]
[From the U.S. Government Publishing Office]




  21
  FOOD AND DRUGS
  2
  1996-04-01
  1996-04-01
  false
  FOOD LABELING
  101
  PART 101
  
    FOOD AND DRUGS
    FOOD AND DRUG ADMINISTRATION, DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES--CONTINUED
    FOOD FOR HUMAN CONSUMPTION
  


PART 101--FOOD LABELING--Table of Contents




                      Subpart A--General Provisions

Sec.
101.1  Principal display panel of package form food.
101.2  Information panel of package form food.
101.3  Identity labeling of food in packaged form.
101.4  Food; designation of ingredients.
101.5  Food; name and place of business of manufacturer, packer, or 
          distributor.
101.8  Labeling of food with number of servings.
101.9  Nutrition labeling of food.
101.10  Nutrition labeling of restaurant foods.
101.11  Saccharin and its salts; retail establishment notice.
101.12  Reference amounts customarily consumed per eating occasion.
101.13  Nutrient content claims--general principles.
101.14  Health claims: general requirements.
101.15  Food; prominence of required statements.
101.17  Food labeling warning and notice statements.
101.18  Misbranding of food.

             Subpart B--Specific Food Labeling Requirements

101.22  Foods; labeling of spices, flavorings, colorings and chemical 
          preservatives.
101.29  Labeling of kosher and kosher-style foods.
101.30  Percentage juice declaration for foods purporting to be 
          beverages that contain fruit or vegetable juice.
101.33  Label declaration of D-erythroascorbic acid when it is an 
          ingredient of a fabricated food.

   Subpart C--Specific Nutrition Labeling Requirements and Guidelines

101.36  Nutrition labeling of dietary supplements of vitamins and 
          minerals (eff. 7-5-95).
101.42  Nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish.
101.43  Substantial compliance of food retailers with the guidelines for 
          the voluntary nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and 
          fish.
101.44  Identification of the 20 most frequently consumed raw fruit, 
          vegetables, and fish in the United States.
101.45  Guidelines for the voluntary nutrition labeling of raw fruit, 
          vegetables, and fish.

      Subpart D--Specific Requirements for Nutrient Content Claims

101.54  Nutrient content claims for ``good source,'' ``high,'' and 
          ``more.''
101.56  Nutrient content claims for ``light'' or ``lite.''
101.60  Nutrient content claims for the calorie content of foods.
101.61  Nutrient content claims for the sodium content of foods.
101.62  Nutrient content claims for fat, fatty acid, and cholesterol 
          content of foods.
101.65  Implied nutrient content claims and related label statements.
101.67  Use of nutrient content claims for butter.
101.69  Petitions for nutrient content claims.

           Subpart E--Specific Requirements for Health Claims

101.70  Petitions for health claims.
101.71  Health claims: claims not authorized.
101.72  Health claims: calcium and osteoporosis.
101.73  Health claims: dietary lipids and cancer.
101.74  Health claims: sodium and hypertension.

[[Page 14]]

101.75  Health claims: dietary saturated fat and cholesterol and risk of 
          coronary heart disease.
101.76  Health claims: fiber-containing grain products, fruits, and 
          vegetables and cancer.
101.77  Health claims: fruits, vegetables, and grain products that 
          contain fiber, particularly soluble fiber, and risk of 
          coronary heart disease.
101.78  Health claims: fruits and vegetables and cancer.
101.79  Health claims: folate and neural tube defects.

Subpart F--Specific Requirements for Descriptive Claims that are Neither 
                Nutrient Content Claims nor Health Claims

101.95  ``Fresh,'' ``freshly frozen,'' ``fresh frozen,'' ``frozen 
          fresh.''

          Subpart G--Exemptions From Food Labeling Requirements

101.100  Food; exemptions from labeling.
101.103  Petitions requesting exemptions from or special requirements 
          for label declaration of ingredients.
101.105  Declaration of net quantity of contents when exempt.
101.108  Temporary exemptions for purposes of conducting authorized food 
          labeling experiments.

Appendix A to Part 101--Monier-Williams Procedure (With Modifications) 
          for Sulfites in Food, Center for Food Safety and Applied 
          Nutrition, Food and Drug Administration (November 1985)
Appendix B to Part 101--Graphic Enhancements Used by the FDA

    Authority: Secs. 4, 5, 6 of the Fair Packaging and Labeling Act (15 
U.S.C. 1453, 1454, 1455); secs. 201, 301, 402, 403, 409, 701 of the 
Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (21 U.S.C. 321, 331, 342, 343, 348, 
371).

    Source: 42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, unless otherwise noted.



                      Subpart A--General Provisions



Sec. 101.1   Principal display panel of package form food.

    The term ``principal display panel'' as it applies to food in 
package form and as used in this part, means the part of a label that is 
most likely to be displayed, presented, shown, or examined under 
customary conditions of display for retail sale. The principal display 
panel shall be large enough to accommodate all the mandatory label 
information required to be placed thereon by this part with clarity and 
conspicuousness and without obscuring design, vignettes, or crowding. 
Where packages bear alternate principal display panels, information 
required to be placed on the principal display panel shall be duplicated 
on each principal display panel. For the purpose of obtaining uniform 
type size in declaring the quantity of contents for all packages of 
substantially the same size, the term ``area of the principal display 
panel'' means the area of the side or surface that bears the principal 
display panel, which area shall be:
    (a) In the case of a rectangular package where one entire side 
properly can be considered to be the principal display panel side, the 
product of the height times the width of that side;
    (b) In the case of a cylindrical or nearly cylindrical container, 40 
percent of the product of the height of the container times the 
circumference;
    (c) In the case of any otherwise shaped container, 40 percent of the 
total surface of the container: Provided, however, That where such 
container presents an obvious ``principal display panel'' such as the 
top of a triangular or circular package of cheese, the area shall 
consist of the entire top surface. In determining the area of the 
principal display panel, exclude tops, bottoms, flanges at tops and 
bottoms of cans, and shoulders and necks of bottles or jars. In the case 
of cylindrical or nearly cylindrical containers, information required by 
this part to appear on the principal display panel shall appear within 
that 40 percent of the circumference which is most likely to be 
displayed, presented, shown, or examined under customary conditions of 
display for retail sale.



Sec. 101.2  Information panel of package form food.

    (a) The term ``information panel'' as it applies to packaged food 
means that part of the label immediately contiguous and to the right of 
the principal display panel as observed by an individual facing the 
principal display panel with the following exceptions:
    (1) If the part of the label immediately contiguous and to the right 
of the principal display panel is too small

[[Page 15]]

to accommodate the necessary information or is otherwise unusable label 
space, e.g., folded flaps or can ends, the panel immediately contiguous 
and to the right of this part of the label may be used.
    (2) If the package has one or more alternate principal display 
panels, the information panel is immediately contiguous and to the right 
of any principal display panel.
    (3) If the top of the container is the principal display panel and 
the package has no alternate principal display panel, the information 
panel is any panel adjacent to the principal display panel.
    (b) All information required to appear on the label of any package 
of food pursuant to Secs. 101.4, 101.5, 101.8, 101.9, 101.13, 101.17, 
subpart D of part 101, and part 105 of this chapter shall appear either 
on the principal display panel or on the information panel, unless 
otherwise specified by regulations in this chapter.
    (c) All information appearing on the principal display panel or the 
information panel pursuant to this section shall appear prominently and 
conspicuously, but in no case may the letters and/or numbers be less 
than one-sixteenth inch in height unless an exemption pursuant to 
paragraph (f) of this section is established. The requirements for 
conspicuousness and legibility shall include the specifications of 
Secs. 101.105(h) (1) and (2) and 101.15.
    (1) Packaged foods are exempt from the type size requirements of 
this paragraph: Provided, That:
    (i) The package is designed such that it has a surface area that can 
bear an information panel and/or an alternate principal display panel.
    (ii) The area of surface available for labeling on the principal 
display panel of the package as this term is defined in Sec. 101.1 is 
less than 10 square inches.
    (iii) The label information includes:
    (a) Nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9.
    (b) A full list of ingredients in accordance with regulations in 
this part and the policy expressed in Sec. 101.6.
    (iv) The information required by paragraph (b) of this section 
appears on the principal display panel or information panel label in 
accordance with the provisions of this paragraph (c) except that the 
type size is not less than three sixty-fourths inch in height.
    (2) Packaged foods are exempt from the type size requirements of 
this paragraph: Provided, That:
    (i) The package is designed such that it has a single ``obvious 
principal display panel'' as this term is defined in Sec. 101.1 and has 
no other available surface area for an information panel or alternate 
principal display panel.
    (ii) The area of surface available for labeling on the principal 
display panel of the package as this term is defined in Sec. 101.1 is 
less than 12 square inches and bears all labeling appearing on the 
package.
    (iii) The label information includes:
    (a) Nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9.
    (b) A full list of ingredients in accordance with regulations in 
this part and the policy expressed in Sec. 101.6.
    (iv) The information required by paragraph (b) of this section 
appears on the single, obvious principal display panel in accordance 
with the provisions of this paragraph (c) except that the type size is 
not less than one thirty-second inch in height.
    (3) Packaged foods are exempt from the type size requirements of 
this paragraph: Provided, That:
    (i) The package is designed such that it has a total surface area 
available to bear labeling of less than 12 square inches.
    (ii) The label information includes:
    (a) Nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9.
    (b) A full list of ingredients in accordance with regulations in 
this part and the policy expressed in Sec. 101.6.
    (iii) The information required by paragraph (b) of this section 
appears on the principal display panel or information panel label in 
accordance with the provisions of this paragraph (c) except that the 
type size is not less than one thirty-second inch in height.
    (4)(i) Soft drinks packaged in bottles manufactured before October 
31, 1975 shall be exempt from the requirements prescribed by this 
section to the extent that information which is blown, lithographed, or 
formed onto the surface of the bottle is exempt from the

[[Page 16]]

size and placement requirements of this section.
    (ii) Soft drinks packaged in bottles shall be exempt from the size 
and placement requirements prescribed by this section if all of the 
following conditions are met:
    (a) If the soft drink is packaged in a bottle bearing a paper, 
plastic foam jacket, or foil label, or is packaged in a nonreusable 
bottle bearing a label lithographed onto the surface of the bottle or is 
packaged in metal cans, the product shall not be exempt from any 
requirement of this section other than the exemptions created by 
Sec. 1.24(a)(5) (ii) and (v) of this chapter and the label shall bear 
all required information in the specified minimum type size, except the 
label will not be required to bear the information required by 
Sec. 101.5 if this information appears on the bottle closure or on the 
lid of the can in a type size not less than one-sixteenth inch in 
height, or if embossed on the lid of the can in a type size not less 
than one-eighth inch in height.
    (b) If the soft drink is packaged in a bottle which does not bear a 
paper, plastic foam jacket or foil label, or is packaged in a reusable 
bottle bearing a label lithographed onto the surface of the bottle:
    (1) Neither the bottle nor the closure is required to bear nutrition 
labeling in compliance with Sec. 101.9, except that any multiunit retail 
package in which it is contained shall bear nutrition labeling if 
required by Sec. 101.9; and any vending machine in which it is contained 
shall bear nutrition labeling if nutrition labeling is not present on 
the bottle or closure, if required by Sec. 101.9.
    (2) All other information pursuant to this section shall appear on 
the top of the bottle closure prominently and conspicuously in letters 
and/or numbers no less than one thirty-second inch in height, except 
that if the information required by Sec. 101.5 is placed on the side of 
the closure in accordance with Sec. 1.24(a)(5)(ii) of this chapter, such 
information shall appear in letters and/or numbers no less than one-
sixteenth inch in height.
    (3) Upon the petition of any interested person demonstrating that 
the bottle closure is too small to accommodate this information, the 
Commissioner may by regulation establish an alternative method of 
disseminating such information. Information appearing on the closure 
shall appear in the following priority:
    (i) The warning required by Sec. 100.130 of this chapter.
    (ii) The statement of ingredients.
    (iii) The name and address of the manufacturer, packer, or 
distributor.
    (iv) The statement of identity.
    (5) Individual serving-size packages of food served with meals in 
restaurants, institutions, and on board passenger carriers, and not 
intended for sale at retail, are exempt from type-size requirements of 
this paragraph, provided:
    (i) The package has a total area of 3 square inches or less 
available to bear labeling;
    (ii) There is insufficient area on the package available to print 
all required information in a type size of \1/16\ inch in height;
    (iii) The label information includes a full list of ingredients in 
accordance with regulations in this part and the policy expressed in 
Sec. 101.6 of this chapter; and
    (iv) The information required by paragraph (b) of this section 
appears on the label in accordance with the provisions of this 
paragraph, except that the type size is not less than \1/32\ inch in 
height.
    (d)(1) Except as provided by Sec. 101.9(j)(13) and (j)(17), all 
information required to appear on the principal display panel or on the 
information panel pursuant to this section shall appear on the same 
panel unless there is insufficient space. In determining the sufficiency 
of the available space, except as provided by Sec. 101.9(j)(17), any 
vignettes, designs, and other nonmandatory label information shall not 
be considered. If there is insufficient space for all of this 
information to appear on a single panel, it may be divided between these 
two panels except that the information required pursuant to any given 
section or part shall all appear on the same panel. A food whose label 
is required to bear the ingredient statement on the principal display 
panel may bear all other information specified in paragraph (b) of this 
section on the information panel.

[[Page 17]]

    (2) Any food, not otherwise exempted in this section, if packaged in 
a container consisting of a separate lid and body, and bearing nutrition 
labeling pursuant to Sec. 101.9, and if the lid qualifies for and is 
designed to serve as a principal display panel, shall be exempt from the 
placement requirements of this section in the following respects:
    (i) The name and place of business information required by 
Sec. 101.5 shall not be required on the body of the container if this 
information appears on the lid in accordance with this section.
    (ii) The nutrition information required by Sec. 101.9 shall not be 
required on the lid if this information appears on the container body in 
accordance with this section.
    (iii) The statement of ingredients required by Sec. 101.4 shall not 
be required on the lid if this information appears on the container body 
in accordance with this section. Further, the statement of ingredients 
is not required on the container body if this information appears on the 
lid in accordance with this section.
    (e) All information appearing on the information panel pursuant to 
this section shall appear in one place without other intervening 
material.
    (f) If the label of any package of food is too small to accommodate 
all of the information required by Secs. 101.4, 101.5, 101.8, 101.9, 
101.13, 101.17, subpart D of part 101, and part 105 of this chapter, the 
Commissioner may establish by regulation an acceptable alternative 
method of disseminating such information to the public, e.g., a type 
size smaller than one-sixteenth inch in height, or labeling attached to 
or inserted in the package or available at the point of purchase. A 
petition requesting such a regulation, as an amendment to this paragraph 
shall be submitted pursuant to part 10 of this chapter.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 42 FR 15673, Mar. 22, 1977; 
42 FR 45905, Sept. 13, 1977; 42 FR 47191, Sept. 20, 1977; 44 FR 16006, 
Mar. 16, 1979; 49 FR 13339, Apr. 4, 1984; 53 FR 16068, May 5, 1988; 58 
FR 44030, Aug. 18, 1993; 60 FR 17205, Apr. 5, 1995]



Sec. 101.3   Identity labeling of food in packaged form.

    (a) The principal display panel of a food in package form shall bear 
as one of its principal features a statement of the identity of the 
commodity.
    (b) Such statement of identity shall be in terms of:
    (1) The name now or hereafter specified in or required by any 
applicable Federal law or regulation; or, in the absence thereof,
    (2) The common or usual name of the food; or, in the absence 
thereof,
    (3) An appropriately descriptive term, or when the nature of the 
food is obvious, a fanciful name commonly used by the public for such 
food.
    (c) Where a food is marketed in various optional forms (whole, 
slices, diced, etc.), the particular form shall be considered to be a 
necessary part of the statement of identity and shall be declared in 
letters of a type size bearing a reasonable relation to the size of the 
letters forming the other components of the statement of identity; 
except that if the optional form is visible through the container or is 
depicted by an appropriate vignette, the particular form need not be 
included in the statement. This specification does not affect the 
required declarations of identity under definitions and standards for 
foods promulgated pursuant to section 401 of the act.
    (d) This statement of identity shall be presented in bold type on 
the principal display panel, shall be in a size reasonably related to 
the most prominent printed matter on such panel, and shall be in lines 
generally parallel to the base on which the package rests as it is 
designed to be displayed.
    (e) Under the provisions of section 403(c) of the Federal Food, 
Drug, and Cosmetic Act, a food shall be deemed to be misbranded if it is 
an imitation of another food unless its label bears, in type of uniform 
size and prominence, the word ``imitation'' and, immediately thereafter, 
the name of the food imitated.
    (1) A food shall be deemed to be an imitation and thus subject to 
the requirements of section 403(c) of the act if it is a substitute for 
and resembles another food but is nutritionally inferior to that food.

[[Page 18]]

    (2) A food that is a substitute for and resembles another food shall 
not be deemed to be an imitation provided it meets each of the following 
requirements:
    (i) It is not nutritionally inferior to the food for which it 
substitutes and which it resembles.
    (ii) Its label bears a common or usual name that complies with the 
provisions of Sec. 102.5 of this chapter and that is not false or 
misleading, or in the absence of an existing common or usual name, an 
appropriately descriptive term that is not false or misleading. The 
label may, in addition, bear a fanciful name which is not false or 
misleading.
    (3) A food for which a common or usual name is established by 
regulation (e.g., in a standard of identity pursuant to section 401 of 
the act, in a common or usual name regulation pursuant to part 102 of 
this chapter, or in a regulation establishing a nutritional quality 
guideline pursuant to part 104 of this chapter), and which complies with 
all of the applicable requirements of such regulation(s), shall not be 
deemed to be an imitation.
    (4) Nutritional inferiority includes: (i) Any reduction in the 
content of an essential nutrient that is present in a measurable amount, 
but does not include a reduction in the caloric or fat content provided 
the food is labeled pursuant to the provisions of Sec. 101.9, and 
provided the labeling with respect to any reduction in caloric content 
complies with the provisions applicable to caloric content in part 105 
of this chapter.
    (ii) For the purpose of this section, a measurable amount of an 
essential nutrient in a food shall be considered to be 2 percent or more 
of the Daily Reference Value (DRV) of protein listed under 
Sec. 101.9(c)(7)(iii) and of potassium listed under Sec. 101.9(c)(9) per 
reference amount customarily consumed and 2 percent or more of the 
Reference Daily Intake (RDI) of any vitamin or mineral listed under 
Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv) per reference amount customarily consumed, except 
that selenium, molybdenum, chromium, and chloride need not be 
considered.
    (iii) If the Commissioner concludes that a food is a substitute for 
and resembles another food but is inferior to the food imitated for 
reasons other than those set forth in this paragraph, he may propose 
appropriate revisions to this regulation or he may propose a separate 
regulation governing the particular food.
    (f) A label may be required to bear the percentage(s) of a 
characterizing ingredient(s) or information concerning the presence or 
absence of an ingredient(s) or the need to add an ingredient(s) as part 
of the common or usual name of the food pursuant to subpart B of part 
102 of this chapter.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 48 FR 10811, Mar. 15, 1983; 
58 FR 2227, Jan. 6, 1993; 60 FR 67174, Dec. 28, 1995]

    Effective Date Note: At 60 FR 67174, Dec. 28, 1995, in Sec. 101.3, 
paragraph (e)(4)(ii) was revised, effective January 1, 1997. For the 
convenience of the reader, the superseded text is set forth below.
Sec. 101.3  Identity labeling of food in packaged form.

                                * * * * *

    (e) * * *
    (4) * * *
    (ii) For the purpose of this section, a measurable amount of an 
essential nutrient in a food shall be considered to be 2 percent or more 
of the Daily Reference Value (DRV) of protein listed under 
Sec. 101.9(c)(7)(iii) and of potassium listed under Sec. 101.9(c)(9) and 
the Reference Daily Intake (RDI) of any vitamin or mineral listed under 
Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv).

                                * * * * *



Sec. 101.4   Food; designation of ingredients.

    (a)(1) Ingredients required to be declared on the label or labeling 
of a food, including foods that comply with standards of identity, 
except those ingredients exempted by Sec. 101.100, shall be listed by 
common or usual name in descending order of predominance by weight on 
either the principal display panel or the information panel in 
accordance with the provisions of Sec. 101.2.
    (2) The descending order of predominance requirements of paragraph 
(a)(1) of this section do not apply to ingredients present in amounts of 
2 percent or less by weight when a listing of these ingredients is 
placed at the end of the ingredient statement following an appropriate 
quantifying statement, e.g.,

[[Page 19]]

``Contains ______ percent or less of ______,'' or ``Less than ______ 
percent of ______.'' The blank percentage within the quantifying 
statement shall be filled in with a threshold level of 2 percent, or, if 
desired, 1.5 percent, 1.0 percent, or 0.5 percent, as appropriate. No 
ingredient to which the quantifying phrase applies may be present in an 
amount greater than the stated threshold.
    (b) The name of an ingredient shall be a specific name and not a 
collective (generic) name, except that:
    (1) Spices, flavorings, colorings and chemical preservatives shall 
be declared according to the provisions of Sec. 101.22.
    (2) An ingredient which itself contains two or more ingredients and 
which has an established common or usual name, conforms to a standard 
established pursuant to the Meat Inspection or Poultry Products 
Inspection Acts by the U.S. Department of Agriculture, or conforms to a 
definition and standard of identity established pursuant to section 401 
of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, shall be designated in the 
statement of ingredients on the label of such food by either of the 
following alternatives:
    (i) By declaring the established common or usual name of the 
ingredient followed by a parenthetical listing of all ingredients 
contained therein in descending order of predominance except that, if 
the ingredient is a food subject to a definition and standard of 
identity established in subchapter B of this chapter that has specific 
labeling provisions for optional ingredients, optional ingredients may 
be declared within the parenthetical listing in accordance with those 
provisions.
    (ii) By incorporating into the statement of ingredients in 
descending order of predominance in the finished food, the common or 
usual name of every component of the ingredient without listing the 
ingredient itself.
    (3) Skim milk, concentrated skim milk, reconstituted skim milk, and 
nonfat dry milk may be declared as ``skim milk'' or ``nonfat milk''.
    (4) Milk, concentrated milk, reconstituted milk, and dry whole milk 
may be declared as ``milk''.
    (5) Bacterial cultures may be declared by the word ``cultured'' 
followed by the name of the substrate, e.g., ``made from cultured skim 
milk or cultured buttermilk''.
    (6) Sweetcream buttermilk, concentrated sweetcream buttermilk, 
reconstituted sweetcream buttermilk, and dried sweetcream buttermilk may 
be declared as ``buttermilk''.
    (7) Whey, concentrated whey, reconstituted whey, and dried whey may 
be declared as ``whey''.
    (8) Cream, reconstituted cream, dried cream, and plastic cream 
(sometimes known as concentrated milk fat) may be declared as ``cream''.
    (9) Butteroil and anhydrous butterfat may be declared as 
``butterfat''.
    (10) Dried whole eggs, frozen whole eggs, and liquid whole eggs may 
be declared as ``eggs''.
    (11) Dried egg whites, frozen egg whites, and liquid egg whites may 
be declared as ``egg whites''.
    (12) Dried egg yolks, frozen egg yolks, and liquid egg yolks may be 
declared as ``egg yolks''.
    (13) [Reserved]
    (14) Each individual fat and/or oil ingredient of a food intended 
for human consumption shall be declared by its specific common or usual 
name (e.g., ``beef fat'', ``cottonseed oil'') in its order of 
predominance in the food except that blends of fats and/or oils may be 
designated in their order of predominance in the foods as ``---- 
shortening'' or ``blend of ---- oils'', the blank to be filled in with 
the word ``vegetable'', ``animal'', ``marine'', with or without the 
terms ``fat'' or ``oils'', or combination of these, whichever is 
applicable if, immediately following the term, the common or usual name 
of each individual vegetable, animal, or marine fat or oil is given in 
parentheses, e.g., ``vegetable oil shortening (soybean and cottonseed 
oil)''. For products that are blends of fats and/or oils and for foods 
in which fats and/or oils constitute the predominant ingredient, i.e., 
in which the combined weight of all fat and/or oil ingredients equals or 
exceeds the weight of the most predominant ingredient that is not a fat 
or oil, the listing of the common or usual names of such fats and/or 
oils in parentheses shall be in

[[Page 20]]

descending order of predominance. In all other foods in which a blend of 
fats and/or oils is used as an ingredient, the listing of the common or 
usual names in parentheses need not be in descending order of 
predominance if the manufacturer, because of the use of varying 
mixtures, is unable to adhere to a constant pattern of fats and/or oils 
in the product. If the fat or oil is completely hydrogenated, the name 
shall include the term ``hydrogenated'', or if partially hydrogenated, 
the name shall include the term ``partially hydrogenated''. If each fat 
and/or oil in a blend or the blend is completely hydrogenated, the term 
``hydrogenated'' may precede the term(s) describing the blend, e.g., 
``hydrogenated vegetable oil (soybean, cottonseed, and palm oils)'', 
rather than preceding the name of each individual fat and/or oil; if the 
blend of fats and/or oils is partially hydrogenated, the term 
``partially hydrogenated'' may be used in the same manner. Fat and/or 
oil ingredients not present in the product may be listed if they may 
sometimes be used in the product. Such ingredients shall be identified 
by words indicating that they may not be present, such as ``or'', ``and/
or'', ``contains one or more of the following:'', e.g., ``vegetable oil 
shortening (contains one or more of the following: cottonseed oil, palm 
oil, soybean oil)''. No fat or oil ingredient shall be listed unless 
actually present if the fats and/or oils constitute the predominant 
ingredient of the product, as defined in this paragraph (b)(14).
    (15) When all the ingredients of a wheat flour are declared in an 
ingredient statement, the principal ingredient of the flour shall be 
declared by the name(s) specified in Secs. 137.105, 137.200, 137.220 and 
137.225 of this chapter, i.e., the first ingredient designated in the 
ingredient list of flour, or bromated flour, or enriched flour, or self-
rising flour is ``flour'', ``white flour'', ``wheat flour'', or ``plain 
flour''; the first ingredient designated in the ingredient list of durum 
flour is ``durum flour''; the first ingredient designated in the 
ingredient list of whole wheat flour, or bromated whole wheat flour is 
``whole wheat flour'', ``graham flour'', or ``entire wheat flour''; and 
the first ingredient designated in the ingredient list of whole durum 
wheat flour is ``whole durum wheat flour''.
    (16) Ingredients that act as leavening agents in food may be 
declared in the ingredient statement by stating the specific common or 
usual name of each individual leavening agent in parentheses following 
the collective name ``leavening'', e.g., ``leavening (baking soda, 
monocalcium phosphate, and calcium carbonate)''. The listing of the 
common or usual name of each individual leavening agent in parentheses 
shall be in descending order of predominance: Except, That if the 
manufacturer is unable to adhere to a constant pattern of leavening 
agents in the product, the listing of individual leavening agents need 
not be in descending order of predominance. Leavening agents not present 
in the product may be listed if they are sometimes used in the product. 
Such ingredients shall be identified by words indicating that they may 
not be present, such as ``or'', ``and/or'', ``contains one or more of 
the following:''.
    (17) Ingredients that act as yeast nutrients in foods may be 
declared in the ingredient statement by stating the specific common or 
usual name of each individual yeast nutrient in parentheses following 
the collective name ``yeast nutrients'', e.g., ``yeast nutrients 
(calcium sulfate and ammonium phosphate)''. The listing of the common or 
usual name of each individual yeast nutrient in parentheses shall be in 
descending order of predominance: Except, That if the manufacturer is 
unable to adhere to a constant pattern of yeast nutrients in the 
product, the listing of the common or usual names of individual yeast 
nutrients need not be in descending order of predominance. Yeast 
nutrients not present in the product may be listed if they are sometimes 
used in the product. Such ingredients shall be identified by words 
indicating that they may not be present, such as ``or'', ``and/or'', or 
``contains one or more of the following:''.
    (18) Ingredients that act as dough conditioners may be declared in 
the ingredient statement by stating the specific common or usual name of 
each individual dough conditioner in parentheses following the 
collective name ``dough conditioner'', e.g., ``dough

[[Page 21]]

conditioners (L-cysteine, ammonium sulfate)''. The listing of the common 
or usual name of each dough conditioner in parentheses shall be in 
descending order of predominance: Except, That if the manufacturer is 
unable to adhere to a constant pattern of dough conditioners in the 
product, the listing of the common or usual names of individual dough 
conditioners need not be in descending order of predominance. Dough 
conditioners not present in the product may be listed if they are 
sometimes used in the product. Such ingredients shall be identified by 
words indicating that they may not be present, such as ``or'', ``and/
or'', or ``contains one or more of the following:''.
    (19) Ingredients that act as firming agents in food (e.g., salts of 
calcium and other safe and suitable salts in canned vegetables) may be 
declared in the ingredient statement, in order of predominance 
appropriate for the total of all firming agents in the food, by stating 
the specific common or usual name of each individual firming agent in 
descending order of predominance in parentheses following the collective 
name ``firming agents''. If the manufacturer is unable to adhere to a 
constant pattern of firming agents in the food, the listing of the 
individual firming agents need not be in descending order of 
predominance. Firming agents not present in the product may be listed if 
they are sometimes used in the product. Such ingredients shall be 
identified by words indicating that they may not be present, such as 
``or'', ``and/or'', ``contains one or more of the following:''.
    (20) For purposes of ingredient labeling, the term ``sugar'' shall 
refer to sucrose, which is obtained from sugar cane or sugar beets in 
accordance with the provisions of Sec. 184.1854 of this chapter.
    (21) [Reserved]
    (22) Wax and resin ingredients on fresh produce when such produce is 
held for retail sale, or when held for other than retail sale by packers 
or repackers shall be declared collectively by the phrase ``coated with 
food-grade animal-based wax, to maintain freshness'' or the phrase 
``coated with food-grade vegetable-, petroleum-, beeswax-, and/or 
shellac-based wax or resin, to maintain freshness'' as appropriate. The 
terms ``food-grade'' and ``to maintain freshness'' are optional. The 
term ``lac-resin'' may be substituted for the term ``shellac.''
    (c) When water is added to reconstitute, completely or partially, an 
ingredient permitted by paragraph (b) of this section to be declared by 
a class name, the position of the ingredient class name in the 
ingredient statement shall be determined by the weight of the 
unreconstituted ingredient plus the weight of the quantity of water 
added to reconstitute that ingredient, up to the amount of water needed 
to reconstitute the ingredient to single strength. Any water added in 
excess of the amount of water needed to reconstitute the ingredient to 
single strength shall be declared as ``water'' in the ingredient 
statement.
    (d) When foods characterized on the label as ``nondairy'' contain a 
caseinate ingredient, the caseinate ingredient shall be followed by a 
parenthetical statement identifying its source. For example, if the 
manufacturer uses the term ``nondairy'' on a creamer that contains 
sodium caseinate, it shall include a parenthetical term such as ``a milk 
derivative'' after the listing of sodium caseinate in the ingredient 
list.
    (e) If the percentage of an ingredient is included in the statement 
of ingredients, it shall be shown in parentheses following the name of 
the ingredient and expressed in terms of percent by weight. Percentage 
declarations shall be expressed to the nearest 1 percent, except that 
where ingredients are present at levels of 2 percent or less, they may 
be grouped together and expressed in accordance with the quantifying 
guidance set forth in paragraph (a)(2) of this section.
    (f) Except as provided in Sec. 101.100, ingredients that must be 
declared on labeling because there is no label for the food, including 
foods that comply with standards of identity, shall be listed 
prominently and conspicuously by common or usual name in the manner 
prescribed by paragraph (b) of this section.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 43 FR 12858, Mar. 28, 1978; 
43 FR 24519, June 6, 1978; 48 FR 8054, Feb. 25, 1983; 55 FR 17433, Apr. 
25, 1990; 58 FR 2875, Jan. 6, 1993]

[[Page 22]]



Sec. 101.5   Food; name and place of business of manufacturer, packer, or distributor.

    (a) The label of a food in packaged form shall specify conspicuously 
the name and place of business of the manufacturer, packer, or 
distributor.
    (b) The requirement for declaration of the name of the manufacturer, 
packer, or distributor shall be deemed to be satisfied, in the case of a 
corporation, only by the actual corporate name, which may be preceded or 
followed by the name of the particular division of the corporation. In 
the case of an individual, partnership, or association, the name under 
which the business is conducted shall be used.
    (c) Where the food is not manufactured by the person whose name 
appears on the label, the name shall be qualified by a phrase that 
reveals the connection such person has with such food; such as 
``Manufactured for --------------'', ``Distributed by --------------'', 
or any other wording that expresses the facts.
    (d) The statement of the place of business shall include the street 
address, city, State, and ZIP code; however, the street address may be 
omitted if it is shown in a current city directory or telephone 
directory. The requirement for inclusion of the ZIP code shall apply 
only to consumer commodity labels developed or revised after the 
effective date of this section. In the case of nonconsumer packages, the 
ZIP code shall appear either on the label or the labeling (including 
invoice).
    (e) If a person manufactures, packs, or distributes a food at a 
place other than his principal place of business, the label may state 
the principal place of business in lieu of the actual place where such 
food was manufactured or packed or is to be distributed, unless such 
statement would be misleading.



Sec. 101.8   Labeling of food with number of servings.

    (a) The label of any package of a food that bears a representation 
as to the number of servings contained in such package shall bear in 
immediate conjunction with such statement, and in the same size type as 
is used for such statement, a statement of the net quantity (in terms of 
weight, measure, or numerical count) of each such serving; however, such 
statement may be expressed in terms that differ from the terms used in 
the required statement of net quantity of contents (for example cups, 
tablespoons) when such differing term is common to cookery and describes 
a constant quantity. Such statement shall not be misleading in any 
particular. Where nutrition labeling information is required in 
accordance with the provisions of Sec. 101.9, however, the statement of 
the net quantity of each serving shall be consistent with the 
requirements for serving size expression set forth in that section 
(e.g., 10 1-cup (240 milliliters) servings). A statement of the number 
of units in a package is not in itself a statement of the number of 
servings.
    (b) If there exists a voluntary product standard promulgated 
pursuant to the procedures found in 15 CFR part 10 by the Department of 
Commerce, quantitatively defining the meaning of the term ``serving'' 
with respect to a particular food, then any label representation as to 
the number of servings in such packaged food shall correspond with such 
quantitative definition. (Copies of published standards are available 
upon request from the National Bureau of Standards, Department of 
Commerce, Washington, DC 20234.)

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 58 FR 2291, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.9  Nutrition labeling of food.

    (a) Nutrition information relating to food shall be provided for all 
products intended for human consumption and offered for sale unless an 
exemption is provided for the product in paragraph (j) of this section.
    (1) When food is in package form, the required nutrition labeling 
information shall appear on the label in the format specified in this 
section.
    (2) When food is not in package form, the required nutrition 
labeling information shall be displayed clearly at the point of purchase 
(e.g., on a counter card, sign, tag affixed to the product, or some 
other appropriate device). Alternatively, the required information may 
be placed in a booklet, looseleaf binder, or other appropriate

[[Page 23]]

format that is available at the point of purchase.
    (3) Solicitation of requests for nutrition information by a 
statement ``For nutrition information write to ________________'' on the 
label or in the labeling or advertising for a food, or providing such 
information in a direct written reply to a solicited or unsolicited 
request, does not subject the label or the labeling of a food exempted 
under paragraph (j) of this section to the requirements of this section 
if the reply to the request conforms to the requirements of this 
section.
    (4) If any vitamin or mineral is added to a food so that a single 
serving provides 50 percent or more of the Reference Daily Intake (RDI) 
for the age group for which the product is intended, as specified in 
paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of this section, of any one of the added vitamins 
or minerals, unless such addition is permitted or required in other 
regulations, e.g., a standard of identity or nutritional quality 
guideline, or is otherwise exempted by the Commissioner, the food shall 
be considered a food for special dietary use within the meaning of 
Sec. 105.3(a)(1)(iii) of this chapter.
    (b) Except as provided in Sec. 101.9(h)(3), all nutrient and food 
component quantities shall be declared in relation to a serving as 
defined in this section.
    (1) The term ``serving'' or ``serving size'' means an amount of food 
customarily consumed per eating occasion by persons 4 years of age or 
older which is expressed in a common household measure that is 
appropriate to the food. When the food is specially formulated or 
processed for use by infants or by toddlers, a serving or serving size 
means an amount of food customarily consumed per eating occasion by 
infants up to 12 months of age or by children 1 through 3 years of age, 
respectively.
    (2) Except as provided in paragraphs (b)(3), (b)(4), and (b)(6) of 
this section and for products that are intended for weight control and 
are available only through a weight-control or weight-maintenance 
program, serving size declared on a product label shall be determined 
from the ``Reference Amounts Customarily Consumed Per Eating Occasion * 
* *'' (reference amounts) that appear in Sec. 101.12(b) using the 
procedures described below. For products that are both intended for 
weight control and available only through a weight-control program, a 
manufacturer may determine the serving size that is consistent with the 
meal plan of the program. Such products must bear a statement, ``for 
sale only through the -------- program'' (fill in the blank with the 
name of the appropriate weight-control program, e.g., Smith's Weight 
Control), on the principal display panel. However, the reference amounts 
in Sec. 101.12(b) shall be used for purposes of evaluating whether 
weight-control products that are available only through a weight-control 
program qualify for nutrient content claims or health claims.
    (i) For products in discrete units (e.g., muffins, sliced products, 
such as sliced bread, or individually packaged products within a 
multiserving package) and for products which consist of two or more 
foods packaged and presented to be consumed together where the 
ingredient represented as the main ingredient is in discrete units 
(e.g., pancakes and syrup), the serving size shall be declared as 
follows:
    (A) If a unit weighs 50 percent or less of the reference amount, the 
serving size shall be the number of whole units that most closely 
approximates the reference amount for the product category;
    (B) If a unit weighs more than 50 percent, but less than 67 percent 
of the reference amount, the manufacturer may declare one unit or two 
units as the serving size;
    (C) If a unit weighs 67 percent or more, but less than 200 percent 
of the reference amount, the serving size shall be one unit;
    (D) If a unit weighs 200 percent or more of the reference amount, 
the manufacturer may declare one unit as the serving size if the whole 
unit can reasonably be consumed at a single-eating occasion.
    (E) For products that have reference amounts of 100 grams (g) (or 
milliliter (mL)) or larger and are individual units within a 
multiserving package, if a unit contains more than 150 percent but less 
than 200 percent of the reference amount, the manufacturer may

[[Page 24]]

decide whether to declare the individual unit as 1 or 2 servings.
    (F) The serving size for maraschino cherries shall be expressed as 1 
cherry with the parenthetical metric measure equal to the average weight 
of a medium size cherry.
    (G) The serving size for products that naturally vary in size (e.g., 
pickles, shellfish, whole fish, and fillet of fish) may be the amount in 
ounces that most closely approximates the reference amount for the 
product category. Manufacturers shall adhere to the requirements in 
paragraph (b)(5)(vi) of this section for expressing the serving size in 
ounces.
    (H) For products which consist of two or more foods packaged and 
presented to be consumed together where the ingredient represented as 
the main ingredient is in discrete units (e.g., pancakes and syrup), the 
serving size may be the number of discrete units represented as the main 
ingredient plus proportioned minor ingredients used to make the 
reference amount for the combined product determined in Sec. 101.12(f).
    (I) For packages containing several individual single-serving 
containers, each of which is labeled with all required information 
including nutrition labeling as specified in Sec. 101.9 (that is, are 
labeled appropriately for individual sale as single-serving containers), 
the serving size shall be 1 unit.
    (ii) For products in large discrete units that are usually divided 
for consumption (e.g., cake, pie, pizza, melon, cabbage), for unprepared 
products where the entire contents of the package is used to prepare 
large discrete units that are usually divided for consumption (e.g., 
cake mix, pizza kit), and for products which consist of two or more 
foods packaged and presented to be consumed together where the 
ingredient represented as the main ingredient is a large discrete unit 
usually divided for consumption (e.g., prepared cake packaged with a can 
of frosting), the serving size shall be the fractional slice of the 
ready-to-eat product (e.g., 1/12 cake, 1/8 pie, 1/4 pizza, 1/4 melon, 1/
6 cabbage) that most closely approximates the reference amount for the 
product category, and may be the fraction of the package used to make 
the reference amount for the unprepared product determined in 
Sec. 101.12(c) or the fraction of the large discrete unit represented as 
the main ingredient plus proportioned minor ingredients used to make the 
reference amount for the combined product determined in Sec. 101.12(f). 
In expressing the fractional slice, manufacturers shall use 1/2, 1/3, 1/
4, 1/5, 1/6, or smaller fractions that can be generated by further 
division by 2 or 3.
    (iii) For nondiscrete bulk products (e.g., breakfast cereal, flour, 
sugar, dry mixes, concentrates, pancake mixes, macaroni and cheese 
kits), and for products which consist of two or more foods packaged and 
presented to be consumed together where the ingredient represented as 
the main ingredient is a bulk product (e.g., peanut butter and jelly), 
the serving size shall be the amount in household measure that most 
closely approximates the reference amount for the product category and 
may be the amount of the bulk product represented as the main ingredient 
plus proportioned minor ingredients used to make the reference amount 
for the combined product determined in Sec. 101.12(f).
    (3) The serving size for meal products and main dish products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and (m) that comes in single-serving 
containers as defined in paragraph (b)(6) of this section shall be the 
entire content (edible portion only) of the package. Serving size for 
meal products and main dish products in multiserving containers shall be 
based on the reference amount applicable to the product in 
Sec. 101.12(b) if the product is listed in Sec. 101.12(b). Serving size 
for meal products and main dish products in multiserving containers that 
are not listed in Sec. 101.12(b) shall be based on the reference amount 
according to Sec. 101.12(f).
    (4) A variety pack, such as a package containing several varieties 
of single-serving units as defined in paragraph (b)(2)(i) of this 
section, and a product having two or more compartments with each 
compartment containing a different food, shall provide nutrition 
information for each variety or food per serving size that is derived 
from the reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b) applicable for each variety 
or food and

[[Page 25]]

the procedures to convert the reference amount to serving size in 
paragraph (b)(2) of this section.
    (5) For labeling purposes, the term ``common household measure'' or 
``common household unit'' means cup, tablespoon, teaspoon, piece, slice, 
fraction (e.g., 1/4 pizza), ounce (oz), fluid ounce (fl oz), or other 
common household equipment used to package food products (e.g., jar, 
tray). In expressing serving size in household measures, except as 
specified in paragraphs (b)(5)(iv), (b)(5)(v), (b)(5)(vi), and 
(b)(5)(vii) of this section, the following rules shall be used:
    (i) Cups, tablespoons, or teaspoons shall be used wherever possible 
and appropriate except for beverages. For beverages, a manufacturer may 
use fluid ounces. Cups shall be expressed in 1/4-or 1/3-cup increments, 
tablespoons in whole number of tablespoons for quantities less than 1/4 
cup but greater than or equal to 2 tablespoons (tbsp), 1, 1 1/3, 1 1/2, 
or 1 2/3 tbsp for quantities less than 2 tbsp but greater than or equal 
to 1 tbsp, and teaspoons in whole number of teaspoons for quantities 
less than 1 tbsp but greater than or equal to 1 teaspoon (tsp), and in 
1/4-tsp increments for quantities less than 1 tsp.
    (ii) If cups, tablespoons or teaspoons are not applicable, units 
such as piece, slice, tray, jar, and fraction shall be used.
    (iii) If paragraphs (b)(5)(i) and (b)(5)(ii) of this section are not 
applicable, ounces may be used with an appropriate visual unit of 
measure such as a dimension of a piece, e.g., 1 oz (28 g/about 1/2 
pickle). Ounce measurements shall be expressed in 0.5 oz increments most 
closely approximating the reference amount.
    (iv) A description of the individual container or package shall be 
used for single serving containers and for individually packaged 
products within multiserving containers (e.g., can, box, package). A 
description of the individual unit shall be used for other products in 
discrete units (e.g., piece, slice, cracker, bar).
    (v) For unprepared products where the entire contents of the package 
is used to prepare large discrete units that are usually divided for 
consumption (e.g., cake mix, pizza kit), the fraction or portion of the 
package may be used.
    (vi) Ounces with an appropriate visual unit of measure, as described 
in paragraph (b)(5)(iii) of this section, may be used for products that 
naturally vary in size as provided for in paragraph (b)(2)(i)(G) of this 
section.
    (vii) As provided for in Sec. 101.9(h)(1), for products that consist 
of two or more distinct ingredients or components packaged and presented 
to be consumed together (e.g. dry macaroni and cheese mix, cake and 
muffin mixes with separate ingredient packages, pancakes and syrup), 
nutrition information may be declared for each component or as a 
composite. The serving size may be provided in accordance with the 
provisions of paragraphs (b)(2)(i), (b)(2)(ii), and (b)(2)(iii) of this 
section, or alternatively in ounces with an appropriate visual unit of 
measure, as described in paragraph (b)(5)(iii) of this section (e.g., 
declared as separate components: ``3 oz dry macaroni (84 g/about 2/3 
cup)'' and ``1 oz dry cheese mix (28 g/about 2 tbsp);'' declared as a 
composite value: ``4 oz (112 g/about 2/3 cup macaroni and 2 tbsp dry 
cheese mix)'').
    (viii) For nutrition labeling purposes, a teaspoon means 5 
milliliters (mL), a tablespoon means 15 mL, a cup means 240 mL, 1 fl oz 
means 30 mL, and 1 oz in weight means 28 g.
    (ix) When a serving size, determined from the reference amount in 
Sec. 101.12(b) and the procedures described in this section, falls 
exactly half way between two serving sizes, e.g., 2.5 tbsp, 
manufacturers shall round the serving size up to the next incremental 
size.
    (6) A product that is packaged and sold individually and that 
contains less than 200 percent of the applicable reference amount shall 
be considered to be a single-serving container, and the entire content 
of the product shall be labeled as one serving except for products that 
have reference amounts of 100 g (or mL) or larger, manufacturers may 
decide whether a package that contains more than 150 percent but less 
than 200 percent of the reference amount is 1 or 2 servings. Packages 
sold individually that contain 200 percent or more of the applicable 
reference amount may be labeled as a single-serving if the entire

[[Page 26]]

content of the package can reasonably be consumed at a single-eating 
occasion.
    (7) A label statement regarding a serving shall be the serving size 
expressed in common household measures as set forth in paragraphs (b)(2) 
through (b)(6) of this section and shall be followed by the equivalent 
metric quantity in parenthesis (fluids in milliliters and all other 
foods in grams) except for single-serving containers.
    (i) For a single-serving container, the parenthetical metric 
quantity, which will be presented as part of the net weight statement on 
the principal display panel, is not required except where nutrition 
information is required on a drained weight basis according to 
Sec. 101.9(b)(9). However, if a manufacturer voluntarily provides the 
metric quantity on products that can be sold as single servings, then 
the numerical value provided as part of the serving size declaration 
must be identical to the metric quantity declaration provided as part of 
the net quantity of contents statement.
    (ii) The gram or milliliter quantity equivalent to the household 
measure should be rounded to the nearest whole number except for 
quantities that are less than 5 g (mL). The gram (mL) quantity between 2 
and 5 g (mL) should be rounded to the nearest 0.5 g (mL) and the g (mL) 
quantity less than 2 g (mL) should be expressed in 0.1-g (mL) 
increments.
    (iii) In addition, serving size may be declared in ounce and fluid 
ounce, in parenthesis, following the metric measure separated by a slash 
where other common household measures are used as the primary unit for 
serving size, e.g., 1 slice (28 g/1 oz) for sliced bread. The ounce 
quantity equivalent to the metric quantity should be expressed in 0.1 oz 
increments.
    (iv) If a manufacturer elects to use abbreviations for units, the 
following abbreviations shall be used: tbsp for tablespoon, tsp for 
teaspoon, g for gram, mL for milliliter, oz for ounce, and fl oz for 
fluid ounce.
    (v) For products that only require the addition of water or another 
ingredient that contains insignificant amounts of nutrients in the 
amount added and that are prepared in such a way that there are no 
significant changes to the nutrient profile, the amount of the finished 
product may be declared in parentheses at the end of the serving size 
declaration (e.g., 1/2 cup (120 mL) concentrated soup (makes 1 cup 
prepared)).
    (vi) To promote uniformity in label serving sizes in household 
measures declared by different manufacturers, FDA has provided a 
guideline entitled, ``Guidelines for Determining the Gram Weight of the 
Household Measure.'' The guideline can be obtained from the Office of 
Food Labeling (HFS-150), Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition, 
Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. SW., Washington, DC 20204.
    (8) Determination of the number of servings per container shall be 
based on the serving size of the product determined by following the 
procedures described in this section.
    (i) The number of servings shall be rounded to the nearest whole 
number except for the number of servings between 2 and 5 servings and 
random weight products. The number of servings between 2 and 5 servings 
shall be rounded to the nearest 0.5 serving. Rounding should be 
indicated by the use of the term ``about'' (e.g., about 2 servings, 
about 3.5 servings).
    (ii) When the serving size is required to be expressed on a drained 
solids basis and the number of servings varies because of a natural 
variation in unit size (e.g., maraschino cherries, pickles), the 
manufacturer may state the typical number of servings per container 
(e.g., usually 5 servings).
    (iii) For random weight products, a manufacturer may declare 
``varied'' for the number of servings per container provided the 
nutrition information is based on the reference amount expressed in 
ounces. The manufacturer may provide the typical number of servings in 
parenthesis following the ``varied'' statement.
    (iv) For packages containing several individual single-serving 
containers, each of which is labeled with all required information 
including nutrition labeling as specified in Sec. 101.9 (that is, are 
labeled appropriately for individual sale as single-serving containers), 
the number of servings shall be the number

[[Page 27]]

of individual packages within the total package.
    (v) For packages containing several individually packaged 
multiserving units, the number of servings shall be determined by 
multiplying the number of individual multiserving units in the total 
package by the number of servings in each individual unit.
    (9) The declaration of nutrient and food component content shall be 
on the basis of food as packaged or purchased with the exception of raw 
fish covered under Sec. 101.42 (see 101.44), packaged single-ingredient 
products that consist of fish or game meat as provided for in paragraph 
(j)(11) of this section, and of foods that are packed or canned in 
water, brine, or oil but whose liquid packing medium is not customarily 
consumed (e.g., canned fish, maraschino cherries, pickled fruits, and 
pickled vegetables). Declaration of nutrient and food component content 
of raw fish shall follow the provisions in Sec. 101.45. Declaration of 
the nutrient and food component content of foods that are packed in 
liquid which is not customarily consumed shall be based on the drained 
solids.
    (10) Another column of figures may be used to declare the nutrient 
and food component information:
    (i) Per 100 g or 100 mL, or per 1 oz or 1 fl oz of the food as 
packaged or purchased;
    (ii) Per one unit if the serving size of a product in discrete units 
in a multiserving container is more than 1 unit;
    (iii) Per cup popped for popcorn in a multiserving container.
    (11) If a product is promoted on the label, labeling, or advertising 
for a use that differs in quantity by twofold or greater from the use 
upon which the reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b) was based (e.g., 
liquid cream substitutes promoted for use with breakfast cereals), the 
manufacturer shall provide a second column of nutrition information 
based on the amount customarily consumed in the promoted use, in 
addition to the nutrition information per serving derived from the 
reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b), except that nondiscrete bulk 
products that are used primarily as ingredients (e.g., flour, 
sweeteners, shortenings, oils), or traditionally used for multipurposes 
(e.g., eggs, butter, margarine), and multipurpose baking mixes are 
exempt from this requirement.
    (c) The declaration of nutrition information on the label and in 
labeling of a food shall contain information about the level of the 
following nutrients, except for those nutrients whose inclusion, and the 
declaration of amounts, is voluntary as set forth in this paragraph. No 
nutrients or food components other than those listed in this paragraph 
as either mandatory or voluntary may be included within the nutrition 
label. Except as provided for in paragraphs (f) or (j) of this section, 
nutrient information shall be presented using the nutrient names 
specified and in the following order in the formats specified in 
paragraphs (d) or (e) of this section.
    (1) ``Calories, total,'' ``Total calories,'' or ``Calories'': A 
statement of the caloric content per serving, expressed to the nearest 
5-calorie increment up to and including 50 calories, and 10-calorie 
increment above 50 calories, except that amounts less than 5 calories 
may be expressed as zero. Energy content per serving may also be 
expressed in kilojoule units, added in parentheses immediately following 
the statement of the caloric content.
    (i) Caloric content may be calculated by the following methods. 
Where either specific or general food factors are used, the factors 
shall be applied to the actual amount (i.e., before rounding) of food 
components (e.g., fat, carbohydrate, protein, or ingredients with 
specific food factors) present per serving.
    (A) Using specific Atwater factors (i. e., the Atwater method) given 
in Table 13, ``Energy Value of Foods--Basis and Derivation,'' by A. L. 
Merrill and B. K. Watt, United States Department of Agriculture (USDA) 
Handbook No. 74 (slightly revised, 1973), which is incorporated by 
reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR part 51 and is 
available from the Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150), Center for Food 
Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. 
SW., Washington, DC 20204, or may be inspected at the Office of the 
Federal Register, 800 North Capitol St. NW., suite 700, Washington, DC.;

[[Page 28]]

    (B) Using the general factors of 4, 4, and 9 calories per gram for 
protein, total carbohydrate, and total fat, respectively, as described 
in USDA Handbook No. 74 (slightly revised 1973) pp. 9-11, which is 
incorporated by reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR 
part 51 (the availability of this incorporation by reference is given in 
paragraph (c)(1)(i)(A) of this section);
    (C) Using the general factors of 4, 4, and 9 calories per gram for 
protein, total carbohydrate less the amount of insoluble dietary fiber, 
and total fat, respectively, as described in USDA Handbook No. 74 
(slightly revised 1973) pp. 9-11, which is incorporated by reference in 
accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR part 51 (the availability of 
this incorporation by reference is given in paragraph (c)(1)(i)(A) of 
this section;
    (D) Using data for specific food factors for particular foods or 
ingredients approved by the Food and Drug Administration (FDA) and 
provided in parts 172 or 184 of this chapter, or by other means, as 
appropriate; or
    (E) Using bomb calorimetry data subtracting 1.25 calories per gram 
protein to correct for incomplete digestibility, as described in USDA 
Handbook No. 74 (slightly revised 1973) p. 10, which is incorporated by 
reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR part 51 (the 
availability of this incorporation by reference is given in paragraph 
(c)(1)(i)(A) of this section).
    (ii) ``Calories from fat'': A statement of the caloric content 
derived from total fat as defined in paragraph (c)(2) of this section in 
a serving, expressed to the nearest 5-calorie increment, up to and 
including 50 calories, and the nearest 10-calorie increment above 50 
calories, except that label declaration of ``calories from fat'' is not 
required on products that contain less than 0.5 gram of fat in a serving 
and amounts less than 5 calories may be expressed as zero. This 
statement shall be declared as provided in paragraph (d)(5) of this 
section. Except as provided for in paragraph (f) of this section, if 
``Calories from fat'' is not required and, as a result, not declared, 
the statement ``Not a significant source of calories from fat'' shall be 
placed at the bottom of the table of nutrient values in the same type 
size.
    (iii) ``Calories from saturated fat'' or ``Calories from saturated'' 
(VOLUNTARY): A statement of the caloric content derived from saturated 
fat as defined in paragraph (c)(2)(i) of this section in a serving may 
be declared voluntarily, expressed to the nearest 5-calorie increment, 
up to and including 50 calories, and the nearest 10-calorie increment 
above 50 calories, except that amounts less than 5 calories may be 
expressed as zero. This statement shall be indented under the statement 
of calories from fat as provided in paragraph (d)(5) of this section.
    (2) ``Fat, total'' or ``Total fat'': A statement of the number of 
grams of total fat in a serving defined as total lipid fatty acids and 
expressed as triglycerides. Amounts shall be expressed to the nearest 
0.5 (1/2) gram increment below 5 grams and to the nearest gram increment 
above 5 grams. If the serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content 
shall be expressed as zero.
    (i) ``Saturated fat,'' or ``Saturated'': A statement of the number 
of grams of saturated fat in a serving defined as the sum of all fatty 
acids containing no double bonds, except that label declaration of 
saturated fat content information is not required for products that 
contain less than 0.5 gram of total fat in a serving if no claims are 
made about fat or cholesterol content, and if ``calories from saturated 
fat'' is not declared. Except as provided for in paragraph (f) of this 
section, if a statement of the saturated fat content is not required 
and, as a result, not declared, the statement ``Not a significant source 
of saturated fat'' shall be placed at the bottom of the table of 
nutrient values in the same type size. Saturated fat content shall be 
indented and expressed as grams per serving to the nearest 0.5 (1/2) 
gram increment below 5 grams and to the nearest gram increment above 5 
grams. If the serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content shall be 
expressed as zero.
    (ii) ``Polyunsaturated fat'' or ``Polyunsaturated'' (VOLUNTARY): A 
statement of the number of grams of polyunsaturated fat in a serving 
defined as cis,cis-methylene-interrupted

[[Page 29]]

polyunsaturated fatty acids may be declared voluntarily, except that 
when monounsaturated fat is declared, or when a claim about fatty acids 
or cholesterol is made on the label or in labeling of a food other than 
one that meets the criteria in Sec. 101.62(b)(1) for a claim for ``fat 
free,'' label declaration of polyunsaturated fat is required. 
Polyunsaturated fat content shall be indented and expressed as grams per 
serving to the nearest 0.5 (1/2) gram increment below 5 grams and to the 
nearest gram increment above 5 grams. If the serving contains less than 
0.5 gram, the content shall be expressed as zero.
    (iii) ``Monounsaturated fat'' or ``Monounsaturated'' (VOLUNTARY): A 
statement of the number of grams of monounsaturated fat in a serving 
defined as cis-monounsaturated fatty acids may be declared voluntarily 
except that when polyunsaturated fat is declared, or when a claim about 
fatty acids or cholesterol is made on the label or in labeling of a food 
other than one that meets the criteria in Sec. 101.62(b)(1) for a claim 
for ``fat free,'' label declaration of monounsaturated fat is required. 
Monounsaturated fat content shall be indented and expressed as grams per 
serving to the nearest 0.5 (1/2) gram increment below 5 grams and to the 
nearest gram increment above 5 grams. If the serving contains less than 
0.5 gram, the content shall be expressed as zero.
    (3) ``Cholesterol'': A statement of the cholesterol content in a 
serving expressed in milligrams to the nearest 5-milligram increment, 
except that label declaration of cholesterol information is not required 
for products that contain less than 2 milligrams cholesterol in a 
serving and make no claim about fat, fatty acids, or cholesterol 
content, or such products may state the cholesterol content as zero. 
Except as provided for in paragraph (f) of this section, if cholesterol 
content is not required and, as a result, not declared, the statement 
``Not a significant source of cholesterol'' shall be placed at the 
bottom of the table of nutrient values in the same type size. If the 
food contains 2 to 5 milligrams of cholesterol per serving, the content 
may be stated as ``less than 5 milligrams.''
    (4) ``Sodium'': A statement of the number of milligrams of sodium in 
a specified serving of food expressed as zero when the serving contains 
less than 5 milligrams of sodium, to the nearest 5-milligram increment 
when the serving contains 5 to 140 milligrams of sodium, and to the 
nearest 10-milligram increment when the serving contains greater than 
140 milligrams.
    (5) ``Potassium'' (VOLUNTARY): A statement of the number of 
milligrams of potassium in a specified serving of food may be declared 
voluntarily, except that when a claim is made about potassium content, 
label declaration shall be required. Potassium content shall be 
expressed as zero when the serving contains less than 5 milligrams of 
potassium, to the nearest 5-milligram increment when the serving 
contains less than or equal to 140 milligrams of potassium, and to the 
nearest 10-milligram increment when the serving contains more than 140 
milligrams.
    (6) ``Carbohydrate, total'' or ``Total carbohydrate'': A statement 
of the number of grams of total carbohydrate in a serving expressed to 
the nearest gram, except that if a serving contains less than 1 gram, 
the statement ``Contains less than 1 gram'' or ``less than 1 gram'' may 
be used as an alternative, or if the serving contains less than 0.5 
gram, the content may be expressed as zero. Total carbohydrate content 
shall be calculated by subtraction of the sum of the crude protein, 
total fat, moisture, and ash from the total weight of the food. This 
calculation method is described in A. L. Merrill and B. K. Watt, 
``Energy Value of Foods--Basis and Derivation,'' USDA Handbook 74 
(slightly revised 1973) pp. 2 and 3, which is incorporated by reference 
in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR part 51 (the availability 
of this incorporation by reference is given in paragraph (c)(1)(i)(A) of 
this section).
    (i) ``Dietary fiber'': A statement of the number of grams of total 
dietary fiber in a serving, indented and expressed to the nearest gram, 
except that if a serving contains less than 1 gram, declaration of 
dietary fiber is not required or, alternatively, the statement 
``Contains less than 1 gram'' or ``less than 1 gram'' may be used, and 
if the serving contains less than 0.5

[[Page 30]]

gram, the content may be expressed as zero. Except as provided for in 
paragraph (f) of this section, if dietary fiber content is not required 
and as a result, not declared, the statement ``Not a significant source 
of dietary fiber'' shall be placed at the bottom of the table of 
nutrient values in the same type size.
    (A) ``Soluble fiber'' (VOLUNTARY): A statement of the number of 
grams of soluble dietary fiber in a serving may be declared voluntarily 
except when a claim is made on the label or in labeling about soluble 
fiber, label declaration shall be required. Soluble fiber content shall 
be indented under dietary fiber and expressed to the nearest gram, 
except that if a serving contains less than 1 gram, the statement 
``Contains less than 1 gram'' or ``less than 1 gram'' may be used as an 
alternative, and if the serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content 
may be expressed as zero.
    (B) ``Insoluble fiber'' (VOLUNTARY): A statement of the number of 
grams of insoluble dietary fiber in a serving may be declared 
voluntarily except that when a claim is made on the label or in labeling 
about insoluble fiber, label declaration shall be required. Insoluble 
fiber content shall be indented under dietary fiber and expressed to the 
nearest gram except that if a serving contains less than 1 gram, the 
statement ``Contains less than 1 gram'' or ``less than 1 gram'' may be 
used as an alternative, and if the serving contains less than 0.5 gram, 
the content may be expressed as zero.
    (ii) ``Sugars'': A statement of the number of grams of sugars in a 
serving, except that label declaration of sugars content is not required 
for products that contain less than 1 gram of sugars in a serving if no 
claims are made about sweeteners, sugars, or sugar alcohol content. 
Except as provided for in paragraph (f) of this section, if a statement 
of the sugars content is not required and, as a result, not declared, 
the statement ``Not a significant source of sugars'' shall be placed at 
the bottom of the table of nutrient values in the same type size. Sugars 
shall be defined as the sum of all free mono- and disaccharides (such as 
glucose, fructose, lactose, and sucrose). Sugars content shall be 
indented and expressed to the nearest gram, except that if a serving 
contains less than 1 gram, the statement ``Contains less then 1 gram'' 
or ``less than 1 gram'' may be used as an alternative, and if the 
serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content may be expressed as 
zero.
    (iii) ``Sugar alcohol'' (VOLUNTARY): A statement of the number of 
grams of sugar alcohols in a serving may be declared voluntarily on the 
label, except that when a claim is made on the label or in labeling 
about sugar alcohol or sugars when sugar alcohols are present in the 
food, sugar alcohol content shall be declared. For nutrition labeling 
purposes, sugar alcohols are defined as the sum of saccharide 
derivatives in which a hydroxyl group replaces a ketone or aldehyde 
group and whose use in the food is listed by FDA (e.g., mannitol or 
xylitol) or is generally recognized as safe (e.g., sorbitol). In lieu of 
the term ``sugar alcohol,'' the name of the specific sugar alcohol 
(e.g., ``xylitol'') present in the food may be used in the nutrition 
label provided that only one sugar alcohol is present in the food. Sugar 
alcohol content shall be indented and expressed to the nearest gram, 
except that if a serving contains less than 1 gram, the statement 
``Contains less then 1 gram'' or ``less than 1 gram'' may be used as an 
alternative, and if the serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content 
may be expressed as zero.
    (iv) ``Other carbohydrate'' (VOLUNTARY): A statement of the number 
of grams of other carbohydrates may be declared voluntarily. Other 
carbohydrates shall be defined as the difference between total 
carbohydrate and the sum of dietary fiber, sugars, and sugar alcohol, 
except that if sugar alcohol is not declared (even if present), it shall 
be defined as the difference between total carbohydrate and the sum of 
dietary fiber and sugars. Other carbohydrate content shall be indented 
and expressed to the nearest gram, except that if a serving contains 
less than 1 gram, the statement ``Contains less than 1 gram'' or ``less 
than 1 gram'' may be used as an alternative, and if the serving contains 
less than 0.5 gram, the content may be expressed as zero.

[[Page 31]]

    (7) ``Protein'': A statement of the number of grams of protein in a 
serving, expressed to the nearest gram, except that if a serving 
contains less than 1 gram, the statement ``Contains less than 1 gram'' 
or ``less than 1 gram'' may be used as an alternative, and if the 
serving contains less than 0.5 gram, the content may be expressed as 
zero. When the protein in foods represented or purported to be for 
adults and children 4 or more years of age has a protein quality value 
that is a protein digestibility-corrected amino acid score of less than 
20 expressed as a percent, or when the protein in a food represented or 
purported to be for children greater than 1 but less than 4 years of age 
has a protein quality value that is a protein digestibility-corrected 
amino acid score of less than 40 expressed as a percent, either of the 
following shall be placed adjacent to the declaration of protein content 
by weight: The statement ``not a significant source of protein,'' or a 
listing aligned under the column headed ``Percent Daily Value'' of the 
corrected amount of protein per serving, as determined in paragraph 
(c)(7)(ii) of this section, calculated as a percentage of the Daily 
Reference Value (DRV) or Reference Daily Intake (RDI), as appropriate, 
for protein and expressed as Percent of Daily Value. When the protein 
quality in a food as measured by the Protein Efficiency Ratio (PER) is 
less than 40 percent of the reference standard (casein) for a food 
represented or purported to be for infants, the statement ``not a 
significant source of protein'' shall be placed adjacent to the 
declaration of protein content. Protein content may be calculated on the 
basis of the factor of 6.25 times the nitrogen content of the food as 
determined by the appropriate method of analysis as given in the 
``Official Methods of Analysis of the AOAC International'' (formerly the 
Association of Official Analytical Chemists), 15th Ed. (1990), which is 
incorporated by reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR 
part 51, except when the official procedure for a specific food requires 
another factor. Copies may be obtained from AOAC, 2200 Wilson Blvd., 
suite 400, Arlington, VA 22201-3301, or may be inspected at the Office 
of the Federal Register, 800 North Capitol St. NW., suite 700, 
Washington, DC.
    (i) A statement of the corrected amount of protein per serving, as 
determined in paragraph (c)(7)(ii) of this section, calculated as a 
percentage of the RDI or DRV for protein, as appropriate, and expressed 
as Percent of Daily Value, may be placed on the label, except that such 
a statement shall be given if a protein claim is made for the product, 
or if the product is represented or purported to be for use by infants 
or children under 4 years of age. When such a declaration is provided, 
it shall be placed on the label adjacent to the statement of grams of 
protein and aligned under the column headed ``Percent Daily Value,'' and 
expressed to the nearest whole percent. However, the percentage of the 
RDI for protein shall not be declared if the food is represented or 
purported to be for use by infants and the protein quality value is less 
than 40 percent of the reference standard.
    (ii) The ``corrected amount of protein (gram) per serving'' for 
foods represented or purported for adults and children 1 or more years 
of age is equal to the actual amount of protein (gram) per serving 
multiplied by the amino acid score corrected for protein digestibility. 
If the corrected score is above 1.00, then it shall be set at 1.00. The 
protein digestibility-corrected amino acid score shall be determined by 
methods given in sections 5.4.1, 7.2.1, and 8.00 in ``Protein Quality 
Evaluation, Report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Consultation on Protein 
Quality Evaluation,'' Rome, 1990, except that when official AOAC 
procedures described in section (c)(7) of this paragraph require a 
specific food factor other than 6.25, that specific factor shall be 
used. The ``Report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Consultation on Protein 
Quality Evaluation'' as published by the Food and Agriculture 
Organization of the United Nations/World Health Organization is 
incorporated by reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 552(a) and 1 CFR 
part 51. Copies are available from the Center for Food Safety and 
Applied Nutrition (HFS-150), Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. 
SW., Washington, DC 20204, or may be inspected at the Office of the

[[Page 32]]

Federal Register, 800 North Capitol St. NW., suite 700, Washington, DC. 
For foods represented or purported for infants, the corrected amount of 
protein (grams) per serving is equal to the actual amount of protein 
(grams) per serving multiplied by the relative protein quality value. 
The relative protein quality value shall be determined by dividing the 
subject food protein PER value by the PER value for casein. If the 
relative protein value is above 1.00, it shall be set at 1.00.
    (iii) For the purpose of labeling with a percent of the Daily 
Reference Value (DRV) or RDI, a value of 50 grams of protein shall be 
the DRV for adults and children 4 or more years of age, and the RDI for 
protein for children less than 4 years of age, infants, pregnant women, 
and lactating women shall be 16 grams, 14 grams, 60 grams, and 65 grams, 
respectively.
    (8) Vitamins and minerals: A statement of the amount per serving of 
the vitamins and minerals as described in this paragraph, calculated as 
a percent of the RDI and expressed as percent of Daily Value.
    (i) For purposes of declaration of percent of Daily Value as 
provided for in paragraphs (d), (e), and (f) of this section, foods 
represented or purported to be for use by infants, children less than 4 
years of age, pregnant women, or lactating women shall use the RDI's 
that are specified for the intended group. For foods represented or 
purported to be for use by both infants and children under 4 years of 
age, the percent of Daily Value shall be presented by separate 
declarations according to paragraph (e) of this section based on the RDI 
values for infants from birth to 12 months of age and for children under 
4 years of age. Similarly, the percent of Daily Value based on both the 
RDI values for pregnant women and for lactating women shall be declared 
separately on foods represented or purported to be for use by both 
pregnant and lactating women. When such dual declaration is used on any 
label, it shall be included in all labeling, and equal prominence shall 
be given to both values in all such labeling. All other foods shall use 
the RDI for adults and children 4 or more years of age.
    (ii) The declaration of vitamins and minerals as a percent of the 
RDI shall include vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, and iron, in that 
order, and shall include any of the other vitamins and minerals listed 
in paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of this section when they are added as a 
nutrient supplement, or when a claim is made about them. Other vitamins 
and minerals need not be declared if neither the nutrient nor the 
component is otherwise referred to on the label or in labeling or 
advertising and the vitamins and minerals are:
    (A) Required or permitted in a standardized food (e.g., thiamin, 
riboflavin, and niacin in enriched flour) and that standardized food is 
included as an ingredient (i.e., component) in another food; or
    (B) Included in a food solely for technological purposes and 
declared only in the ingredient statement. The declaration may also 
include any of the other vitamins and minerals listed in paragraph 
(c)(8)(iv) of this section when they are naturally occurring in the 
food. The additional vitamins and minerals shall be listed in the order 
established in paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of this section.
    (iii) The percentages for vitamins and minerals shall be expressed 
to the nearest 2-percent increment up to and including the 10-percent 
level, the nearest 5-percent increment above 10 percent and up to and 
including the 50-percent level, and the nearest 10-percent increment 
above the 50-percent level. Amounts of vitamins and minerals present at 
less than 2 percent of the RDI are not required to be declared in 
nutrition labeling but may be declared by a zero or by the use of an 
asterisk (or other symbol) that refers to another asterisk (or symbol) 
that is placed at the bottom of the table and that is followed by the 
statement ``Contains less than 2 percent of the Daily Value of this 
(these) nutrient (nutrients).'' Alternatively, except as provided for in 
paragraph (f) of this section, if vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, or iron 
is present in amounts less than 2 percent of the RDI, label declaration 
of the nutrient(s) is not required if the statement ``Not a significant 
source of __________ (listing the vitamins or minerals omitted)'' is 
placed

[[Page 33]]

at the bottom of the table of nutrient values. Either statement shall be 
in the same type size as nutrients that are indented.
    (iv) The following RDI's and nomenclature are established for the 
following vitamins and minerals which are essential in human nutrition:

Vitamin A, 5,000 International Units
Vitamin C, 60 milligrams
Calcium, 1,000 milligrams
Iron, 18 milligrams
Vitamin D, 400 International Units
Vitamin E, 30 International Units
Vitamin K, 80 micrograms
Thiamin, 1.5 milligrams
Riboflavin, 1.7 milligrams
Niacin, 20 milligrams
Vitamin B6, 2.0 milligrams
Folate, 400 micrograms
Vitamin B12, 6 micrograms
Biotin, 300 micrograms
Pantothenic acid, 10 milligrams
Phosphorus, 1,000 milligrams
Iodine, 150 micrograms
Magnesium, 400 milligrams
Zinc, 15 milligrams
Selenium, 70 micrograms
Copper, 2.0 milligrams
Manganese, 2.0 milligrams
Chromium, 120 micrograms
Molybdenum, 75 micrograms
Chloride, 3,400 milligrams

    (v) The following synonyms may be added in parentheses immediately 
following the name of the nutrient or dietary component:

Vitamin C--Ascorbic acid
Thiamin--Vitamin B1
Riboflavin--Vitamin B2
Folate--either Folic acid or Folacin may be used.
Calories--Energy

    (vi) A statement of the percent of vitamin A that is present as 
beta-carotene may be declared voluntarily. When the vitamins and 
minerals are listed in a single column, the statement shall be indented 
under the information on vitamin A. When vitamins and minerals are 
arrayed horizontally, the statement of percent shall be presented in 
parenthesis following the declaration of vitamin A and the percent DV of 
vitamin A in the food (e.g., ``Percent Daily Value: Vitamin A 50 (90 
percent as beta-carotene)''). When declared, the percentages shall be 
expressed in the same increments as are provided for vitamins and 
minerals in paragraph (c)(8)(iii) of this section.
    (9) For the purpose of labeling with a percent of the DRV, the 
following DRV's are established for the following food components based 
on the reference caloric intake of 2,000 calories:

                                                                        
------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                        Unit of                         
         Food component               measurement             DRV       
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Fat.............................  gram (g)..........  65                
Saturated fatty acids...........  do................  20                
Cholesterol.....................  milligrams (mg)...  300               
Total carbohydrate..............  grams (g).........  300               
Fiber...........................  do................  25                
Sodium..........................  milligrams (mg)...  2,400             
Potassium.......................  do................  3,500             
Protein.........................  grams (g).........  50                
------------------------------------------------------------------------

    (d)(1) Nutrient information specified in paragraph (c) of this 
section shall be presented on foods in the following format, as shown in 
paragraph (d)(12) of this section, except on foods on which dual columns 
of nutrition information are declared as provided for in paragraph (e) 
of this section, on those food products on which the simplified format 
is required to be used as provided for in paragraph (f) of this section, 
on foods for infants and children less than 4 years of age as provided 
for in paragraph (j)(5) of this section, and on foods in small or 
intermediate-sized packages as provided for in paragraph (j)(13) of this 
section. In the interest of uniformity of presentation, FDA urges that 
the nutrition information be presented using the graphic specifications 
set forth in appendix B to part 101.
    (i) The nutrition information shall be set off in a box by use of 
hairlines and shall be all black or one color type, printed on a white 
or other neutral contrasting background whenever practical.
    (ii) All information within the nutrition label shall utilize:
    (A) A single easy-to-read type style,
    (B) Upper and lower case letters,
    (C) At least one point leading (i.e., space between two lines of 
text) except that at least four points leading shall be utilized for the 
information required by paragraphs (d)(7) and (d)(8) of this section as 
shown in paragraph (d)(12), and
    (D) Letters should never touch.
    (iii) Information required in paragraphs (d)(3), (d)(5), (d)(7), and 
(d)(8) of this section shall be in type size no smaller than 8 point. 
Except for the

[[Page 34]]

heading ``Nutrition Facts,'' the information required in paragraphs 
(d)(4), (d)(6), and (d)(9) of this section and all other information 
contained within the nutrition label shall be in type size no smaller 
than 6 point. When provided, the information described in paragraph 
(d)(10) of this section shall also be in type no smaller than 6 point.
    (iv) The headings required by paragraphs (d)(2), (d)(4), and (d)(6) 
of this section (i.e., ``Nutrition Facts,'' ``Amount per Serving,'' and 
``% Daily Value*''), the names of all nutrients that are not indented 
according to requirements of paragraph (c) of this section (i.e., 
``Calories,'' ``Total Fat,'' ``Cholesterol,'' ``Sodium,'' ``Total 
Carbohydrate,'' and ``Protein''), and the percentage amounts required by 
paragraph (d)(7)(ii) of this section shall be highlighted by bold or 
extra bold type or other highlighting (reverse printing is not permitted 
as a form of highlighting) that prominently distinguishes it from other 
information. No other information shall be highlighted.
    (v) A hairline rule that is centered between the lines of text shall 
separate ``Amount Per Serving'' from the calorie statements required in 
paragraph (d)(5) of this section and shall separate each nutrient and 
its corresponding percent Daily Value required in paragraphs (d)(7)(i) 
and (d)(7)(ii) of this section from the nutrient and percent Daily Value 
above and below it, as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this section.
    (2) The information shall be presented under the identifying heading 
of ``Nutrition Facts'' which shall be set in a type size larger than all 
other print size in the nutrition label and, except for labels presented 
according to the format provided for in paragraph (d)(11) of this 
section, unless impractical, shall be set the full width of the 
information provided under paragraph (d)(7) of this section, as shown in 
paragraph (d)(12) of this section.
    (3) Information on serving size shall immediately follow the heading 
as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this section. Such information shall 
include:
    (i) ``Serving Size'': A statement of the serving size as specified 
in paragraph (b)(7) of this section.
    (ii) ``Servings Per Container'': The number of servings per 
container, except that this statement is not required on single serving 
containers as defined in paragraph (b)(6) of this section or on other 
food containers when this information is stated in the net quantity of 
contents declaration.
    (4) A subheading ``Amount Per Serving'' shall be separated from 
serving size information by a bar as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this 
section.
    (5) Information on calories shall immediately follow the heading 
``Amount Per Serving'' and shall be declared in one line, leaving 
sufficient space between the declaration of ``Calories'' and ``Calories 
from fat'' to allow clear differentiation, or, if ``Calories from 
saturated fat'' is declared, in a column with total ``Calories'' at the 
top, followed by ``Calories from fat'' (indented), and ``Calories from 
saturated fat'' (indented).
    (6) The column heading ``% Daily Value,'' followed by an asterisk 
(e.g., ``% Daily Value*''), shall be separated from information on 
calories by a bar as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this section. The 
position of this column heading shall allow for a list of nutrient names 
and amounts as described in paragraph (d)(7) of this section to be to 
the left of, and below, this column heading. The column headings 
``Percent Daily Value,'' ``Percent DV,'' or ``% DV'' may be substituted 
for ``% Daily Value.''
    (7) Except as provided for in paragraph (j)(13) of this section, 
nutrient information for both mandatory and any voluntary nutrients 
listed in paragraph (c) of this section that are to be declared in the 
nutrition label, except vitamins and minerals, shall be declared as 
follows:
    (i) The name of each nutrient, as specified in paragraph (c) of this 
section, shall be given in a column and followed immediately by the 
quantitative amount by weight for that nutrient appended with a ``g'' 
for grams or ``mg'' for milligrams as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this 
section.
    (ii) A listing of the percent of the DRV as established in 
paragraphs (c)(7)(iii) and (c)(9) of this section shall be given in a 
column aligned under the heading ``% Daily Value'' established

[[Page 35]]

in paragraph (d)(6) of this section with the percent expressed to the 
nearest whole percent for each nutrient declared in the column described 
in paragraph (d)(7)(i) of this section for which a DRV has been 
established, except that the percent for protein may be omitted as 
provided in paragraph (c)(7) of this section. The percent shall be 
calculated by dividing either the amount declared on the label for each 
nutrient or the actual amount of each nutrient (i.e., before rounding) 
by the DRV for the nutrient, except that the percent for protein shall 
be calculated as specified in paragraph (c)(7)(ii) of this section. The 
numerical value shall be followed by the symbol for percent (i.e., %).
    (8) Nutrient information for vitamins and minerals shall be 
separated from information on other nutrients by a bar and shall be 
arrayed horizontally (e.g., Vitamin A 4%, Vitamin C 2%, Calcium 15%, 
Iron 4%) or may be listed in two columns as shown in paragraph (d)(12) 
of this section, except that when more than four vitamins and minerals 
are declared, they may be declared vertically with percentages listed 
under the column headed ``% Daily Value.''
    (9) A footnote, preceded by an asterisk, shall be placed beneath the 
list of vitamins and minerals and shall be separated from that list by a 
hairline.
    (i) The footnote shall state:
    Percent Daily Values are based on a 2,000 calorie diet.
    Your daily values may be higher or lower depending on your calorie 
needs.

------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                   Calories:       2,000        2,500   
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total fat.....................  Less than.....  65 g         80 g       
Saturated fat.................  Less than.....  20 g         25 g       
Cholesterol...................  Less than.....  300 mg       300 mg     
Sodium........................  Less than.....  2,400 mg     2,400 mg   
Total carbohydrate............  ..............  300 g        375 g      
Dietary fiber.................  ..............  25 g         30 g       
------------------------------------------------------------------------

    (ii) If the percent of Daily Value is given for protein in the 
Percent of Daily Value column as provided in paragraph (d)(7)(ii) of 
this section, protein shall be listed under dietary fiber, and a value 
of 50 g shall be inserted on the same line in the column headed 
``2,000'' and a value of 65 g in the column headed ``2,500''.
    (iii) If potassium is declared in the column described in paragraph 
(d)(7)(i) of this section, potassium shall be listed under sodium and 
the DRV established in paragraph (c)(9) of this section shall be 
inserted on the same line in the numeric columns.
    (iv) The abbreviations established in paragraph (j)(13)(ii)(B) of 
this section may be used within the footnote.
    (10) Caloric conversion information on a per gram basis for fat, 
carbohydrate, and protein may be presented beneath the information 
required in paragraph (d)(9) of this section, separated from that 
information by a hairline. This information may be presented 
horizontally as shown in paragraph (d)(12) of this section (i.e., 
``Calories per gram: fat 9, carbohydrate 4, protein 4'') or vertically 
in columns.
    (11)(i) If the space beneath the information on vitamins and 
minerals is not adequate to accommodate the information required in 
paragraph (d)(9) of this section, the information required in paragraph 
(d)(9) may be moved to the right of the column required in paragraph 
(d)(7)(ii) of this section and set off by a line that distinguishes it 
and sets it apart from the percent Daily Value information. The caloric 
conversion information provided for in paragraph (d)(10) of this section 
may be presented beneath either side or along the full length of the 
nutrition label.
    (ii) If the space beneath the mandatory declaration of iron is not 
adequate to accommodate any remaining vitamins and minerals to be 
declared or the information required in paragraph (d)(9) of this 
section, the remaining information may be moved to the right and set off 
by a line that distinguishes it and sets it apart from the nutrients and 
the percent DV information given to the left. The caloric conversion 
information provided for in paragraph (d)(10) of this section may be 
presented beneath either side or along the full length of the nutrition 
label.
    (iii) If there is not sufficient continuous vertical space (i.e., 
approximately 3 in) to accommodate the required components of the 
nutrition label up to and including the mandatory declaration of iron, 
the nutrition label may be presented in a tabular display as shown 
below.

[[Page 36]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.351



[[Page 37]]

    (12) The following sample label illustrates the provisions of 
paragraph (d) of this section.
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.352


[[Page 38]]


    (13)(i) Nutrition labels on the outer label of packages of products 
that contain two or more separately packaged foods that are intended to 
be eaten individually (e.g., variety packs of cereals or snack foods) or 
of packages that are used interchangeably for the same type of food 
(e.g., round ice cream containers) may use an aggregate display.
    (ii) Aggregate displays shall comply with the format requirements of 
paragraph (d) of this section to the maximum extent possible, except 
that the identity of each food shall be specified immediately under the 
``Nutrition Facts'' title, and both the quantitative amount by weight 
(i.e., g/mg amounts) and the percent Daily Value for each nutrient shall 
be listed in separate columns under the name of each food. The following 
sample label illustrates an aggregate display.
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.353

    (14) In accordance with Sec. 101.15(c)(2), when nutrition labeling 
must appear in a second language, the nutrition information may be 
presented in a separate nutrition label for each language or in one 
nutrition label with the information in the second language following 
that in English. Numeric characters that are identical in both languages 
need not be repeated (e.g., ``Protein/Proteinas 2 g''). All required 
information must be included in both languages.
    (e) Nutrition information may be presented for two or more forms of 
the same food (e.g., both ``as purchased'' and ``as prepared'') or for 
common combinations of food as provided for in paragraph (h)(4) of this 
section, for different units (e.g., slices of bread or per

[[Page 39]]

100 grams) as provided for in paragraph (b) of this section, or for two 
or more groups for which RDI's are established (e.g., both infants and 
children less than 4 years of age) as shown in paragraph (e)(5) of this 
section. When such dual labeling is provided, equal prominence shall be 
given to both sets of values. Information shall be presented in a format 
consistent with paragraph (d) of this section, except that:
    (1) Following the subheading of ``Amount Per Serving,'' there shall 
be two or more column headings accurately describing the forms of the 
same food (e.g., ``Mix'' and ``Baked''), the combinations of food, the 
units, or the RDI groups that are being declared. The column 
representing the product as packaged and according to the label serving 
size based on the reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b) shall be to the 
left of the numeric columns.
    (2) When the dual labeling is presented for two or more forms of the 
same food, for combinations of food, or for different units, total 
calories and calories from fat (and calories from saturated fat, when 
declared) shall be listed in a column and indented as specified in 
paragraph (d)(5) of this section with quantitative amounts declared in 
columns aligned under the column headings set forth in paragraph (e)(1) 
of this section.
    (3) Quantitative information by weight required in paragraph 
(d)(7)(i) of this section shall be specified for the form of the product 
as packaged and according to the label serving size based on the 
reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b).
    (i) Quantitative information by weight may be included for other 
forms of the product represented by the additional column(s) either 
immediately adjacent to the required quantitative information by weight 
for the product as packaged and according to the label serving size 
based on the reference amount in Sec. 101.12(b) or as a footnote.
    (A) If such additional quantitative information is given immediately 
adjacent to the required quantitative information, it shall be declared 
for all nutrients listed and placed immediately following and 
differentiated from the required quantitative information (e.g., 
separated by a comma). Such information shall not be put in a separate 
column.
    (B) If such additional quantitative information is given in a 
footnote, it shall be declared in the same order as the nutrients are 
listed in the nutrition label. The additional quantitative information 
may state the total nutrient content of the product identified in the 
second column or the nutrient amounts added to the product as packaged 
for only those nutrients that are present in different amounts than the 
amounts declared in the required quantitative information. The footnote 
shall clearly identify which amounts are declared. Any subcomponents 
declared shall be listed parenthetically after principal components 
(e.g., 1/2 cup skim milk contributes an additional 40 calories, 65 mg 
sodium, 6 g total carbohydrate (6 g sugars), and 4 g protein).
    (ii) Total fat and its quantitative amount by weight shall be 
followed by an asterisk (or other symbol) (e.g., ``Total fat (2 g)*'') 
referring to another asterisk (or symbol) at the bottom of the nutrition 
label identifying the form(s) of the product for which quantitative 
information is presented.
    (4) Information required in paragraphs (d)(7)(ii) and (d)(8) of this 
section shall be presented under the subheading ``% DAILY VALUE'' and in 
columns directly under the column headings set forth in paragraph (e)(1) 
of this section.
    (5) The following sample label illustrates the provisions of 
paragraph (e) of this section:

[[Page 40]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.354


    (f) The declaration of nutrition information may be presented in the 
simplified format set forth herein when a food product contains 
insignificant amounts of seven or more of the following: Calories, total 
fat, saturated fat, cholesterol, sodium, total carbohydrate, dietary 
fiber, sugars, protein,

[[Page 41]]

vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, and iron; except that for foods intended 
for children less than 2 years of age to which Sec. 101.9(j)(5)(i) 
applies, nutrition information may be presented in the simplified format 
when a food product contains insignificant amounts of six or more of the 
following: Calories, total fat, sodium, total carbohydrate, dietary 
fiber, sugars, protein, vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, and iron.
    (1) An ``insignificant amount'' shall be defined as that amount that 
allows a declaration of zero in nutrition labeling, except that for 
total carbohydrate, dietary fiber, and protein, it shall be an amount 
that allows a declaration of ``less than 1 gram.''
    (2) The simplified format shall include information on the following 
nutrients:
    (i) Total calories, total fat, total carbohydrate, protein, and 
sodium;
    (ii) Calories from fat and any other nutrients identified in 
paragraph (f) of this section that are present in the food in more than 
insignificant amounts; and
    (iii) Any vitamins and minerals listed in paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of 
this section when they are required to be added as a nutrient supplement 
to foods for which a standard of identity exists.
    (iv) Any vitamins or minerals listed in paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of this 
section voluntarily added to the food as nutrient supplements.
    (3) Other nutrients that are naturally present in the food in more 
than insignificant amounts may be voluntarily declared as part of the 
simplified format.
    (4) If any nutrients are declared as provided in paragraphs 
(f)(2)(iii), (f)(2)(iv), or (f)(3) of this section as part of the 
simplified format or if any nutrition claims are made on the label or in 
labeling, the statement ``Not a significant source of ----------'' (with 
the blank filled in with the name(s) of any nutrient(s) identified in 
Sec. 101.9(f) and calories from fat that are present in insignificant 
amounts) shall be included at the bottom of the nutrition label.
    (5) Except as provided for in paragraphs (j)(5) and (j)(13) of this 
section, nutrient information declared in the simplified format shall be 
presented in the same manner as specified in paragraphs (d) or (e) of 
this section, except that the footnote required in paragraph (d)(9) of 
this section is not required. When the footnote is omitted, an asterisk 
shall be placed at the bottom of the label followed by the statement 
``Percent Daily Values are based on a 2,000 calorie diet'' and, if the 
term ``Daily Value'' is not spelled out in the heading, a statement that 
``DV'' represents ``Daily Value.''
    (g) Compliance with this section shall be determined as follows:
    (1) A collection of primary containers or units of the same size, 
type, and style produced under conditions as nearly uniform as possible, 
designated by a common container code or marking, or in the absence of 
any common container code or marking, a day's production, constitutes a 
``lot.''
    (2) The sample for nutrient analysis shall consist of a composite of 
12 subsamples (consumer units), taken 1 from each of 12 different 
randomly chosenshipping cases, to be representative of a lot. Unless a 
particular method of analysis is specified in paragraph (c) of this 
section, composites shall be analyzed by appropriate methods as given in 
the ``Official Methods of Analysis of the AOAC International,'' 15th Ed. 
(1990), which is incorporated by reference in accordance with 5 U.S.C. 
552(a) or 1 CFR part 51 or, if no AOAC method is available or 
appropriate, by other reliable and appropriate analytical procedures. 
The availability of this incorporation by reference is given in 
paragraph (c)(7) of this section.
    (3) Two classes of nutrients are defined for purposes of compliance:
    (i) Class I. Added nutrients in fortified or fabricated foods; and
    (ii) Class II. Naturally occurring (indigenous) nutrients. If any 
ingredient which contains a naturally occurring (indigenous) nutrient is 
added to a food, the total amount of such nutrient in the final food 
product is subject to class II requirements unless the same nutrient is 
also added.
    (4) A food with a label declaration of a vitamin, mineral, protein, 
total carbohydrate, dietary fiber, other carbohydrate, polyunsaturated 
or monounsaturated fat, or potassium shall be deemed to be misbranded 
under section 403(a) of the Federal

[[Page 42]]

Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act) unless it meets the following 
requirements:
    (i) Class I vitamin, mineral, protein, dietary fiber, or potassium. 
The nutrient content of the composite is at least equal to the value for 
that nutrient declared on the label.
    (ii) Class II vitamin, mineral, protein, total carbohydrate, dietary 
fiber, other carbohydrate, polyunsaturated or monounsaturated fat, or 
potassium. The nutrient content of the composite is at least equal to 80 
percent of the value for that nutrient declared on the label.
    Provided, That no regulatory action will be based on a determination 
of a nutrient value that falls below this level by a factor less than 
the variability generally recognized for the analytical method used in 
that food at the level involved.
    (5) A food with a label declaration of calories, sugars, total fat, 
saturated fat, cholesterol, or sodium shall be deemed to be misbranded 
under section 403(a) of the act if the nutrient content of the composite 
is greater than 20 percent in excess of the value for that nutrient 
declared on the label. Provided, That no regulatory action will be based 
on a determination of a nutrient value that falls above this level by a 
factor less than the variability generally recognized for the analytical 
method used in that food at the level involved.
    (6) Reasonable excesses of a vitamin, mineral, protein, total 
carbohydrate, dietary fiber, other carbohydrate, polyunsaturated or 
monounsaturated fat, or potassium over labeled amounts are acceptable 
within current good manufacturing practice. Reasonable deficiencies of 
calories, sugars, total fat, saturated fat, cholesterol, or sodium under 
labeled amounts are acceptable within current good manufacturing 
practice.
    (7) Compliance will be based on the metric measure specified in the 
label statement of serving size.
    (8) Compliance with the provisions set forth in paragraphs (g)(1) 
through (g)(6) of this section may be provided by use of an FDA approved 
data base that has been computed following FDA guideline procedures and 
where food samples have been handled in accordance with current good 
manufacturing practice to prevent nutrition loss. FDA approval of a data 
base shall not be considered granted until the Center for Food Safety 
and Applied Nutrition has agreed to all aspects of the data base in 
writing. The approval will be granted where a clear need is presented 
(e.g., raw produce and seafood). Approvals will be in effect for a 
limited time, e.g., 10 years, and will be eligible for renewal in the 
absence of significant changes in agricultural or industry practices. 
Approval requests shall be submitted in accordance with the provisions 
of Sec. 10.30 of this chapter. Guidance in the use of data bases may be 
found in the ``FDA Nutrition Labeling Manual--A Guide for Developing and 
Using Data Bases,'' available from the Office of Food Labeling (HFS-
150), Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food and Drug 
Administration, 200 C St. SW., Washington, DC 20204.
    (9) When it is not technologically feasible, or some other 
circumstance makes it impracticable, for firms to comply with the 
requirements of this section (e.g., to develop adequate nutrient 
profiles to comply with the requirements of paragraph (c) of this 
section), FDA may permit alternative means of compliance or additional 
exemptions to deal with the situation. Firms in need of such special 
allowances shall make their request in writing to the Center for Food 
Safety and Applied Nutrition (HFS-150), Food and Drug Administration, 
200 C St. SW., Washington, DC 20204.
    (h) Products with separately packaged ingredients or foods, with 
assortments of food, or to which other ingredients are added by the user 
may be labeled as follows:
    (1) If a product consists of two or more separately packaged 
ingredients enclosed in an outer container or of assortments of the same 
type of food (e.g., assorted nuts or candy mixtures) in the same retail 
package, nutrition labeling shall be located on the outer container or 
retail package (as the case may be) to provide information for the 
consumer at the point of purchase. However, when two or more food 
products are simply combined together in such a manner that no outer 
container is used, or no outer label is available,

[[Page 43]]

each product shall have its own nutrition information, e.g., two boxes 
taped together or two cans combined in a clear plastic overwrap. When 
separately packaged ingredients or assortments of the same type of food 
are intended to be eaten at the same time, the nutrition information may 
be specified per serving for each component or as a composite value.
    (2) If a product consists of two or more separately packaged foods 
that are intended to be eaten individually and that are enclosed in an 
outer container (e.g., variety packs of cereals or snack foods), the 
nutrition information shall:
    (i) Be specified per serving for each food in a location that is 
clearly visible to the consumer at the point of purchase; and
    (ii) Be presented in separate nutrition labels or in one aggregate 
nutrition label with separate columns for the quantitative amount by 
weight and the percent Daily Value for each food.
    (3) If a package contains a variety of foods, or an assortment of 
foods, and is in a form intended to be used as a gift, the nutrition 
labeling shall be in the form required by paragraphs (a) through (f) of 
this section, but it may be modified as follows:
    (i) Nutrition information may be presented on the label of the outer 
package or in labeling within or attached to the outer package.
    (ii) In the absence of a reference amount customarily consumed in 
Sec. 101.12(b) that is appropriate for the variety or assortment of 
foods in a gift package, 1 ounce for solid foods, 2 fluid ounces for 
nonbeverage liquids (e.g., syrups), and 8 fluid ounces for beverages may 
be used as the standard serving size for purposes of nutrition labeling 
of foods subject to this paragraph. However, the reference amounts 
customarily consumed in Sec. 101.12(b) shall be used for purposes of 
evaluating whether individual foods in a gift package qualify for 
nutrient content claims or health claims.
    (iii) The number of servings per container may be stated as 
``varied.''
    (iv) Nutrition information may be provided per serving for 
individual foods in the package, or, alternatively, as a composite per 
serving for reasonable categories of foods in the package having similar 
dietary uses and similar significant nutritional characteristics. 
Reasonable categories of foods may be used only if accepted by FDA. In 
determining whether a proposed category is reasonable, FDA will consider 
whether the values of the characterizing nutrients in the foods proposed 
to be in the category meet the compliance criteria set forth in 
paragraphs (g)(3) through (g)(6) of this section. Proposals for such 
categories may be submitted in writing to the Office of Food Labeling 
(HFS-150), Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food and Drug 
Administration, 200 C St. SW., Washington, DC 20204.
    (v) If a food subject to paragraph (j)(13) of this section because 
of its small size is contained in a gift package, the food need not be 
included in the determination of nutrition information under paragraph 
(h) of this section if it is not specifically listed in a promotional 
catalogue as being present in the gift package, and:
    (A) It is used in small quantities primarily to enhance the 
appearance of the gift package; or
    (B) It is included in the gift package as a free gift or promotional 
item.
    (4) If a food is commonly combined with other ingredients or is 
cooked or otherwise prepared before eating, and directions for such 
combination or preparations are provided, another column of figures may 
be used to declare nutrition information on the basis of the food as 
consumed in the format required in paragraph (e) of this section (e.g., 
a dry ready-to-eat cereal may be described with one set of Percent Daily 
Values for the cereal as sold (e.g., per ounce), and another set for the 
cereal and milk as suggested in the label (e.g., per ounce of cereal and 
1/2 cup of vitamin D fortified skim milk); and a cake mix may be labeled 
with one set of Percent Daily Values for the dry mix (per serving) and 
another set for the serving of the final cake when prepared): Provided, 
That, the type and quantity of the other ingredients to be added to the 
product by the user and the specific method of cooking and other 
preparation shall be specified prominently on the label.

[[Page 44]]

    (i) Except as provided in paragraphs (j)(13) and (j)(17) of this 
section, the location of nutrition information on a label shall be in 
compliance with Sec. 101.2.
    (j) The following foods are exempt from this section or are subject 
to special labeling requirements:
    (1)(i) Food offered for sale by a manufacturer, packer, or 
distributor who has annual gross sales made or business done in sales to 
consumers that is not more than $500,000 or has annual gross sales made 
or business done in sales of food to consumers of not more than $50,000, 
Provided, That the food bears no nutrition claims or other nutrition 
information in any context on the label or in labeling or advertising. 
Claims or other nutrition information subject the food to the provisions 
of this section.
    (ii) For purposes of this paragraph, calculation of the amount of 
sales shall be based on the most recent 2-year average of business 
activity. Where firms have been in business less than 2 years, 
reasonable estimates must indicate that annual sales will not exceed the 
amounts specified. For foreign firms that ship foods into the United 
States, the business activities to be included shall be the total amount 
of food sales, as well as other sales to consumers, by the firm in the 
United States.
    (2) Food products which are:
    (i) Served in restaurants, Provided, That the food bears no 
nutrition claims or other nutrition information in any context on the 
label or in labeling or advertising. Claims or other nutrition 
information subject the food to the provisions of this section;
    (ii) Served in other establishments in which food is served for 
immediate human consumption (e.g., institutional food service 
establishments, such as schools, hospitals, and cafeterias; 
transportation carriers, such as trains and airplanes; bakeries, 
delicatessens, and retail confectionery stores where there are 
facilities for immediate consumption on the premises; food service 
vendors, such as lunch wagons, ice cream shops, mall cookie counters, 
vending machines, and sidewalk carts where foods are generally consumed 
immediately where purchased or while the consumer is walking away, 
including similar foods sold from convenience stores; and food delivery 
systems or establishments where ready-to-eat foods are delivered to 
homes or offices), Provided, That the food bears no nutrition claims or 
other nutrition information in any context on the label or in labeling 
or advertising. Claims or other nutrition information subject the food 
to the provisions of this section;
    (iii) Sold only in such facilities, Provided, That the food bears no 
nutrition claims or other nutrition information in any context on the 
label or in labeling or advertising. Claims or other nutrition 
information subject the food to the provisions of this section;
    (iv) Used only in such facilities and not served to the consumer in 
the package in which they are received (e.g., foods that are not 
packaged in individual serving containers); or
    (v) Sold by a distributor who principally sells food to such 
facilities: Provided, That:
    (A) This exemption shall not be available for those foods that are 
manufactured, processed, or repackaged by that distributor for sale to 
any persons other than restaurants or other establishments that serve 
food for immediate human consumption, and
    (B) The manufacturer of such products is responsible for providing 
the nutrition information on the products if there is a reasonable 
possibility that the product will be purchased directly by consumers.
    (3) Food products that are:
    (i) Of the type of food described in paragraphs (j)(2)(i) and 
(j)(2)(ii) of this section,
    (ii) Ready for human consumption,
    (iii) Offered for sale to consumers but not for immediate human 
consumption,
    (iv) Processed and prepared primarily in a retail establishment, and
    (v) Not offered for sale outside of that establishment (e.g., ready-
to-eat foods that are processed and prepared on-site and sold by 
independent delicatessens, bakeries, or retail confectionery stores 
where there are no facilities for immediate human consumption; by in-
store delicatessen, bakery, or candy departments; or at self-service 
food bars such as salad bars), Provided, That the food bears no 
nutrition

[[Page 45]]

claims or other nutrition information in any context on the label or in 
labeling or advertising. Claims or other nutrition information subject 
the food to the provisions of this section.
    (4) Foods that contain insignificant amounts of all of the nutrients 
and food components required to be included in the declaration of 
nutrition information under paragraph (c) of this section, Provided, 
That the food bears no nutrition claims or other nutrition information 
in any context on the label or in labeling or advertising. Claims or 
other nutrition information subject the food to the provisions of this 
section. An insignificant amount of a nutrient or food component shall 
be that amount that allows a declaration of zero in nutrition labeling, 
except that for total carbohydrate, dietary fiber, and protein, it shall 
be an amount that allows a declaration of ``less than 1 gram.'' Foods 
that are exempt under this paragraph include coffee beans (whole or 
ground), tea leaves, plain unsweetened instant coffee and tea, 
condiment-type dehydrated vegetables, flavor extracts, and food colors.
    (5)(i) Foods, other than infant formula, represented or purported to 
be specifically for infants and children less than 2 years of age shall 
bear nutrition labeling, except as provided in paragraph (j)(5)(ii) and 
except that such labeling shall not include calories from fat (paragraph 
(c)(1)(ii) of this section), calories from saturated fat ((c)(1)(iii)), 
saturated fat ((c)(2)(i)), polyunsaturated fat ((c)(2)(ii)), 
monounsaturated fat ((c)(2)(iii)), and cholesterol ((c)(3)).
    (ii) Foods, other than infant formula, represented or purported to 
be specifically for infants and children less than 4 years of age shall 
bear nutrition labeling, except that:
    (A) Such labeling shall not include declarations of percent of Daily 
Value for total fat, saturated fat, cholesterol, sodium, potassium, 
total carbohydrate, and dietary fiber;
    (B) Nutrient names and quantitative amounts by weight shall be 
presented in two separate columns.
    (C) The heading ``Percent Daily Value'' required in paragraph (d)(6) 
of this section shall be placed immediately below the quantitative 
information by weight for protein;
    (D) Percent of Daily Value for protein, vitamins, and minerals shall 
be listed immediately below the heading ``Percent Daily Value''; and
    (E) Such labeling shall not include the footnote specified in 
paragraph (d)(9) of this section.
    (6) Dietary supplements of vitamins or minerals that have an RDI as 
established in paragraph (c)(8)(iv) of this section or a DRV as 
established in paragraph (c)(9) of this section shall be labeled in 
compliance with Sec. 101.36, except that dietary supplements of vitamins 
or minerals in food in conventional form (e.g., breakfast cereals), of 
herbs, and of other similar nutritional substances shall conform to the 
labeling of this section.
    (7) Infant formula subject to section 412 of the act, as amended, 
except that such foods shall be labeled in compliance with part 107 of 
this chapter.
    (8) Medical foods as defined in section 5(b) of the Orphan Drug Act 
(21 U.S.C. 360ee(b)(3)). A medical food is a food which is formulated to 
be consumed or administered enterally under the supervision of a 
physician and which is intended for the specific dietary management of a 
disease or condition for which distinctive nutritional requirements, 
based on recognized scientific principles, are established by medical 
evaluation. A food is subject to this exemption only if:
    (i) It is a specially formulated and processed product (as opposed 
to a naturally occurring foodstuff used in its natural state) for the 
partial or exclusive feeding of a patient by means of oral intake or 
enteral feeding by tube;
    (ii) It is intended for the dietary management of a patient who, 
because of therapeutic or chronic medical needs, has limited or impaired 
capacity to ingest, digest, absorb, or metabolize ordinary foodstuffs or 
certain nutrients, or who has other special medically determined 
nutrient requirements, the dietary management of which cannot be 
achieved by the modification of the normal diet alone;
    (iii) It provides nutritional support specifically modified for the 
management of the unique nutrient needs that

[[Page 46]]

result from the specific disease or condition, as determined by medical 
evaluation;
    (iv) It is intended to be used under medical supervision; and
    (v) It is intended only for a patient receiving active and ongoing 
medical supervision wherein the patient requires medical care on a 
recurring basis for, among other things, instructions on the use of the 
medical food.
    (9) Food products shipped in bulk form that are not for distribution 
to consumers in such form and that are for use solely in the manufacture 
of other foods or that are to be processed, labeled, or repacked at a 
site other than where originally processed or packed.
    (10) Raw fruits, vegetables, and fish subject to section 403(q)(4) 
of the act, except that the labeling of such foods should adhere to 
guidelines in Sec. 101.45. This exemption is contingent on the food 
bearing no nutrition claims or other nutrition information in any 
context on the label or in labeling or advertising. Claims or other 
nutrition information subject the food to nutrition labeling in 
accordance with Sec. 101.45. The term ``fish'' includes freshwater or 
marine fin fish, crustaceans, and mollusks, including shellfish, 
amphibians, and other forms of aquatic animal life.
    (11) Packaged single-ingredient products that consist of fish or 
game meat (i.e., animal products not covered under the Federal Meat 
Inspection Act or the Poultry Products Inspection Act, such as flesh 
products from deer, bison, rabbit, quail, wild turkey, or ostrich) 
subject to this section may provide required nutrition information for a 
3-ounce cooked edible portion (i.e., on an ``as prepared'' basis), 
except that:
    (i) Such products that make claims that are based on values as 
packaged must provide nutrition information on an as packaged basis, and
    (ii) Nutrition information is not required for custom processed fish 
or game meats.
    (12) Game meats (i.e., animal products not covered under the Federal 
Meat Inspection Act or the Poultry Products Inspection Act, such as 
flesh products from deer, bison, rabbit, quail, wild turkey, or ostrich) 
may provide required nutrition information on labeling in accordance 
with the provisions of paragraph (a)(2) of this section.
    (13)(i) Foods in small packages that have a total surface area 
available to bear labeling of less than 12 square inches, Provided, That 
the labels for these foods bear no nutrition claims or other nutrition 
information in any context on the label or in labeling or advertising. 
Claims or other nutrition information subject the food to the provisions 
of this section.
    (A) The manufacturer, packer, or distributor shall provide on the 
label of packages that qualify for and use this exemption an address or 
telephone number that a consumer can use to obtain the required 
nutrition information (e.g., ``For nutrition information, call 1-800-
123-4567'').
    (B) When such products bear nutrition labeling, either voluntarily 
or because nutrition claims or other nutrition information is provided, 
all required information shall be in type size no smaller than 6 point 
or all uppercase type of 1/16 inches minimum height, except that 
individual serving-size packages of food served with meals in 
restaurants, institutions, and on board passenger carriers, and not 
intended for sale at retail, may comply with Sec. 101.2(c)(5).
    (ii) Foods in packages that have a total surface area available to 
bear labeling of 40 or less square inches may modify the requirements of 
paragraphs (c) through (f) and (i) of this section by one or more of the 
following means:
    (A) Presenting the required nutrition information in a tabular or, 
as provided below, linear (i.e., string) fashion rather than in vertical 
columns if the product has a total surface area available to bear 
labeling of less than 12 square inches, or if the product has a total 
surface area available to bear labeling of 40 or less square inches and 
the package shape or size cannot accommodate a standard vertical column 
or tabular display on any label panel. Nutrition information may be 
given in a linear fashion only if the label will not accommodate a 
tabular display.
    (1) The following sample label illustrates the tabular display.

[[Page 47]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.355


    (2) The following sample label illustrates the linear display. When 
nutrition information is given in a linear fashion, bolding is required 
only on the title ``Nutrition Facts`` and is allowed voluntarily for the 
nutrient names for ``Calories,'' ``Total fat,'' ``Cholesterol,'' 
``Sodium,'' ``Total carbohydrate,'' and ``Protein.''
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.356

    (B) Using any of the following abbreviations:
Serving size--Serv size
Servings per container--Servings
Calories from fat--Fat cal
Calories from saturated fat--Sat fat cal
Saturated fat--Sat fat
Monounsaturated fat--Monounsat fat
Polyunsaturated fat--Polyunsat fat
Cholesterol--Cholest
Total carbohydrate--Total carb
Dietary fiber--Fiber
Soluble fiber--Sol fiber
Insoluble fiber--Insol fiber
Sugar alcohol--Sugar alc
Other carbohydrate--Other carb
    (C) Omitting the footnote required in paragraph (d)(9) of this 
section and placing another asterisk at the bottom of the label followed 
by the statement ``Percent Daily Values are based on a 2,000 calorie 
diet`` and, if the term ``Daily Value'' is not spelled out in the 
heading, a statement that ``DV'' represents ``Daily Value.''
    (D) Presenting the required nutrition information on any label 
panel.
    (14) Shell eggs packaged in a carton that has a top lid designed to 
conform to the shape of the eggs are exempt from outer carton label 
requirements where the required nutrition information is clearly 
presented immediately beneath the carton lid or in an insert that can be 
clearly seen when the carton is opened.
    (15) The unit containers in a multiunit retail food package where:
    (i) The multiunit retail food package labeling contains all 
nutrition information in accordance with the requirements of this 
section;
    (ii) The unit containers are securely enclosed within and not 
intended to be separated from the retail package under conditions of 
retail sale; and
    (iii) Each unit container is labeled with the statement ``This Unit 
Not Labeled For Retail Sale'' in type size not less than 1/16-inch in 
height, except that this statement shall not be required when the inner 
unit containers

[[Page 48]]

bear no labeling at all. The word ``individual'' may be used in lieu of 
or immediately preceding the word ``Retail'' in the statement.
    (16) Food products sold from bulk containers: Provided, That 
nutrition information required by this section be displayed to consumers 
either on the labeling of the bulk container plainly in view or in 
accordance with the provisions of paragraph (a)(2) of this section.
    (17) Foods in packages that have a total surface area available to 
bear labeling greater than 40 square inches but whose principal display 
panel and information panel do not provide sufficient space to 
accommodate all required information may use any alternate panel that 
can be readily seen by consumers for the nutrition label. The space 
needed for vignettes, designs, and other nonmandatory label information 
on the principal display panel may be considered in determining the 
sufficiency of available space on the principal display panel for the 
placement of the nutrition label. Nonmandatory label information on the 
information panel shall not be considered in determining the sufficiency 
of available space for the placement of the nutrition label.
    (k) A food labeled under the provisions of this section shall be 
deemed to be misbranded under sections 201(n) and 403(a) of the act if 
its label or labeling represents, suggests, or implies:
    (1) That the food, because of the presence or absence of certain 
dietary properties, is adequate or effective in the prevention, cure, 
mitigation, or treatment of any disease or symptom. Information about 
the relationship of a dietary property to a disease or health-related 
condition may only be provided in conformance with the requirements of 
Sec. 101.14 and part 101, subpart E.
    (2) That a balanced diet of ordinary foods cannot supply adequate 
amounts of nutrients.
    (3) That the lack of optimum nutritive quality of a food, by reason 
of the soil on which that food was grown, is or may be responsible for 
an inadequacy or deficiency in the quality of the daily diet.
    (4) That the storage, transportation, processing, or cooking of a 
food is or may be responsible for an inadequacy or deficiency in the 
quality of the daily diet.
    (5) That the food has dietary properties when such properties are of 
no significant value or need in human nutrition.
    (6) That a natural vitamin in a food is superior to an added or 
synthetic vitamin or to differentiate in any way between vitamins 
naturally present from those added.

[58 FR 2175, Jan. 6, 1993, as amended at 58 FR 2227, 2533, Jan. 6, 1993; 
58 FR 17104, Apr. 1, 1993; 58 FR 17328-17331, Apr. 2, 1993; 58 FR 44048, 
44076, Aug. 18, 1993; 58 FR 59363, Nov. 9, 1993; 58 FR 60109, Nov. 15, 
1993; 59 FR 371, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 62317, Dec. 5, 1994; 60 FR 17205, 
Apr. 5, 1995; 60 FR 30788, June 12, 1995; 60 FR 67174, Dec. 28, 1995; 61 
FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996; 61 FR 14479, Apr. 2, 1996]

    Effective Date Notes: 1. At 60 FR 67174, Dec. 28, 1995, in 
Sec. 101.9, paragraph (c)(8)(iv) was revised, effective January 1, 1997. 
For the convenience of the reader, the superseded text is set forth 
below.
Sec. 101.9  Nutrition labeling of food.

                                * * * * *

    (c) * * *
    (8) * * *
    (iv) The following RDI's and nomenclature are established for the 
following vitamins and minerals which are essential in human nutrition:

Vitamin A, 5,000 International Units.
Vitamin C, 60 milligrams.
Calcium, 1.0 gram.
Iron, 18 milligrams.
Vitamin D, 400 International Units.
Vitamin E, 30 International Units.
Thiamin, 1.5 milligrams.
Riboflavin, 1.7 milligrams.
Niacin, 20 milligrams.
Vitamin B6, 2.0 milligrams.
Folate, 0.4 milligrams.
Vitamin B12, 6.0 micrograms.
Biotin, 0.3 milligram.
Pantothenic acid, 10 milligrams.
Phosphorus, 1.0 gram.
Iodine, 150 micrograms.
Magnesium, 400 milligrams.
Zinc, 15 milligrams.
Copper, 2.0 milligrams.

                                * * * * *

    2. At 61 FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996, in Sec. 101.9, in paragraph 
(c)(8)(v) the entry which read ``Folate--Folacin'' was revised to read 
as set forth above in the text, effective April 19, 1996.

[[Page 49]]



Sec. 101.10  Nutrition labeling of restaurant foods.

    Nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9 shall be provided 
upon request for any restaurant food or meal for which a nutrient 
content claim (as defined in Sec. 101.13 or in subpart D of this part) 
or a health claim (as defined in Sec. 101.14 and permitted by a 
regulation in subpart E of this part) is made (except on menus). Except: 
That information on the nutrient amounts that are the basis for the 
claim (e.g., ``low fat,'' this meal provides less than 10 grams of fat) 
may serve as the functional equivalent of complete nutrition information 
as described in Sec. 101.9. Nutrient levels may be determined by 
nutrient data bases, cookbooks, or analyses or by other reasonable bases 
that provide assurance that the food or meal meets the nutrient 
requirements for the claim. Presentation of nutrition labeling may be in 
various forms, including those provided in Sec. 101.45 and other 
reasonable means.

[58 FR 2410, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17341, Apr. 2, 1993]



Sec. 101.11  Saccharin and its salts; retail establishment notice.

    Each retail establishment (except restaurants) that sells food that 
contains saccharin shall display the following notice in the locations 
set forth in paragraph (b) of this section:
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.357

Each notice shall be displayed prominently, in a manner highly visible 
to consumers (e.g., not shielded by other store signs or merchandise 
displays) and set up to reduce the likelihood

[[Page 50]]

that a notice will be torn, defaced, or removed.
    (a) The notice shall be printed in a combination of red and black 
ink on white card stock and be at least 11 by 14 inches. The background 
of the bold heading, ``Saccharin Notice,'' and the boxed warning 
statement shall be bright red and the lettering, white. The remaining 
background shall be white with black ink. All lettering shall be in 
gothic typeface.
    (b) Except as provided in paragraph (c) of this section, each retail 
establishment that sells food that contains saccharin shall display a 
notice in each of the following three locations:
    (1) Near the entrance to the retail establishment and arranged so 
that consumers are likely to see the notice upon entering.
    (2) Centrally located in the area of the retail establishment in 
which soft drinks containing saccharin are displayed. If there is more 
than one such place, then in the area where the greatest quantity of 
diet soft drinks are displayed.
    (3) In the area in the establishment in which the largest quantity 
of saccharin-containing foods (including saccharin sold in package form 
as a sugar substitute) are displayed, other than the area where diet 
soft drinks are displayed.
    (c) The following are exceptions to the requirements set forth in 
paragraph (b) of this section:
    (1) A retail establishment with 3,200 square feet or less of floor 
space shall display at least one notice. The notice shall be located 
near the entrance to the retail establishment and arranged so that 
consumers are likely to see the notice upon entering.
    (2) A retail establishment with more than 3,200 but less than 10,000 
square feet of floor space shall display at least two notices. The first 
notice shall be located near the entrance to the retail establishment 
and arranged so that consumers are likely to see the notice upon 
entering. The second notice shall be centrally located in the area of 
the retail establishment in which soft drinks containing saccharin are 
displayed. If there is more than one such place, then in the area where 
the greatest quantity of diet soft drinks are displayed. If diet soft 
drinks are not sold, then in the area of the establishment in which the 
largest quantity of saccharin-containing foods (including saccharin sold 
in package form as a sugar substitute) are displayed.
    (3) A large retail establishment, e.g., department store, whose 
primary business consists of selling nonfood items (i.e., the proportion 
of food sold is extremely small compared to other items) shall display 
at least one notice. The notice shall be located in the area of the 
establishment in which foods containing saccharin are displayed. If 
there is more than one such area, then a notice shall be displayed in 
each area.
    (d) Each manufacturer of saccharin-containing food who customarily 
delivers his products directly to retail establishments shall make 
available at least three notices to each retail establishment in which 
his products are sold. Each manufacturer shall also arrange to supply 
additional notices to a retail establishment that asks for them.
    (e) Manufacturers who do not customarily deliver their saccharin-
containing food products directly to retail establishments may fulfill 
their obligation to provide notices either in the manner set forth in 
paragraph (d) of this section or by participating in, and performing the 
actions required by, a trade association coordinated program that meets 
the following requirements:
    (1) The coordinating association shall have filed notice of the 
program with the Food and Drug Administration, including the 
association's name, mailing address, telephone number, and contact 
person.
    (2) Each manufacturer participating in the program shall file notice 
of its participation with the coordinating association, including its 
name, mailing address, telephone number, and contact person.
    (3) The association shall ensure that retail establishment notices, 
in the form specified in this section, are readily available to 
participating manufacturers.
    (4) The association shall take affirmative steps to coordinate with 
retail establishments, their trade associations,

[[Page 51]]

and the trade press to disseminate information about the applicable 
requirements of the Saccharin Study and Labeling Act and these 
regulations, the existence of the association coordinated program, and 
the availability of notices through the program.
    (5) Each manufacturer shall, in consultation with the association, 
communicate with its contacts in the distributional chain to inform them 
of the applicable requirements of the Saccharin Study and Labeling Act 
and these regulations, and the continued availability of notices.
    (6) Each manufacturer shall ensure that notices are promptly 
provided on request to any retail establishment carrying its products.
    (7) The association shall consult with participating manufacturers 
concerning the implementation and progress of the program and shall 
disseminate information to facilitate the conduct of the program based 
on such consultations or consultation with the Food and Drug 
Administration.
    (8) The association shall, on request, permit the Food and Drug 
Administration to have access to the participation notices filed by 
manufacturers, samples showing the form of retail establishment notices 
made available, and typical communication materials used by the 
association in the course of the program.

[43 FR 8795, Mar. 3, 1978]



Sec. 101.12  Reference amounts customarily consumed per eating occasion.

    (a) The general principles and factors that the Food and Drug 
Administration (FDA) considered in arriving at the reference amounts 
customarily consumed per eating occasion (reference amounts) which are 
set forth in paragraph (b) of this section, are that:
    (1) FDA calculated the reference amounts for persons 4 years of age 
or older to reflect the amount of food customarily consumed per eating 
occasion by persons in this population group. These reference amounts 
are based on data set forth in appropriate national food consumption 
surveys.
    (2) FDA calculated the reference amounts for an infant or child 
under 4 years of age to reflect the amount of food customarily consumed 
per eating occasion by infants up to 12 months of age or by children 1 
through 3 years of age, respectively. These reference amounts are based 
on data set forth in appropriate national food consumption surveys. Such 
reference amounts are to be used only when the food is specially 
formulated or processed for use by an infant or by a child under 4 years 
of age.
    (3) An appropriate national food consumption survey includes a large 
sample size representative of the demographic and socioeconomic 
characteristics of the relevant population group and must be based on 
consumption data under actual conditions of use.
    (4) To determine the amount of food customarily consumed per eating 
occasion, FDA considered the mean, median, and mode of the consumed 
amount per eating occasion.
    (5) When survey data were insufficient, FDA took various other 
sources of information on serving sizes of food into consideration. 
These other sources of information included:
    (i) Serving sizes used in dietary guidance recommendations or 
recommended by other authoritative systems or organizations;
    (ii) Serving sizes recommended in comments;
    (iii) Serving sizes used by manufacturers and grocers; and
    (iv) Serving sizes used by other countries.
    (6) Because they reflect the amount customarily consumed, the 
reference amount and, in turn, the serving size declared on the product 
label are based on only the edible portion of food, and not bone, seed, 
shell, or other inedible components.
    (7) The reference amount is based on the major intended use of the 
food (e.g., milk as a beverage and not as an addition to cereal).
    (8) The reference amounts for products that are consumed as an 
ingredient of other foods, but that may also be consumed in the form in 
which they are purchased (e.g., butter), are based on use in the form 
purchased.
    (9) FDA sought to ensure that foods that have similar dietary usage, 
product characteristics, and customarily consumed amounts have a uniform 
reference amount.

[[Page 52]]

    (b) The following reference amounts shall be used as the basis for 
determining serving sizes for specific products:

  Table 1.--Reference Amounts Customarily Consumed Per Eating Occasion: 
                    Infant and Toddler Foods 1,2,3,4                    
------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Product category          Reference amount      Label statement5  
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Cereals, dry instant........  15 g................  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g)                 
Cereals, prepared, ready-to-  110 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
 serve.                                               g)                
Other cereal and grain        7 g for infants and   ------ cup(s) (------
 products, dry ready-to-eat,   20 g for toddlers      g) for ready-to-  
 e.g., ready-to-eat cereals,   for ready-to-eat      eat cereals; ------
 cookies, teething biscuits,   cereals; 7 g for      piece(s) (------ g)
 and toasts.                   all others.           for others         
Dinners, desserts, fruits,    15 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
 vegetables or soups, dry                            (------ g); ------ 
 mix.                                                cup(s) (------ g)  
Dinners, desserts, fruits,    110 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
 vegetables or soups, ready-                          g); ------ cup(s) 
 to-serve, junior type.                              (------ mL)        
Dinners, desserts, fruits,    60 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
 vegetables or soups, ready-                          g); ------ cup(s) 
 to-serve, strained type.                            (------ mL)        
Dinners, stews or soups for   170 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
 toddlers, ready-to-serve.                            g); ------ cup(s) 
                                                     (------ mL)        
Fruits for toddlers, ready-   125 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
 to-serve.                                            g)                
Vegetables for toddlers,      70 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
 ready-to- serve.                                     g)                
Eggs/egg yolks, ready-to-     55 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
 serve.                                               g)                
Juices, all varieties.......  120 mL..............  4 fl oz (120 mL)    
------------------------------------------------------------------------
\1\ These values represent the amount of food customarily consumed per  
  eating occasion and were primarily derived from the 1977-1978 and the 
  1987-1988 Nationwide Food Consumption Surveys conducted by the U.S.   
  Department of Agriculture.                                            
\2\ Unless otherwise noted in the Reference amount column, the reference
  amounts are for the ready-to-serve or almost ready-to-serve form of   
  the product (i.e., heat and serve, brown and serve). If not listed    
  separately, the reference amount for the unprepared form (e.g., dry   
  cereal) is the amount required to make the reference amount of the    
  prepared form. Prepared means prepared for consumption (e.g., cooked).
\3\ Manufacturers are required to convert the reference amount to the   
  label serving size in a household measure most appropriate to their   
  specific product using the procedures in 21 CFR 101.9(b).             
\4\Copies of the list of products for each product category are         
  available from the Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150), Center for Food 
  Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. 
  SW., Washington, DC 20204.                                            
\5\ The label statements are meant to provide guidance to manufacturers 
  on the presentation of serving size information on the label, but they
  are not required. The term ``piece'' is used as a generic description 
  of a discrete unit. Manufacturers should use the description of a unit
  that is most appropriate for the specific product (e.g., sandwich for 
  sandwiches, cookie for cookies, and bar for frozen novelties).        


  Table 2.--Reference Amounts Customarily Consumed Per Eating Occasion: 
                       General Food Supply1,2,3,4                       
------------------------------------------------------------------------
      Product category          Reference amount      Label statement5  
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Bakery products:                                                        
    Biscuits, croissants,     55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     bagels, tortillas, soft                         -- g)              
     bread sticks, soft                                                 
     pretzels, corn bread,                                              
     hush puppies.                                                      
    Breads (excluding sweet   50 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     quick type), rolls.                             -- g) for sliced   
                                                     bread and distinct 
                                                     pieces (e.g.,      
                                                     rolls); 2 oz (56 g/
                                                     ------ inch slice) 
                                                     for unsliced bread 
    Bread sticks--see         ....................  ....................
     crackers.                                                          
    Toaster pastries--see     ....................  ....................
     coffee cakes.                                                      
    Brownies................  40 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g) for distinct 
                                                     pieces; fractional 
                                                     slice (------ g)   
                                                     for bulk           
    Cakes, heavy weight       125 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     (cheese cake; pineapple                         -- g) for distinct 
     upside-down cake;                               pieces (e.g.,      
     fruit, nut, and                                 sliced or          
     vegetable cakes with                            individually       
     more than or equal to                           packaged products);
     35 percent of the                               ------ fractional  
     finished weight as                              slice (------ g)   
     fruit, nuts, or                                 for large discrete 
     vegetables or any of                            units              
     these combined)6.                                                  
    Cakes, medium weight      80 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     (chemically leavened                            -- g) for distinct 
     cake with or without                            pieces (e.g.,      
     icing or filling except                         cupcake); ------   
     those classified as                             fractional slice (--
     light weight cake;                              ---- g) for large  
     fruit, nut, and                                 discrete units     
     vegetable cake with                                                
     less than 35 percent of                                            
     the finished weight as                                             
     fruit, nuts, or                                                    
     vegetables or any of                                               
     these combined; light                                              
     weight cake with icing;                                            
     Boston cream pie;                                                  
     cupcake; eclair; cream                                             
     puff)7.                                                            

[[Page 53]]

                                                                        
    Cakes, light weight       55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     (angel food, chiffon,                           -- g) for distinct 
     or sponge cake without                          pieces (e.g.,      
     icing or filling)8.                             sliced or          
                                                     individually       
                                                     packaged products);
                                                     ------ fractional  
                                                     slice (------ g)   
                                                     for large discrete 
                                                     units              
    Coffee cakes, crumb       55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     cakes, doughnuts,                               -- g) for sliced   
     Danish, sweet rolls,                            bread and distinct 
     sweet quick type                                pieces (e.g.,      
     breads, muffins,                                doughnut); 2 oz (56
     toaster pastries.                               g/visual unit of   
                                                     measure) for bulk  
                                                     products (e.g.,    
                                                     unsliced bread)    
    Cookies.................  30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              
    Crackers that are         15 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     usually not used as                             -- g)              
     snack, melba toast,                                                
     hard bread sticks, ice                                             
     cream cones9.                                                      
    Crackers that are         30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     usually used as snacks.                         -- g)              
    Croutons................  7 g.................  ------ tbsp(s)      
                                                     (------ g); ------ 
                                                     cup(s) (------ g); 
                                                     ------ piece(s)    
                                                     (------ g) for     
                                                     large pieces       
    French toast, pancakes,   110 g prepared for    ------ piece(s) (----
     variety mixes.            french toast and      -- g); ------      
                               pancakes; 40 g dry    cup(s) (------ g)  
                               mix for variety       for dry mix        
                               mixes.                                   
    Grain-based bars with or  40 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     without filling or                              -- g)              
     coating, e.g.,                                                     
     breakfast bars, granola                                            
     bars, rice cereal bars.                                            
    Ice cream cones--see      ....................  ....................
     crackers.                                                          
    Pies, cobblers, fruit     125 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     crisps, turnovers,                              --g) for distinct  
     other pastries.                                 pieces; ------     
                                                     fractional slice (--
                                                     ---- g) for large  
                                                     discrete units     
    Pie crust...............  1/6 of 8 inch crust;  1/6 of 8 inch crust 
                               1/8 of 9 inch crust.  (------ g); 1/8 of 
                                                     9 inch crust (------
                                                      g)                
    Pizza crust.............  55 g................  ------ fractional   
                                                     slice (------ g)   
    Taco shells, hard.......  30 g................  ------ shell(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              
    Waffles.................  85 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              
Beverages:                                                              
    Carbonated and            240 mL..............  8 fl oz (240 mL)    
     noncarbonated                                                      
     beverages, wine                                                    
     coolers, water.                                                    
    Coffee or tea, flavored   240 mL prepared.....  8 fl oz (240 mL)    
     and sweetened.                                                     
Cereal and Other Grain                                                  
 Products:                                                              
    Breakfast cereals (hot    1 cup prepared; 40 g  ------ cup(s) (------
     cereal type), hominy      plain dry cereal;      g)                
     grits.                    55 g flavored,                           
                               sweetened dry                            
                               cereal.                                  
    Breakfast cereals, ready- 15 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
     to-eat, weighing less                            g)                
     than 20 g per cup,                                                 
     e.g., plain puffed                                                 
     cereal grains.                                                     
    Breakfast cereals, ready- 30 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
     to-eat weighing 20 g or                          g)                
     more but less than 43 g                                            
     per cup; high fiber                                                
     cereals containing 28 g                                            
     or more of fiber per                                               
     100 g.                                                             
    Breakfast cereals, ready- 55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     to-eat, weighing 43 g                           -- g) for large    
     or more per cup;                                distinct pieces    
     biscuit types.                                  (e.g., biscuit     
                                                     type);------ cup(s)
                                                     (------ g) for all 
                                                     others             
    Bran or wheat germ......  15 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
                                                     (------ g); ------ 
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
    Flours or cornmeal......  30 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
                                                     (------ g); ------ 
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
    Grains, e.g., rice,       140 g prepared; 45 g  ------ cup(s) (------
     barley, plain.            dry.                   g)                
    Pastas, plain...........  140 g prepared; 55 g  ------ cup(s) (------
                               dry.                   g); ------        
                                                     piece(s) (------ g)
                                                     for large pieces   
                                                     (e.g., large shells
                                                     or lasagna noodles)
                                                     or 2 oz (56 g/     
                                                     visual unit of     
                                                     measure) for dry   
                                                     bulk products      
                                                     (e.g., spaghetti)  
    Pastas, dry, ready-to-    25 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
     eat, e.g., fried canned                          g)                
     chow mein noodles.                                                 
    Starches, e.g.,           10 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
     cornstarch, potato                              g)                 
     starch, tapioca, etc..                                             
    Stuffing................  100 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
                                                      g)                
Dairy Products and                                                      
 Substitutes:                                                           
    Cheese, cottage.........  110 g...............  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g)                 
    Cheese used primarily as  55 g................  ------ cup (------  
     ingredients, e.g., dry                          g)                 
     cottage cheese, ricotta                                            
     cheese.                                                            

[[Page 54]]

                                                                        
    Cheese, grated hard,      5 g.................  ------ tbsp (------ 
     e.g., Parmesan, Romano.                         g)                 
    Cheese, all others        30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     except those listed as                          -- g) for distinct 
     separate categories--                           pieces;------      
     includes cream cheese                           tbsp(s) (------ g) 
     and cheese spread.                              for cream cheese   
                                                     and cheese spread; 
                                                     1 oz (28 g/visual  
                                                     unit of measure)   
                                                     for bulk           
    Cheese sauce--see sauce                                             
     category.                                                          
    Cream or cream            15 mL...............  1 tbsp (15 mL)      
     substitutes, fluid.                                                
    Cream or cream            2 g.................  ------ tsp (------  
     substitutes, powder.                            g)                 
    Cream, half & half......  30 mL...............  2 tbsp (30 mL)      
    Eggnog..................  120 mL..............  1/2 cup (120 mL); 4 
                                                     fl oz (120 mL)     
    Milk, condensed,          30 mL...............  2 tbsp (30 mL)      
     undiluted.                                                         
    Milk, evaporated,         30 mL...............  2 tbsp (30 mL)      
     undiluted.                                                         
    Milk, milk-based drinks,  240 mL..............  1 cup (240 mL); 8 fl
     e.g., instant                                   oz (240 mL)        
     breakfast, meal                                                    
     replacement, cocoa.                                                
    Shakes or shake           240 mL..............  1 cup (240 mL); 8 fl
     substitutes, e.g.,                              oz (240 mL)        
     dairy shake mixes,                                                 
     fruit frost mixes.                                                 
    Sour cream..............  30 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
                                                     g)                 
    Yogurt..................  225 g...............  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g)                 
Desserts:                                                               
    Ice cream, ice milk,      1/2 cup-includes the  ------ piece(s) (----
     frozen yogurt, sherbet:   volume for coatings   -- g) for          
     all types, bulk and       and wafers for the    individually       
     novelties (e.g., bars,    novelty type          wrapped or packaged
     sandwiches, cones).       varieties.            products; 1/2 cup  
                                                     (------ g) for     
                                                     others             
    Frozen flavored and       85 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     sweetened ice and pops,                         -- g) for          
     frozen fruit juices:                            individually       
     all types, bulk and                             wrapped or packaged
     novelties (e.g., bars,                          products; ------   
     cups).                                          cup(s) (------ g)  
                                                     for others         
    Sundae..................  1 cup...............  1 cup (------ g)    
    Custards, gelatin or      1/2 cup.............  ------ piece(s) (----
     pudding.                                        -- g) for distinct 
                                                     unit (e.g.,        
                                                     individually       
                                                     packaged products);
                                                     1/2 cup (------ g) 
                                                     for bulk           
Dessert Toppings and                                                    
 Fillings:                                                              
    Cake frostings or icings  35 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
                                                     (------ g)         
    Other dessert toppings,   2 tbsp..............  2 tbsp (------ g); 2
     e.g., fruits, syrups,                           tbsp (30 mL)       
     spreads, marshmallow                                               
     cream, nuts, dairy and                                             
     nondairy whipped                                                   
     toppings.                                                          
    Pie fillings............  85 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
                                                      g)                
Egg and Egg Sustitutes:                                                 
    Egg mixtures, e.g., egg   110 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     foo young, scrambled                            -- g) for discrete 
     eggs, omelets.                                  pieces; ------     
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
    Eggs (all sizes)9.......  50 g................  1 large, medium,    
                                                     etc. (------ g)    
    Egg substitutes.........  An amount to make 1   ------ cup(s) (------
                               large (50 g) egg.      g); ------ cup(s) 
                                                     (------ mL)        
Fats and Oils:                                                          
    Butter, margarine, oil,   1 tbsp..............  1 tbsp (------ g); 1
     shortening.                                     tbsp (15 mL)       
    Butter replacement,       2 g.................  ------ tsp(s) (------
     powder.                                          g)                
    Dressings for salads....  30 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
                                                     g); ------ tbsp    
                                                     (------ mL)        
     Mayonnaise, sandwich     15 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
     spreads, mayonnaise-                            g)                 
     type dressings.                                                    
    Spray types.............  0.25 g..............  About ------ seconds
                                                     spray (------ g)   
Fish, Shellfish, Game                                                   
 Meats10, and Meat or                                                   
 Poultry Substitutes:                                                   
    Bacon substitutes,        15 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     canned anchovies,11                             -- g) for discrete 
     anchovy pastes, caviar.                         pieces; ------     
                                                     tbsp(s) (------ g) 
                                                     for others         
    Dried, e.g., jerky......  30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              
    Entrees with sauce,       140 g cooked........  ------ cup(s) (------
     e.g., fish with cream                            g); 5 oz (140 g/  
     sauce, shrimp with                              visual unit of     
     lobster sauce.                                  measure) if not    
                                                     measurable by cup  
    Entrees without sauce,    85 g cooked; 110 g    ------ piece(s) (----
     e.g., plain or fried      uncooked12.           -- g) for discrete 
     fish and shellfish,                             pieces; ------     
     fish and shellfish cake.                        cup(s) (------ g); 
                                                     ------ oz (------ g/
                                                     visual unit of     
                                                     measure) if not    
                                                     measurable by cup13

[[Page 55]]

                                                                        
    Fish, shellfish or game   55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     meat10, canned11.                               -- g) for discrete 
                                                     pieces; ------     
                                                     cup(s) (------ g); 
                                                     2 oz (56 g/------  
                                                     cup) for products  
                                                     that are difficult 
                                                     to measure the g   
                                                     weight of cup      
                                                     measure (e.g.,     
                                                     tuna); 2 oz (56 g/--
                                                     ---- pieces) for   
                                                     products that      
                                                     naturally vary in  
                                                     size (e.g.,        
                                                     sardines)          
    Substitute for luncheon   55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     meat, meat spreads,                             -- g) for distinct 
     Canadian bacon,                                 pieces (e.g.,      
     sausages and                                    slices, links); ----
     frankfurters.                                   -- cup(s) (------  
                                                     g); 2 oz (56 g/    
                                                     visual unit of     
                                                     measure) for       
                                                     nondiscrete bulk   
                                                     product            
    Smoked or pickled11       55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     fish, shellfish, or                             -- g) for distinct 
     game meat10; fish or                            pieces (e.g.,      
     shellfish spread.                               slices, links) or --
                                                     ---- cup(s) (------
                                                     g); 2 oz (56 g/    
                                                     visual unit of     
                                                     measure) for       
                                                     nondiscrete bulk   
                                                     product            
    Substitutes for bacon                                               
     bits--see miscellaneous                                            
     category.                                                          
Fruits and Fruit Juices:                                                
    Candied or pickled11....  30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              
    Dehydrated fruits--see    ....................  ....................
     snacks category.                                                   
    Dried...................  40 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g) for large    
                                                     pieces (e.g.,      
                                                     dates, figs,       
                                                     prunes); ------    
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
                                                     for small pieces   
                                                     (e.g., raisins)    
    Fruits for garnish or     4 g.................  1 cherry (------ g) 
     flavor, e.g.,                                                      
     maraschino cherries11.                                             
    Fruit relishes, e.g.,     70 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
     cranberry sauce,                                 g)                
     cranberry relish.                                                  
    Fruits used primarily as  30 g................  See footnote 13     
     ingredients, avocado.                                              
    Fruits used primarily as  55 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     ingredients, others                             -- g) for large    
     (cranberries, lemon,                            fruits; ------     
     lime).                                          cup(s) (------ g)  
                                                     for small fruits   
                                                     measurable by cup13
    Watermelon..............  280 g...............  See footnote 13     
    All other fruits (except  140 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     those listed as                                 -- g) for large    
     separate categories),                           pieces (e.g.,      
     fresh, canned, or                               strawberries,      
     frozen.                                         prunes, apricots,  
                                                     etc.); ------      
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
                                                     for small pieces   
                                                     (e.g., blueberries,
                                                     raspberries,       
                                                     etc.)13            
    Juices, nectars, fruit    240 mL..............  8 fl oz (240 mL)    
     drinks.                                                            
    Juices used as            5 mL................  1 tsp (5 mL)        
     ingredients, e.g.,                                                 
     lemon juice, lime juice.                                           
Legumes:                                                                
    Bean cake (tofu)11,       85 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     tempeh.                                         -- g) for discrete 
                                                     pieces; 3 oz (84 g/
                                                     visual unit of     
                                                     measure) for bulk  
                                                     products           
    Beans, plain or in sauce  130 g for beans in    ------ cup (------  
                               sauce or canned in    g)                 
                               liquid and refried                       
                               beans prepared; 90                       
                               g for others                             
                               prepared; 35 g dry.                      
Miscellaneous Category:                                                 
    Baking powder, baking     1 g.................  ------ tsp (------  
     soda, pectin.                                   g)                 
    Baking decorations,       1 tsp or 4 g if not   ------ piece(s) (----
     e.g., colored sugars      measurable by         -- g) for discrete 
     and sprinkles for         teaspoon.             pieces;1 tsp (------
     cookies, cake                                    g)                
     decorations.                                                       
    Batter mixes, bread       30 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
     crumbs.                                         (------ g);------  
                                                     cup(s) (------ g)  
    Cooking wine............  30 mL...............  2 tbsp (30 mL)      
    Dietary supplements not   The maximum amount    ------ tablet(s),   
     in conventional food      recommended, as       ------ capsule(s), 
     form..                    appropriate, on the   ------ packet(s), --
                               label for             ---- tsp(s) (------
                               consumption per       g), etc.           
                               eating occasion or,                      
                               in the absence of                        
                               recommendations, 1                       
                               unit, e.g., tablet,                      
                               capsule, packet,                         
                               teaspoonful, etc..                       
    Drink mixers (without     Amount to make 240    ------ fl oz (------
     alcohol).                 mL drink (without     mL)                
                               ice).                                    
    Chewing gum9............  3 g.................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g)              

[[Page 56]]

                                                                        
    Meat, poultry and fish    Amount to make one    ------ tsp(s) (------
     coating mixes, dry;       reference amount of    g); ------ tbsp(s)
     seasoning mixes, dry,     final dish.           (------ g)         
     e.g., chili seasoning                                              
     mixes, pasta salad                                                 
     seasoning mixes.                                                   
    Salad and potato          7 g.................  ------ tbsp(s)      
     toppers, e.g., salad                            (------ g)         
     crunchies, salad                                                   
     crispins, substitutes                                              
     for bacon bits.                                                    
    Salt, salt substitutes,   1 g.................  ------ tsp(s) (------
     seasoning salts (e.g.,                           g);------ piece(s)
     garlic salt).                                   (------ g) for     
                                                     discrete pieces    
                                                     (e.g., individually
                                                     packaged products) 
    Spices, herbs (other      1/4 tsp or 0.5 g if   1/4 tsp (------ g); 
     than dietary              not measurable by     ------ piece(s)    
     supplements).             teaspoon.             (------ g) if not  
                                                     measurable by      
                                                     teaspoons (e.g.,   
                                                     bay leaf)          
Mixed Dishes:                                                           
    Measurable with cup,       1 cup..............  1 cup (------ g)    
     e.g., casseroles, hash,                                            
     macaroni and cheese,                                               
     pot pies, spaghetti                                                
     with sauce, stews, etc..                                           
    Not measurable with cup,  140 g, add 55 g for   ------ piece(s) (----
     e.g., burritos, egg       products with gravy   -- g) for discrete 
     rolls, enchiladas,        or sauce topping,     pieces; ------     
     pizza, pizza rolls,       e.g., enchilada       fractional slice (--
     quiche, all types of      with cheese sauce,    ---- g) for large  
     sandwiches.               crepe with white      discrete units     
                               sauce14.                                 
Nuts and Seeds:                                                         
    Nuts, seeds, and          30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     mixtures, all types:                            -- g) for large    
     sliced, chopped,                                pieces (e.g.,      
     slivered, and whole.                            unshelled nuts);----
                                                     -- tbsp(s) (------ 
                                                     g) ;------ cup(s)  
                                                     (------ g) for     
                                                     small pieces (e.g.,
                                                     peanuts, sunflower 
                                                     seeds)             
    Nut and seed butters,     2 tbsp..............  2 tbsp (------ g)   
     pastes, or creams.                                                 
    Coconut, nut and seed     15 g................  ------ tbsp(s)      
     flours.                                         (------ g); ------ 
                                                     cup (------ g)     
Potatoes and Sweet Potatoes/                                            
 Yams:                                                                  
    French fries, hash        70 g prepared; 85 g   ------ piece(s) (----
     browns, skins, or         for frozen            -- g) for large    
     pancakes.                 unprepared french     distinct pieces    
                               fries.                (e.g., patties,    
                                                     skins); 2.5 oz (70 
                                                     g/------ pieces)   
                                                     for prepared fries;
                                                     3 oz (84 g/------  
                                                     pieces) for        
                                                     unprepared fries   
    Mashed, candied,          140 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     stuffed, or with sauce.                         -- g) for discrete 
                                                     pieces (e.g.,      
                                                     stuffed potato);   
                                                     ------ cup(s)      
                                                     (------ g)         
    Plain, fresh, canned, or  110 g for fresh or    ------ piece(s) (----
     frozen.                   frozen; 125 g for     -- g) for discrete 
                               vacuum packed; 160    pieces;------      
                               g for canned in       cup(s) (------ g)  
                               liquid.               for sliced or      
                                                     chopped products   
Salads:                                                                 
    Gelatin salad...........  120 g...............  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g)                 
    Pasta or potato salad...  140 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
                                                      g)                
    All other salads, e.g.,   100 g...............  ------ cup(s) (------
     egg, fish, shellfish,                            g)                
     bean, fruit, or                                                    
     vegetable salads.                                                  
Sauces, Dips, Gravies and                                               
 Condiments:                                                            
    Barbecue sauce,           2 tbsp..............  2 tbsp (------ g); 2
     hollandaise sauce,                              tbsp (30 mL)       
     tartar sauce, other                                                
     sauces for dipping                                                 
     (e.g., mustard sauce,                                              
     sweet and sour sauce),                                             
     all dips (e.g., bean                                               
     dips, dairy-based dips,                                            
     salsa).                                                            
    Major main entree         125 g...............  ------ cup (------  
     sauces, e.g., spaghetti                         g); ------ cup (----
     sauce.                                          -- mL)             
    Minor main entree sauces  1/4 cup.............  1/4 cup (------ g); 
     (e.g., pizza sauce,                             1/4 cup (60 mL)    
     pesto sauce), other                                                
     sauces used as toppings                                            
     (e.g., gravy, white                                                
     sauce, cheese sauce),                                              
     cocktail sauce.                                                    
    Major condiments, e.g.,   1 tbsp..............  1 tbsp (------ g); 1
     catsup, steak sauce,                            tbsp (15 mL)       
     soy sauce, vinegar,                                                
     teriyaki sauce,                                                    
     marinades.                                                         
    Minor condiments, e.g.,   1 tsp...............  1 tsp (------ g); 1 
     horseradish, hot                                tsp (5 mL)         
     sauces, mustards,                                                  
     worcestershire sauce.                                              

[[Page 57]]

                                                                        
Snacks:                                                                 
    All varieties, chips,     30 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
     pretzels, popcorns,                              g) for small      
     extruded snacks, fruit-                         pieces (e.g.,      
     based snacks (e.g.,                             popcorn) ------    
     fruit chips,) grain-                            piece(s) (------ g)
     based snack mixes.                              for large pieces   
                                                     (e.g., large       
                                                     pretzels; pressed  
                                                     dried fruit sheet);
                                                     1 oz (28 g/visual  
                                                     unit of measure)   
                                                     for bulk products  
                                                     (e.g., potato      
                                                     chips)             
Soups:                                                                  
    All varieties...........  245 g...............  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g); ------ cup (----
                                                     -- mL)             
Sugars and Sweets:                                                      
    Baking candies (e.g.,     15 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     chips).                                         -- g) for large    
                                                     pieces; ------     
                                                     tbsp(s) (------ g) 
                                                     for small pieces; 1/
                                                     2 oz (14 g/visual  
                                                     unit of measure)   
                                                     for bulk products  
    Hard candies, breath      2 g.................  ------ piece(s) (----
     mints.                                          -- g)              
    Hard candies, roll-type,  5 g.................  ------ piece(s) (----
     mini-size in dispenser                          -- g)              
     packages.                                                          
    Hard candies, others....  15 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g) for large    
                                                     pieces;------      
                                                     tbsp(s) (------ g) 
                                                     for ``mini-size''  
                                                     candies measurable 
                                                     by tablespoon; 1/2 
                                                     oz (14 g/visual    
                                                     unit of measure)   
                                                     for bulk products  
    All other candies.......  40 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g); 1 1/2 oz (42
                                                     g/visual unit of   
                                                     measure) for bulk  
                                                     products           
    Confectioner's sugar....  30 g................  ------ cup (------  
                                                     g)                 
    Honey, jams, jellies,     1 tbsp..............  1 tbsp (------ g); 1
     fruit butter, molasses.                         tbsp (15 mL)       
    Marshmallows............  30 g................  ------ cup(s) (------
                                                      g) for small      
                                                     pieces; ------     
                                                     piece(s) (------ g)
                                                     for large pieces   
    Sugar...................  4 g.................  ------ tsp (------  
                                                     g) ; ------        
                                                     piece(s) (------ g)
                                                     for discrete pieces
                                                     (e.g., sugar cubes,
                                                     individually       
                                                     packaged products) 
    Sugar substitutes.......  An amount equivalent  ------ tsp(s) (------
                               to one reference       g) for solids; ----
                               amount for sugar in   -- drop(s) (------ 
                               sweetness.            g) for liquid;     
                                                     ------ piece(s)    
                                                     (------ g) (e.g.,  
                                                     individually       
                                                     packaged products) 
    Syrups..................  30 mL for syrups      2 tbsp (30 mL) for  
                               used primarily as     syrups used        
                               an ingredient         primarily as an    
                               (e.g., light or       ingredient; 1/4 cup
                               dark corn syrup);     (60 mL) for all    
                               60 mL for all         others             
                               others.                                  
Vegetables:                                                             
    Vegetables primarily      4 g.................  ------ piece(s) (----
     used for garnish or                             -- g); ------      
     flavor, e.g., pimento,                          tbsp(s) (------ g) 
     parsley.                                        for chopped        
                                                     products           
    Chili pepper, green       30 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
     onion.                                          -- g)13; ------    
                                                     tbsp(s) (------ g);
                                                     ------ cup(s)      
                                                     (------ g) for     
                                                     sliced or chopped  
                                                     products           
    All other vegetables      85 g for fresh or     ------ piece(s) (----
     without sauce: fresh,     frozen; 95 g for      -- g) for large    
     canned, or frozen.        vacuum packed; 130    pieces (e.g.,      
                               g for canned in       brussel sprouts); --
                               liquid, cream-style   ---- cup(s) (------
                               corn, canned or       g) for small pieces
                               stewed tomatoes,      (e.g., cut corn,   
                               pumpkin, or winter    green peas); 3 oz  
                               squash.               (84 g/visual unit  
                                                     of measure) if not 
                                                     measurable by cup13
    All other vegetables      110 g...............  ------ piece(s) (----
     with sauce: fresh,                              -- g) for large    
     canned, or frozen.                              pieces (e.g.,      
                                                     brussel sprouts); --
                                                     ---- cup(s) (------
                                                     g) for small pieces
                                                     (e.g., cut corn,   
                                                     green peas); 4 oz  
                                                     (112 g/visual unit 
                                                     of measure) if not 
                                                     measurable by cup  
    Vegetable juice.........  240 mL..............  8 fl oz (240 mL)    
    Olives11................  15 g................  ------ piece(s) (----
                                                     -- g); ------      
                                                     tbsp(s) (------ g) 
                                                     for sliced products
    Pickles, all types11....  30 g................  1 oz (28 g/visual   
                                                     unit of measure)   
    Pickle relishes.........  15 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
                                                     g)                 
    Vegetable pastes, e.g.,   30 g................  ------ tbsp (------ 
     tomato paste.                                   g)                 

[[Page 58]]

                                                                        
    Vegetable sauces or       60 g................  ------ cup (------  
     purees, e.g, tomato                             g); ------ cup (----
     sauce, tomato puree.                            -- mL)             
------------------------------------------------------------------------
\1\ These values represent the amount (edible portion) of food          
  customarily consumed per eating occasion and were primarily derived   
  from the 1977-1978 and the 1987-1988 Nationwide Food Consumption      
  Surveys conducted by the U.S. Department of Argiculture.              
\2\ Unless otherwise noted in the Reference Amount column, the reference
  amounts are for the ready-to-serve or almost ready-to-serve form of   
  the product (i.e., heat and serve, brown and serve). If not listed    
  separately, the reference amount for the unprepared form (e.g., dry   
  mixes; concentrates; dough; batter; fresh and frozen pasta) is the    
  amount required to make the reference amount of the prepared form.    
  Prepared means prepared for consumption (e.g., cooked).               
\3\ Manufacturers are required to convert the reference amount to the   
  label serving size in a household measure most appropriate to their   
  specific product using the procedures in 21 CFR 101.9(b).             
\4\ Copies of the list of products for each product category are        
  available from the Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150), Center for Food 
  Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. 
  SW., Washington, DC 20204.                                            
\5\ The label statements are meant to provide guidance to manufacturers 
  on the presentation of serving size information on the label, but they
  are not required. The term ``piece'' is used as a generic description 
  of a discrete unit. Manufacturers should use the description of a unit
  that is most appropriate for the specific product (e.g., sandwich for 
  sandwiches, cookie for cookies, and bar for ice cream bars). The      
  guidance provided is for the label statement of products in ready-to- 
  serve or almost ready-to-serve form. The guidance does not apply to   
  the products which require further preparation for consumption (e.g., 
  dry mixes, concentrates) unless specifically stated in the product    
  category, reference amount, or label statement column that it is for  
  these forms of the product. For products that require further         
  preparation, manufacturers must determine the label statement         
  following the rules in Sec.  101.9(b) using the reference amount      
  determined according to Sec.  101.12(c).                              
\6\ Includes cakes that weigh 10 g or more per cubic inch.              
\7\ Includes cakes that weigh 4 g or more per cubic inch but less than  
  10 g per cubic inch.                                                  
\8\ Includes cakes that weigh less than 4 g per cubic inch.             
\9\ Label serving size for ice cream cones and eggs of all sizes will be
  1 unit. Label serving size of all chewing gums that weigh more than   
  the reference amount that can reasonably be consumed at a single-     
  eating occasion will be 1 unit.                                       
\10\ Animal products not covered under the Federal Meat Inspection Act  
  or the Poultry Products Inspection Act, such as flesh products from   
  deer, bison, rabbit, quail, wild turkey, geese, ostrich, etc.         
\11\ If packed or canned in liquid, the reference amount is for the     
  drained solids, except for products in which both the solids and      
  liquids are customarily consumed (e.g., canned chopped clam in juice).
\12\ The reference amount for the uncooked form does not apply to raw   
  fish in Sec.  101.45 or to single-ingredient products that consist of 
  fish or game meat as provided for in Sec.  101.9(b)(j)(11).           
\13\ For raw fruit, vegetables, and fish, manufacturers should follow   
  the label statement for the serving size specified in Appendices A and
  B to the regulation entitled ``Food Labeling; Guidelines for Voluntary
  Nutrition Labeling; and Identification of the 20 Most Frequently      
  Consumed Raw Fruits, Vegetables, and Fish; Definition of Substantial  
  Compliance; Correction'' (56 FR 60880 as amended 57 FR 8174, March 6, 
  1992).                                                                
\14\ Pizza sauce is part of the pizza and is not considered to be sauce 
  topping.                                                              

    (c) If a product requires further preparation, e.g., cooking or the 
addition of water or other ingredients, and if paragraph (b) of this 
section provides a reference amount for the product in the prepared but 
not the unprepared form, then the reference amount for the unprepared 
product shall be determined using the following rules:
    (1) Except as provided for in paragraph (c)(2) of this section, the 
reference amount for the unprepared product shall be the amount of the 
unprepared product required to make the reference amount for the 
prepared product as established in paragraph (b) of this section.
    (2) For products where the entire contents of the package is used to 
prepare one large discrete unit usually divided for consumption, the 
reference amount for the unprepared product shall be the amount of the 
unprepared product required to make the fraction of the large discrete 
unit closest to the reference amount for the prepared product as 
established in paragraph (b) of this section.
    (d) The reference amount for an imitation or substitute food or 
altered food, such as a ``low calorie'' version, shall be the same as 
for the food for which it is offered as a substitute.
    (e) If a food is modified by incorporating air (aerated), and 
thereby the density of the food is lowered by 25 percent or more in 
weight than that of an appropriate reference regular food as described 
in Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(ii)(A), and the reference amount of the regular 
food is in grams, the manufacturer may determine the reference amount of 
the aerated food by adjusting for the difference in density of the 
aerated food relative to the density of the appropriate reference food 
provided that the manufacturer will show FDA detailed protocol and 
records of all data that were used to determine the density-adjusted 
reference amount for the aerated food. The reference amount for the 
aerated food shall be rounded to

[[Page 59]]

the nearest 5-g increment. Such products shall bear a descriptive term 
indicating that extra air has been incorporated (e.g., whipped, 
aerated). The density-adjusted reference amounts described in paragraph 
(b) of this section may not be used for cakes except for cheese cake. 
The differences in the densities of different types of cakes having 
different degrees of air incorporation have already been taken into 
consideration in determining the reference amounts for cakes in 
Sec. 101.12(b). In determining the difference in density of the aerated 
and the regular food, the manufacturer shall adhere to the following:
    (1) The regular and the aerated product must be the same in size, 
shape, and volume. To compare the densities of products having nonsmooth 
surfaces (e.g., waffles), manufacturers shall use a device or method 
that ensures that the volumes of the regular and the aerated products 
are the same.
    (2) Sample selections for the density measurements shall be done in 
accordance with the provisions in Sec. 101.9(e).
    (3) Density measurements of the regular and the aerated products 
shall be conducted by the same trained operator using the same 
methodology (e.g., the same equipment, procedures, and techniques) under 
the same conditions.
    (4) Density measurements shall be replicated a sufficient number of 
times to ensure that the average of the measurements is representative 
of the true differences in the densities of the regular and the 
``aerated'' products.
    (f) For products that have no reference amount listed in paragraph 
(b) of this section for the unprepared or the prepared form of the 
product and that consist of two or more foods packaged and presented to 
be consumed together (e.g., peanut putter and jelly, cracker and cheese 
pack, pancakes and syrup, cake and frosting), the reference amount for 
the combined product shall be determined using the following rules:
    (1) For bulk products (e.g., peanut butter and jelly), the reference 
amount for the combined product shall be the reference amount, as 
established in paragraph (b) of this section, for the ingredient that is 
represented as the main ingredient plus proportioned amounts of all 
minor ingredients.
    (2) For products where the ingredient represented as the main 
ingredient is one or more discrete units (e.g., cracker and cheese pack, 
pancakes and syrup, cake and frosting), the reference amount for the 
combined product shall be either the number of small discrete units or 
the fraction of the large discrete unit that is represented as the main 
ingredient that is closest to the reference amount for that ingredient 
as established in paragraph (b) of this section plus proportioned 
amounts of all minor ingredients.
    (3) If the reference amounts are in compatible units, they shall be 
summed (e.g., the reference amount for equal volumes of peanut butter 
and jelly for which peanut butter is represented as the main ingredient 
would be 4 tablespoons (tbsp) (2 tbsp peanut butter plus 2 tbsp jelly). 
If the reference amounts are in incompatible units, the weights of the 
appropriate volumes should be used (e.g., 110 grams (g) pancakes plus 
the gram weight of the proportioned amount of syrup).
    (g) The reference amounts set forth in paragraphs (b) through (f) of 
this section shall be used in determining whether a product meets the 
criteria for nutrient content claims, such as ``low calorie,'' and for 
health claims. If the serving size declared on the product label differs 
from the reference amount, and the product meets the criteria for the 
claim only on the basis of the reference amount, the claim shall be 
followed by a statement that sets forth the basis on which the claim is 
made. That statement shall include the reference amount as it appears in 
paragraph (b) of this section followed, in parenthesis, by the amount in 
common household measure if the reference amount is expressed in 
measures other than common household measures (e.g., for a beverage, 
``Very low sodium, 35 mg or less per 240 mL (8 fl oz)'').
    (h) The Commissioner of Food and Drugs, either on his or her own 
initiative or in response to a petition submitted pursuant to part 10 of 
this chapter, may issue a proposal to establish or amend a reference 
amount in paragraph (b) of this section. A petition to

[[Page 60]]

establish or amend a reference amount shall include:
    (1) Objective of the petition;
    (2) A description of the product;
    (3) A complete sample product label including nutrition label, using 
the format established by regulation;
    (4) A description of the form (e.g., dry mix, frozen dough) in which 
the product will be marketed;
    (5) The intended dietary uses of the product with the major use 
identified (e.g., milk as a beverage and chips as a snack);
    (6) If the intended use is primarily as an ingredient in other 
foods, list of foods or food categories in which the product will be 
used as an ingredient with information on the prioritization of the use;
    (7) The population group for which the product will be offered for 
use (e.g., infants, children under 4 years of age);
    (8) The names of the most closely related products (or in the case 
of foods for special dietary use and imitation or substitute foods, the 
names of the products for which they are offered as substitutes);
    (9) The suggested reference amount (the amount of edible portion of 
food as consumed, excluding bone, seed, shell, or other inedible 
components) for the population group for which the product is intended 
with full description of the methodology and procedures that were used 
to determine the suggested reference amount. In determining the 
reference amount, general principles and factors in paragraph (a) of 
this section should be followed.
    (10) The suggested reference amount shall be expressed in metric 
units. Reference amounts for fluids shall be expressed in milliliters. 
Reference amounts for other foods shall be expressed in grams except 
when common household units such as cups, tablespoons, and teaspoons, 
are more appropriate or are more likely to promote uniformity in serving 
sizes declared on product labels. For example, common household measures 
would be more appropriate if products within the same category differ 
substantially in density, such as frozen desserts.
    (i) In expressing the reference amounts in milliliters, the 
following rules shall be followed:
    (A) For volumes greater than 30 milliliters (mL), the volume shall 
be expressed in multiples of 30 mL.
    (B) For volumes less than 30 mL, the volume shall be expressed in 
milliliters equivalent to a whole number of teaspoons or 1 tbsp, i.e., 
5, 10, or 15 mL.
    (ii) In expressing the reference amounts in grams, the following 
general rules shall be followed:
    (A) For quantities greater than 10 g, the quantity shall be 
expressed in the nearest 5-g increment.
    (B) For quantities less than 10 g, exact gram weights shall be used.
    (11) A petition to create a new subcategory of food with its own 
reference amount shall include the following additional information:
    (i) Data that demonstrate that the new subcategory of food will be 
consumed in amounts that differ enough from the reference amount for the 
parent category to warrant a separate reference amount. Data must 
include sample size; and the mean, standard deviation, median, and modal 
consumed amount per eating occasion for the petitioned product and for 
other products in the category, excluding the petitioned product. All 
data must be derived from the same survey data.
    (ii) Documentation supporting the difference in dietary usage and 
product characteristics that affect the consumption size that 
distinguishes the petitioned product from the rest of the products in 
the category.
    (12) A claim for categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this 
chapter or an environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter; 
and
    (13) In conducting research to collect or process food consumption 
data in support of the petition, the following general guidelines should 
be followed.
    (i) Sampled population selected should be representative of the 
demographic and socioeconomic characteristics of the target population 
group for which the food is intended.
    (ii) Sample size (i.e., number of eaters) should be large enough to 
give reliable estimates for customarily consumed amounts.
    (iii) The study protocol should identify potential biases and 
describe how potential biases are controlled for or, if

[[Page 61]]

not possible to control, how they affect interpretation of results.
    (iv) The methodology used to collect or process data should be fully 
documented and should include: study design, sampling procedures, 
materials used (e.g., questionnaire, and interviewer's manual), 
procedures used to collect or process data, methods or procedures used 
to control for unbiased estimates, and procedures used to correct for 
nonresponse.
    (14) A statement concerning the feasibility of convening 
associations, corporations, consumers, and other interested parties to 
engage in negotiated rulemaking to develop a proposed rule consistent 
with the Negotiated Rulemaking Act (5 U.S.C. 561).

[58 FR 44051, Aug. 18, 1993; 58 FR 60109, Nov. 15, 1993, as amended at 
59 FR 371, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 24039, May 10, 1994]



Sec. 101.13  Nutrient content claims--general principles.

    (a) This section and the regulations in subpart D of this part apply 
to foods that are intended for human consumption and that are offered 
for sale, including foods in conventional food form and dietary 
supplements of vitamins, minerals, herbs, and other similar nutritional 
substances (dietary supplements).
    (b) A claim that expressly or implicitly characterizes the level of 
a nutrient (nutrient content claim) of the type required in nutrition 
labeling under Sec. 101.9, with the exception of such claims on 
restaurant menus, may not be made on the label or in labeling of foods 
unless the claim is made in accordance with this regulation and with the 
applicable regulations in subpart D of this part or in part 105 or part 
107 of this chapter.
    (1) An expressed nutrient content claim is any direct statement 
about the level (or range) of a nutrient in the food, e.g., ``low 
sodium'' or ``contains 100 calories.''
    (2) An implied nutrient content claim is any claim that:
    (i) Describes the food or an ingredient therein in a manner that 
suggests that a nutrient is absent or present in a certain amount (e.g., 
``high in oat bran''); or
    (ii) Suggests that the food, because of its nutrient content, may be 
useful in maintaining healthy dietary practices and is made in 
association with an explicit claim or statement about a nutrient (e.g., 
``healthy, contains 3 grams (g) of fat'').
    (3) Except for claims regarding vitamins and minerals described in 
paragraph (q)(3) of this section, no nutrient content claims may be made 
on food intended specifically for use by infants and children less than 
2 years of age unless the claim is specifically provided for in parts 
101, 105, or 107 of this chapter.
    (4) Reasonable variations in the spelling of the terms defined in 
part 101 and their synonyms are permitted provided these variations are 
not misleading (e.g., ``hi'' or ``lo'').
    (5) For dietary supplements, claims for calories, fat, saturated 
fat, and cholesterol may not be made on products that meet the criteria 
in Sec. 101.60(b)(1) or (b)(2) for ``calorie free'' or ``low calorie'' 
claims, except, in the case of calorie claims, when an equivalent amount 
of a similar dietary supplement (e.g., another protein supplement) that 
the labeled food resembles and for which it substitutes, normally 
exceeds the definition for ``low calorie'' in Sec. 101.60(b)(2).
    (c) Information that is required or permitted by Sec. 101.9 or 
Sec. 101.36, as applicable, to be declared in nutrition labeling, and 
that appears as part of the nutrition label, is not a nutrient content 
claim and is not subject to the requirements of this section. If such 
information is declared elsewhere on the label or in labeling, it is a 
nutrient content claim and is subject to the requirements for nutrient 
content claims.
    (d) A ``substitute'' food is one that may be used interchangeably 
with another food that it resembles, i.e., that it is organoleptically, 
physically, and functionally (including shelf life) similar to, and that 
it is not nutritionally inferior to unless it is labeled as an 
``imitation.''
    (1) If there is a difference in performance characteristics that 
materially limits the use of the food, the food may still be considered 
a substitute if the label includes a disclaimer adjacent to the most 
prominent claim as defined in

[[Page 62]]

paragraph (j)(2)(iii) of this section, informing the consumer of such 
difference (e.g., ``not recommended for frying'').
    (2) This disclaimer shall be in easily legible print or type and in 
a size no less than that required by Sec. 101.105(i) for the net 
quantity of contents statement, except where the size of the claim is 
less than two times the required size of the net quantity of contents 
statement, in which case the disclaimer shall be no less than one-half 
the size of the claim but no smaller than one-sixteenth of an inch, 
unless the package complies with Sec. 101.2(c)(5), in which case the 
disclaimer may be in type of not less than one thirty-second of an inch.
    (e)(1) Because the use of a ``free'' or ``low'' claim before the 
name of a food implies that the food differs from other foods of the 
same type by virtue of its having a lower amount of the nutrient, only 
foods that have been specially processed, altered, formulated, or 
reformulated so as to lower the amount of the nutrient in the food, 
remove the nutrient from the food, or not include the nutrient in the 
food, may bear such a claim (e.g., ``low sodium potato chips'').
    (2) Any claim for the absence of a nutrient in a food, or that a 
food is low in a nutrient when the food has not been specially 
processed, altered, formulated, or reformulated to qualify for that 
claim shall indicate that the food inherently meets the criteria and 
shall clearly refer to all foods of that type and not merely to the 
particular brand to which the labeling attaches (e.g., ``corn oil, a 
sodium-free food'').
    (f) A nutrient content claim shall be in type size no larger than 
two times the statement of identity and shall not be unduly prominent in 
type style compared to the statement of identity.
    (g) The label or labeling of a food for which a nutrient content 
claim is made shall contain prominently and in immediate proximity to 
such claim, the following referral statement: ``See --------------------
------------ for nutrition information'' with the blank filled in with 
the identity of the panel on which nutrition labeling is located, except 
that when such a claim appears on the panel that bears nutrition 
information the referral statement may be omitted.
    (1) The referral statement ``See [appropriate panel] for nutrition 
information'' shall be in easily legible boldface print or type, in 
distinct contrast to other printed or graphic matter, and in a size no 
less than that required by Sec. 101.105(i) for the net quantity of 
contents statement, except where the size of the claim is less than two 
times the required size of the net quantity of contents statement, in 
which case the referral statement shall be no less than one-half the 
size of the claim but no smaller than one-sixteenth of an inch, unless 
the package complies with Sec. 101.2(c)(5), in which case the referral 
statement may be in type of not less than one thirty-second of an inch.
    (2) The referral statement shall be immediately adjacent to the 
nutrient content claim and may have no intervening material other than, 
if applicable, other information in the statement of identity or any 
other information that is required to be presented with the claim under 
this section (e.g., see paragraph (j)(2) of this section) or under a 
regulation in subpart D of this part (e.g., see Secs. 101.54 and 
101.62). If the nutrient content claim appears on more than one panel of 
the label, the referral statement shall be adjacent to the claim on each 
panel except for the panel that bears the nutrition information where it 
may be omitted.
    (3) If a single panel of a food label or labeling contains multiple 
nutrient content claims or a single claim repeated several times, a 
single referral statement may be made. The statement shall be adjacent 
to the claim that is printed in the largest type on that panel.
    (h) In place of the referral statement described in paragraph (g) of 
this section,
    (1) If a food, except a meal product as defined in Sec. 101.13(l), a 
main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), or food intended 
specifically for use by infants and children less than 2 years of age, 
contains more than 13.0 g of fat, 4.0 g of saturated fat, 60 milligrams 
(mg) of cholesterol, or 480 mg of sodium per reference amount 
customarily consumed, per labeled serving, or, for a

[[Page 63]]

food with a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or less or 2 
tablespoons or less, per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be 
reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form), then that food must 
disclose, as part of the referral statement, that the nutrient exceeding 
the specified level is present in the food as follows: ``See 
[appropriate panel] for information about [nutrient requiring 
disclosure] and other nutrients,'' e.g., ``See side panel for 
information about total fat and other nutrients.''
    (2) If a food is a meal product as defined in Sec. 101.13(l), and 
contains more than 26 g of fat, 8.0 g of saturated fat, 120 mg of 
cholesterol, or 960 mg of sodium per labeled serving, then that food 
must disclose, in accordance with the requirements as provided in 
paragraph (h)(1) of this section, that the nutrient exceeding the 
specified level is present in the food.
    (3) If a food is a main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
and contains more than 19.5 g of fat, 6.0 g of saturated fat, 90 mg of 
cholesterol, or 720 mg of sodium per labeled serving, then that food 
must disclose, in accordance with the requirements as provided in 
paragraph (h)(1) of this section, that the nutrient exceeding the 
specified level is present in the food.
    (i) Except as provided in Sec. 101.9 or Sec. 101.36, as applicable, 
or in paragraph (q)(3) of this section, the label or labeling of a 
product may contain a statement about the amount or percentage of a 
nutrient if:
    (1) The use of the statement on the food implicitly characterizes 
the level of the nutrient in the food and is consistent with a 
definition for a claim, as provided in subpart D of this part, for the 
nutrient that the label addresses. Such a claim might be, ``less than 3 
g of fat per serving;''
    (2) The use of the statement on the food implicitly characterizes 
the level of the nutrient in the food and is not consistent with such a 
definition, but the label carries a disclaimer adjacent to the statement 
that the food is not ``low'' in or a ``good source'' of the nutrient, 
such as ``only 200 mg sodium per serving, not a low sodium food.'' The 
disclaimer must be in easily legible print or type and in a size no less 
than that required by Sec. 101.105(i) for the net quantity of contents 
statement except where the size of the claim is less than two times the 
required size of the net quantity of contents statement, in which case 
the disclaimer shall be no less than one-half the size of the claim but 
no smaller than one-sixteenth of an inch unless the package complies 
with Sec. 101.2(c)(5), in which case the disclaimer may be in type of 
not less less than one thirty-second of an inch, or
    (3) The statement does not in any way implicitly characterize the 
level of the nutrient in the food and it is not false or misleading in 
any respect (e.g., ``100 calories'' or ``5 grams of fat''), in which 
case no disclaimer is required.
    (4) ``Percent fat free'' claims are not authorized by this 
paragraph. Such claims shall comply with Sec. 101.62(b)(6).
    (j) A food may bear a statement that compares the level of a 
nutrient in the food with the level of a nutrient in a reference food. 
These statements shall be known as ``relative claims'' and include 
``light,'' ``reduced,'' ``less'' (or ``fewer''), and ``more'' claims.
    (1) To bear a relative claim about the level of a nutrient, the 
amount of that nutrient in the food must be compared to an amount of 
nutrient in an appropriate reference food as specified below.
    (i)(A) For ``less'' (or ``fewer'') and ``more'' claims, the 
reference food may be a dissimilar food within a product category that 
can generally be substituted for one another in the diet (e.g., potato 
chips as reference for pretzels, orange juice as a reference for vitamin 
C tablets) or a similar food (e.g., potato chips as reference for potato 
chips, one brand of multivitamin as reference for another brand of 
multivitamin).
    (B) For ``light,'' ``reduced,'' ``added,'' ``extra,'' ``fortified,'' 
and ``enriched'' claims, the reference food shall be a similar food 
(e.g., potato chips as a reference for potato chips, one brand of 
multivitamin for another brand of multivitamin), and

[[Page 64]]

    (ii)(A) For ``light'' claims, the reference food shall be 
representative of the type of food that includes the product that bears 
the claim. The nutrient value for the reference food shall be 
representative of a broad base of foods of that type; e.g., a value in a 
representative, valid data base; an average value determined from the 
top three national (or regional) brands, a market basket norm; or, where 
its nutrient value is representative of the food type, a market leader. 
Firms using such a reference nutrient value as a basis for a claim, are 
required to provide specific information upon which the nutrient value 
was derived, on request, to consumers and appropriate regulatory 
officials.
    (B) For relative claims other than ``light,'' including ``less'' and 
``more'' claims, the reference food may be the same as that provided for 
``light'' in paragraph (j)(1)(ii)(A) of this section, or it may be the 
manufacturer's regular product, or that of another manufacturer, that 
has been offered for sale to the public on a regular basis for a 
substantial period of time in the same geographic area by the same 
business entity or by one entitled to use its trade name. The nutrient 
values used to determine the claim when comparing a single 
manufacturer's product to the labeled product shall be either the values 
declared in nutrition labeling or the actual nutrient values, provided 
that the resulting label is internally consistent to (i.e., that the 
values stated in the nutrition information, the nutrient values in the 
accompanying information and the declaration of the percentage of 
nutrient by which the food has been modified are consistent and will not 
cause consumer confusion when compared), and that the actual 
modification is at least equal to the percentage specified in the 
definition of the claim.
    (2) For foods bearing relative claims:
    (i) The label or labeling must state the identity of the reference 
food and the percentage (or fraction) of the amount of the nutrient in 
the reference food by which the nutrient in the labeled food differs 
(e.g., ``50 percent less fat than (reference food)'' or ``1/3 fewer 
calories than (reference food)''),
    (ii) This information shall be immediately adjacent to the most 
prominent claim. The type size shall be in accordance with paragraph 
(g)(1) of this section.
    (iii) The determination of which use of the claim is in the most 
prominent location on the label or labeling will be made based on the 
following factors, considered in order:
    (A) A claim on the principal display panel adjacent to the statement 
of identity;
    (B) A claim elsewhere on the principal display panel;
    (C) A claim on the information panel; or
    (D) A claim elsewhere on the label or labeling.
    (iv) The label or labeling must also bear:
    (A) Clear and concise quantitative information comparing the amount 
of the subject nutrient in the product per labeled serving with that in 
the reference food; and
    (B) This statement shall appear adjacent to the most prominent claim 
or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (3) A relative claim for decreased levels of a nutrient may not be 
made on the label or in labeling of a food if the nutrient content of 
the reference food meets the requirement for a ``low'' claim for that 
nutrient (e.g., 3 g fat or less).
    (k) The term ``modified'' may be used in the statement of identity 
of a food that bears a relative claim that complies with the 
requirements of this part, followed immediately by the name of the 
nutrient whose content has been altered (e.g., ``Modified fat 
cheesecake''). This statement of identity must be immediately followed 
by the comparative statement such as ``Contains 35 percent less fat than 
----------.'' The label or labeling must also bear the information 
required by paragraph (j)(2) of this section in the manner prescribed.
    (l) For purposes of making a claim, a ``meal product shall be 
defined as a food that:

[[Page 65]]

    (1) Makes a major contribution to the total diet by:
    (i) Weighing at least 10 ounces (oz) per labeled serving; and
    (ii) Containing not less than three 40-g portions of food, or 
combinations of foods, from two or more of the following four food 
groups, except as noted in paragraph (l)(1)(ii)(E) of this section.
    (A) Bread, cereal, rice, and pasta group;
    (B) Fruits and vegetables group;
    (C) Milk, yogurt, and cheese group;
    (D) Meat, poultry, fish, dry beans, eggs, and nuts group; except 
that;
    (E) These foods shall not be sauces (except for foods in the above 
four food groups that are in the sauces), gravies, condiments, relishes, 
pickles, olives, jams, jellies, syrups, breadings or garnishes; and
    (2) Is represented as, or is in a form commonly understood to be, a 
breakfast, lunch, dinner, or meal. Such representations may be made 
either by statements, photographs, or vignettes.
    (m) For purposes of making a claim, a ``main dish product'' shall be 
defined as a food that:
    (1) Makes a major contribution to a meal by
    (i) Weighing at least 6 oz per labeled serving; and
    (ii) Containing not less than 40 g of food, or combinations of 
foods, from each of at least two of the following four food groups, 
except as noted in paragraph (m)(1)(ii)(E) of this section.
    (A) Bread, cereal, rice, and pasta group;
    (B) Fruits and vegetables group;
    (C) Milk, yogurt, and cheese group;
    (D) Meat, poultry, fish, dry beans, eggs, and nuts groups; except 
that:
    (E) These foods shall not be sauces (except for foods in the above 
four food groups that are in the sauces) gravies, condiments, relishes, 
pickles, olives, jams, jellies, syrups, breadings, or garnishes; and
    (2) Is represented as, or is in a form commonly understood to be, a 
main dish (e.g, not a beverage or a dessert). Such representations may 
be made either by statements, photographs, or vignettes.
    (n) Nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, 
or Sec. 101.36, as applicable, shall be provided for any food for which 
a nutrient content claim is made.
    (o) Except as provided in Sec. 101.10, compliance with requirements 
for nutrient content claims in this section and in the regulations in 
subpart D of this part, will be determined using the analytical 
methodology prescribed for determining compliance with nutrition 
labeling in Sec. 101.9.
    (p)(1) Unless otherwise specified, the reference amount customarily 
consumed set forth in Sec. 101.12(b) through (f) shall be used in 
determining whether a product meets the criteria for a nutrient content 
claim. If the serving size declared on the product label differs from 
the reference amount customarily consumed, and the amount of the 
nutrient contained in the labeled serving does not meet the maximum or 
minimum amount criterion in the definition for the descriptor for that 
nutrient, the claim shall be followed by the criteria for the claim as 
required by Sec. 101.12(g) (e.g., ``very low sodium, 35 mg or less per 
240 milliliters (8 fl oz.)'').
    (2) The criteria for the claim shall be immediately adjacent to the 
most prominent claim in easily legible print or type and in a size in 
accordance with paragraph (g)(1) of this section.
    (q) The following exemptions apply:
    (1) Nutrient content claims that have not been defined by regulation 
and that are contained in the brand name of a specific food product that 
was the brand name in use on such food before October 25, 1989, may 
continue to be used as part of that brand name for such product, 
provided that they are not false or misleading under section 403(a) of 
the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act). However, foods 
bearing such claims must comply with section 403(f), (g), and (h) of the 
act;
    (2) A soft drink that used the term ``diet'' as part of its brand 
name before October 25, 1989, and whose use of that term was in 
compliance with Sec. 105.66 of this chapter as that regulation appeared 
in the Code of Federal Regulations on that date, may continue to use 
that term as part of its brand name, provided that its use of the term 
is not false or misleading under section 403(a) of the act. Such claims 
are exempt from the requirements of section

[[Page 66]]

403(r)(2) of the act (e.g., the referral statement also required by 
Sec. 101.13(g) and the disclosure statement also required by 
Sec. 101.13(h)). Soft drinks marketed after October 25, 1989, may use 
the term ``diet'' provided they are in compliance with the current 
Sec. 105.66 of this chapter and the requirements of Sec. 101.13.
    (3) A statement that describes the percentage of a vitamin or 
mineral in the food, including foods intended specifically for use by 
infants and children less than 2 years of age, in relation to a 
Reference Daily Intake (RDI) as defined in Sec. 101.9 may be made on the 
label or in labeling of a food without a regulation authorizing such a 
claim for a specific vitamin or mineral unless such claim is expressly 
prohibited by regulation under section 403(r)(2)(A)(vi) of the act.
    (4) The requirements of this section do not apply to:
    (i) Infant formulas subject to section 412(h) of the act; and
    (ii) Medical foods defined by section 5(b) of the Orphan Drug Act.
    (5) A nutrient content claim used on food that is served in 
restaurants (except on menus) or other establishments in which food is 
served for immediate human consumption or which is sold for sale or use 
in such establishments shall comply with the requirements of this 
section and the appropriate definition in subpart D of this part, except 
that:
    (i) Such claim is exempt from the requirements for disclosure 
statements in paragraphs (g) and (h) of this section and 
Secs. 101.54(d), 101.62(c), (d)(1)(ii)(D), (d)(2)(iii)(C), (d)(3), 
(d)(4)(ii)(C), and (d)(5)(ii)(C); and
    (ii) In lieu of analytical testing, compliance may be determined 
using a reasonable basis for concluding that the food that bears the 
claim meets the definition for the claim. This reasonable basis may 
derive from recognized data bases for raw and processed foods, recipes, 
and other means to compute nutrient levels in the foods or meals and may 
be used provided reasonable steps are taken to ensure that the method of 
preparation adheres to the factors on which the reasonable basis was 
determined (e.g., types and amounts of ingredients, cooking 
temperatures, etc.). Firms making claims on foods based on this 
reasonable basis criterion are required to provide to appropriate 
regulatory officials on request the specific information on which their 
determination is based and reasonable assurance of operational adherence 
to the preparation methods or other basis for the claim; and
    (iii) A term or symbol that may in some contexts constitute a claim 
under this section may be used, provided that the use of the term or 
symbol does not characterize the level of a nutrient, and a statement 
that clearly explains the basis for the use of the term or symbol is 
prominently displayed and does not characterize the level of a nutrient. 
For example, a term such as ``lite fare'' followed by an asterisk 
referring to a note that makes clear that in this restaurant ``lite 
fare'' means smaller portion sizes than normal; or an item bearing a 
symbol referring to a note that makes clear that this item meets the 
criteria for the dietary guidance established by a recognized dietary 
authority would not be considered a nutrient content claim under 
Sec. 101.13.
     (6) Nutrient content claims that were part of the common or usual 
names of foods that were subject to a standard of identity on November 
8, 1990, are not subject to the requirements of paragraphs (b), (g), and 
(h) of this section or to definitions in subpart D of this part.
     (7) Implied nutrient content claims may be used as part of a brand 
name, provided that the use of the claim has been authorized by the Food 
and Drug Administration. Petitions requesting approval of such a claim 
may be submitted under Sec. 101.69(o).
    (8) The term ``fluoridated,'' ``fluoride added'' or ``with added 
fluoride'' may be used on the label or in labeling of bottled water that 
contains added fluoride.

[58 FR 2410, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17341, 17342, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended 
at 58 FR 44030, Aug. 18, 1993; 59 FR 393, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 15051, 
Mar. 31, 1994; 60 FR 17205, Apr. 5, 1995; 61 FR 11731, Mar. 22, 1996]



Sec. 101.14  Health claims: general requirements.

    (a) Definitions. For purposes of this section, the following 
definitions apply:

[[Page 67]]

    (1) Health claim means any claim made on the label or in labeling of 
a food, including a dietary supplement, that expressly or by 
implication, including ``third party'' references, written statements 
(e.g., a brand name including a term such as ``heart''), symbols (e.g., 
a heart symbol), or vignettes, characterizes the relationship of any 
substance to a disease or health-related condition. Implied health 
claims include those statements, symbols, vignettes, or other forms of 
communication that suggest, within the context in which they are 
presented, that a relationship exists between the presence or level of a 
substance in the food and a disease or health-related condition.
    (2) Substance means a specific food or component of food, regardless 
of whether the food is in conventional food form or a dietary supplement 
that includes vitamins, minerals, herbs, or other similar nutritional 
substances.
    (3) Nutritive value means a value in sustaining human existence by 
such processes as promoting growth, replacing loss of essential 
nutrients, or providing energy.
    (4) Dietary supplement means a food, not in conventional food form, 
that supplies a component to supplement the diet by increasing the total 
dietary intake of that component.
    (5) Disqualifying nutrient levels means the levels of total fat, 
saturated fat, cholesterol, or sodium in a food above which the food 
will be disqualified from making a health claim. These levels are 13.0 
grams (g) of fat, 4.0 g of saturated fat, 60 milligrams (mg) of 
cholesterol, or 480 mg of sodium, per reference amount customarily 
consumed, per label serving size, and, only for foods with reference 
amounts customarily consumed of 30 g or less or 2 tablespoons or less, 
per 50 g. For dehydrated foods that must have water added to them prior 
to typical consumption, the per 50-g criterion refers to the as prepared 
form. Any one of the levels, on a per reference amount customarily 
consumed, a per label serving size or, when applicable, a per 50 g 
basis, will disqualify a food from making a health claim unless an 
exception is provided in subpart E of this part, except that:
    (i) The levels for a meal product as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) are 
26.0 g of fat, 8.0 g of saturated fat, 120 mg of cholesterol, or 960 mg 
of sodium per label serving size, and
     (ii) The levels for a main dish product as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m) are 19.5 g of fat, 6.0 g of saturated fat, 90 mg of 
cholesterol, or 720 mg of sodium per label serving size.
    (6) Disease or health-related condition means damage to an organ, 
part, structure, or system of the body such that it does not function 
properly (e.g., cardiovascular disease), or a state of health leading to 
such dysfunctioning (e.g., hypertension); except that diseases resulting 
from essential nutrient deficiencies (e.g., scurvy, pellagra) are not 
included in this definition (claims pertaining to such diseases are 
thereby not subject to Sec. 101.14 or Sec. 101.70).
    (b) Eligibility. For a substance to be eligible for a health claim:
    (1) The substance must be associated with a disease or health-
related condition for which the general U.S. population, or an 
identified U.S. population subgroup (e.g., the elderly) is at risk, or, 
alternatively, the petition submitted by the proponent of the claim 
otherwise explains the prevalence of the disease or health-related 
condition in the U.S. population and the relevance of the claim in the 
context of the total daily diet and satisfies the other requirements of 
this section.
    (2) If the substance is to be consumed as a component of a 
conventional food at decreased dietary levels, the substance must be a 
nutrient listed in 21 U.S.C. 343(q)(1)(C) or (q)(1)(D), or one that the 
Food and Drug Administration (FDA) has required to be included in the 
label or labeling under 21 U.S.C. 343(q)(2)(A); or
    (3) If the substance is to be consumed at other than decreased 
dietary levels:
    (i) The substance must, regardless of whether the food is in 
conventional food form or dietary supplement form, contribute taste, 
aroma, or nutritive value, or any other technical effect listed in 
Sec. 170.3(o) of this chapter, to the food and must retain that 
attribute when consumed at levels that are necessary to justify a claim; 
and
    (ii) The substance must be a food or a food ingredient or a 
component of a

[[Page 68]]

food ingredient whose use at the levels necessary to justify a claim has 
been demonstrated by the proponent of the claim, to FDA's satisfaction, 
to be safe and lawful under the applicable food safety provisions of the 
Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act.
    (c) Validity requirement. FDA will promulgate regulations 
authorizing a health claim only when it determines, based on the 
totality of publicly available scientific evidence (including evidence 
from well-designed studies conducted in a manner which is consistent 
with generally recognized scientific procedures and principles), that 
there is significant scientific agreement, among experts qualified by 
scientific training and experience to evaluate such claims, that the 
claim is supported by such evidence.
    (d) General health claim labeling requirements. (1) When FDA 
determines that a health claim meets the validity requirements of 
paragraph (c) of this section, FDA will propose a regulation in subpart 
E of this part to authorize the use of that claim. If the claim pertains 
to a substance not provided for in Sec. 101.9 or Sec. 101.36, FDA will 
propose amending that regulation to include declaration of the 
substance.
    (2) When FDA has adopted a regulation in subpart E of this part 
providing for a health claim, firms may make claims based on the 
regulation in subpart E of this part, provided that:
    (i) All label or labeling statements about the substance-disease 
relationship that is the subject of the claim are based on, and 
consistent with, the conclusions set forth in the regulations in subpart 
E of this part;
    (ii) The claim is limited to describing the value that ingestion (or 
reduced ingestion) of the substance, as part of a total dietary pattern, 
may have on a particular disease or health-related condition;
    (iii) The claim is complete, truthful, and not misleading. Where 
factors other than dietary intake of the substance affect the 
relationship between the substance and the disease or health-related 
condition, such factors may be required to be addressed in the claim by 
a specific regulation in subpart E of this part;
    (iv) All information required to be included in the claim appears in 
one place without other intervening material, except that the principal 
display panel of the label or labeling may bear the reference statement, 
``See -------------- for information about the relationship between ----
---------- and ------------,'' with the blanks filled in with the 
location of the labeling containing the health claim, the name of the 
substance, and the disease or health-related condition (e.g., ``See 
attached pamphlet for information about calcium and osteoporosis''), 
with the entire claim appearing elsewhere on the other labeling, 
Provided that, where any graphic material (e.g., a heart symbol) 
constituting an explicit or implied health claim appears on the label or 
labeling, the reference statement or the complete claim shall appear in 
immediate proximity to such graphic material;
    (v) The claim enables the public to comprehend the information 
provided and to understand the relative significance of such information 
in the context of a total daily diet; and
    (vi) If the claim is about the effects of consuming the substance at 
decreased dietary levels, the level of the substance in the food is 
sufficiently low to justify the claim. To meet this requirement, if a 
definition for use of the term ``low'' has been established for that 
substance under this part, the substance must be present at a level that 
meets the requirements for use of that term, unless a specific 
alternative level has been established for the substance in subpart E of 
this part. If no definition for ``low'' has been established, the level 
of the substance must meet the level established in the regulation 
authorizing the claim; or
    (vii) If the claim is about the effects of consuming the substance 
at other than decreased dietary levels, the level of the substance is 
sufficiently high and in an appropriate form to justify the claim. To 
meet this requirement, if a definition for use of the term ``high'' for 
that substance has been established under this part, the substance must 
be present at a level that meets the requirements for use of that term, 
unless a specific alternative level has been established for the 
substance in subpart

[[Page 69]]

E of this part. If no definition for ``high'' has been established 
(e.g., where the claim pertains to a food either as a whole food or as 
an ingredient in another food), the claim must specify the daily dietary 
intake necessary to achieve the claimed effect, as established in the 
regulation authorizing the claim; Provided That:
    (A) Where the food that bears the claim meets the requirements of 
paragraphs (d)(2)(vi) or (d)(2)(vii) of this section based on its 
reference amount customarily consumed, and the labeled serving size 
differs from that amount, the claim shall be followed by a statement 
explaining that the claim is based on the reference amount rather than 
the labeled serving size (e.g., ``Diets low in sodium may reduce the 
risk of high blood pressure, a disease associated with many factors. A 
serving of -------- ounces of this product conforms to such a diet.'').
    (B) Where the food that bears the claim is sold in a restaurant 
(except if the claim is made on a menu) or in other establishments in 
which food that is ready for human consumption is sold, the food can 
meet the requirements of paragraphs (d)(2)(vi) or (d)(2)(vii) of this 
section if the firm that sells the food has a reasonable basis on which 
to believe that the food that bears the claim meets the requirements of 
paragraphs (d)(2)(vi) and (d)(2)(vii) of this section and provides that 
basis upon request.
    (3) Nutrition labeling shall be provided in the label or labeling of 
any food for which a health claim is made in accordance with Sec. 101.9; 
for restaurant foods, in accordance with Sec. 101.10; or for dietary 
supplements of vitamins or minerals, in accordance with Sec. 101.36. The 
requirements of the introductory text of paragraph (d)(3) of this 
section are effective as of May 8, 1993, except:
    (i)--(ii) [Reserved]
    (iii) For dietary supplements of vitamins, minerals, herbs, or other 
similar nutritional substances for which the requirements of paragraph 
(d)(3) of this section will be effective July 5, 1994.
    (e) Prohibited health claims. No expressed or implied health claim 
may be made on the label or in labeling for a food, regardless of 
whether the food is in conventional food form or dietary supplement 
form, unless:
    (1) The claim is specifically provided for in subpart E of this 
part; and
    (2) The claim conforms to all general provisions of this section as 
well as to all specific provisions in the appropriate section of subpart 
E of this part;
    (3) None of the disqualifying levels identified in paragraph (a)(5) 
of this section is exceeded in the food, unless specific alternative 
levels have been established for the substance in subpart E of this 
part; or unless FDA has permitted a claim despite the fact that a 
disqualifying level of a nutrient is present in the food based on a 
finding that such a claim will assist consumers in maintaining healthy 
dietary practices, and, in accordance with the regulation in subpart E 
of this part that makes such a finding, the label bears a referral 
statement that complies with Sec. 101.13(h), highlighting the nutrient 
that exceeds the disqualifying level;
    (4) Except as provided in paragraph (e)(3) of this section, no 
substance is present at an inappropriate level as determined in the 
specific provision authorizing the claim in subpart E of this part;
    (5) The label does not represent or purport that the food is for 
infants and toddlers less than 2 years of age except if the claim is 
specifically provided for in subpart E of this part; and
    (6) Except for dietary supplements or where provided for in other 
regulations in part 101, subpart E, the food contains 10 percent or more 
of the Reference Daily Intake or the Daily Reference Value for vitamin 
A, vitamin C, iron, calcium, protein, or fiber per reference amount 
customarily consumed prior to any nutrient addition.
    (f) The requirements of this section do not apply to:
    (1) Infant formulas subject to section 412(h) of the Federal Food, 
Drug, and Cosmetic Act, and
    (2) Medical foods defined by section 5(b) of the Orphan Drug Act.
    (g)  Applicability. The requirements of this section apply to foods 
intended for human consumption that are offered for sale, regardless of 
whether the

[[Page 70]]

foods are in conventional food form or dietary supplement form.

[58 FR 2533, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17097, Apr. 1, 1993, as amended at 58 
FR 44038, Aug. 18, 1993; 59 FR 425, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 15050, Mar. 31, 
1994]



Sec. 101.15   Food; prominence of required statements.

    (a) A word, statement, or other information required by or under 
authority of the act to appear on the label may lack that prominence and 
conspicuousness required by section 403(f) of the act by reason (among 
other reasons) of:
    (1) The failure of such word, statement, or information to appear on 
the part or panel of the label which is presented or displayed under 
customary conditions of purchase;
    (2) The failure of such word, statement, or information to appear on 
two or more parts or panels of the label, each of which has sufficient 
space therefor, and each of which is so designed as to render it likely 
to be, under customary conditions of purchase, the part or panel 
displayed;
    (3) The failure of the label to extend over the area of the 
container or package available for such extension, so as to provide 
sufficient label space for the prominent placing of such word, 
statement, or information;
    (4) Insufficiency of label space (for the prominent placing of such 
word, statement, or information) resulting from the use of label space 
for any word, statement, design, or device which is not required by or 
under authority of the act to appear on the label;
    (5) Insufficiency of label space (for the prominent placing of such 
word, statement, or information) resulting from the use of label space 
to give materially greater conspicuousness to any other word, statement, 
or information, or to any design or device; or
    (6) Smallness or style of type in which such word, statement, or 
information appears, insufficient background contrast, obscuring designs 
or vignettes, or crowding with other written, printed, or graphic 
matter.
    (b) No exemption depending on insufficiency of label space, as 
prescribed in regulations promulgated under section 403 (e) or (i) of 
the act, shall apply if such insufficiency is caused by:
    (1) The use of label space for any word, statement, design, or 
device which is not required by or under authority of the act to appear 
on the label;
    (2) The use of label space to give greater conspicuousness to any 
word, statement, or other information than is required by section 403(f) 
of the act; or
    (3) The use of label space for any representation in a foreign 
language.
    (c)(1) All words, statements, and other information required by or 
under authority of the act to appear on the label or labeling shall 
appear thereon in the English language: Provided, however, That in the 
case of articles distributed solely in the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico 
or in a Territory where the predominant language is one other than 
English, the predominant language may be substituted for English.
    (2) If the label contains any representation in a foreign language, 
all words, statements, and other information required by or under 
authority of the act to appear on the label shall appear thereon in the 
foreign language: Provided, however, That individual serving-size 
packages of foods containing no more than 1\1/2\ avoirdupois ounces or 
no more than 1\1/2\ fluid ounces served with meals in restaurants, 
institutions, and passenger carriers and not intended for sale at retail 
are exempt from the requirements of this paragraph (c)(2), if the only 
representation in the foreign language(s) is the name of the food.
    (3) If any article of labeling (other than a label) contains any 
representation in a foreign language, all words, statements, and other 
information required by or under authority of the act to appear on the 
label or labeling shall appear on such article of labeling.



Sec. 101.17  Food labeling warning and notice statements.

    (a) Self-pressurized containers. (1) The label of a food packaged in 
a self-pressurized container and intended to be expelled from the 
package under pressure shall bear the following warning:


[[Page 71]]


    Warning--Avoid spraying in eyes. Contents under pressure. Do not 
puncture or incinerate. Do not store at temperature above 120 deg. F. 
Keep out of reach of children.

    (2) In the case of products intended for use by children, the phrase 
``except under adult supervision'' may be added at the end of the last 
sentence in the warning required by paragraph (a)(1) of this section.
    (3) In the case of products packaged in glass containers, the word 
``break'' may be substituted for the word ``puncture'' in the warning 
required by paragraph (a)(1) of this section.
    (4) The words ``Avoid spraying in eyes'' may be deleted from the 
warning required by paragraph (a)(1) of this section in the case of a 
product not expelled as a spray.
    (b) Self-pressurized containers with halocarbon or hydrocarbon 
propellants. (1) In addition to the warning required by paragraph (a) of 
this section, the label of a food packaged in a self-pressurized 
container in which the propellant consists in whole or in part of a 
halocarbon or a hydrocarbon shall bear the following warning:

    Warning--Use only as directed. Intentional misuse by deliberately 
concentrating and inhaling the contents can be harmful or fatal.

    (2) The warning required by paragraph (b)(1) of this section is not 
required for the following products:
    (i) Products expelled in the form of a foam or cream, which contain 
less than 10 percent propellant in the container.
    (ii) Products in a container with a physical barrier that prevents 
escape of the propellant at the time of use.
    (iii) Products of a net quantity of contents of less than 2 ounces 
that are designed to release a measured amount of product with each 
valve actuation.
    (iv) Products of a net quantity of contents of less than one-half 
ounce.
    (c) Self-pressurized containers with a chlorofluorocarbon 
propellant. (1) In addition to the warning required by paragraphs (a) 
and (b) of this section, the label on each package of a food in a self-
pressurized container in which the propellant consists in whole or in 
part of a fully halogenated chlorofluoroalkane (chlorofluorocarbon) 
shall bear the following warning:

    Warning--Contains a chlorofluorocarbon that may harm the public 
health and environment by reducing ozone in the upper atmosphere.

    (2) The warning required by paragraph (c)(1) of this section shall 
appear on an appropriate panel with such prominence and conspicuousness 
as to render it likely to be read and understood by ordinary individuals 
under normal conditions of purchase. The warning may appear on a firmly 
affixed tag, tape, card, or sticker or similar overlabeling attached to 
the package. The warning shall comply in all other respects with 
Sec. 101.2, e.g., type-size requirements.
    (3) The warning required by paragraph (c)(1) of this section is 
applicable only to self-pressurized containers that use 
chlorofluorocarbons in whole or in part as a propellant to expel from 
the container liquid or solid material different from the propellant, 
but the warning is not applicable to the use of chlorofluorocarbon as a 
stabilizer in food toppings and spreads.
    (d) Protein products. (1) The label and labeling of any food product 
in liquid, powdered, tablet, capsule, or similar forms that derives more 
than 50 percent of its total caloric value from either whole protein, 
protein hydrolysates, amino acid mixtures, or a combination of these, 
and that is represented for use in reducing weight shall bear the 
following warning:

    Warning: Very low calorie protein diets (below 400 Calories per day) 
may cause serious illness or death. Do Not Use for Weight Reduction in 
Such Diets Without Medical Supervision. Not for use by infants, 
children, or pregnant or nursing women.

    (2) Products described in paragraph (d)(1) of this section are 
exempt from the labeling requirements of that paragraph if the protein 
products are represented as part of a nutritionally balanced diet plan 
providing 400 or more Calories (kilocalories) per day and the label or 
labeling of the product specifies the diet plan in detail or provides a 
brief description of that diet plan and adequate information describing 
where

[[Page 72]]

the detailed diet plan may be obtained and the label and labeling bear 
the following statement:

    Notice: For weight reduction, use only as directed in the 
accompanying diet plan (the name and specific location in labeling of 
the diet plan may be included in this statement in place of 
``accompanying diet plan''). Do not use in diets supplying less than 400 
Calories per day without medical supervision.

    (3) The label and labeling of food products represented or intended 
for dietery (food) supplementation that derive more than 50 percent of 
their total caloric value from either whole protein, protein 
hydrolysates, amino acid mixtures, or a combination of these, that are 
represented specifically for purposes other than weight reduction; and 
that are not covered by the requirements of paragraph (d) (1) and (2) of 
this section; shall bear the following statement:

    Notice: Use this product as a food supplement only. Do not use for 
weight reduction.

    (4) The provisions of this paragraph are separate from and in 
addition to any labeling requirements promulgated by the Federal Trade 
Commission for protein supplements.
    (5) Protein products shipped in bulk form for use solely in the 
manufacture of other foods and not for distribution to consumers in such 
container are exempt from the labeling requirements of this paragraph.
    (6) The warning and notice statements required by paragraphs (d) 
(1), (2), and (3) of this section shall appear prominently and 
conspicuously on the principal display panel of the package label and 
any other labeling.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 42 FR 22033, Apr. 29, 1977; 
49 FR 13690, Apr. 6, 1984; 49 FR 28548, July 13, 1984]



Sec. 101.18   Misbranding of food.

    (a) Among representations in the labeling of a food which render 
such food misbranded is a false or misleading representation with 
respect to another food or a drug, device, or cosmetic.
    (b) The labeling of a food which contains two or more ingredients 
may be misleading by reason (among other reasons) of the designation of 
such food in such labeling by a name which includes or suggests the name 
of one or more but not all such ingredients, even though the names of 
all such ingredients are stated elsewhere in the labeling.
    (c) Among representations in the labeling of a food which render 
such food misbranded is any representation that expresses or implies a 
geographical origin of the food or any ingredient of the food except 
when such representation is either:
    (1) A truthful representation of geographical origin.
    (2) A trademark or trade name provided that as applied to the 
article in question its use is not deceptively misdescriptive. A 
trademark or trade name composed in whole or in part of geographical 
words shall not be considered deceptively misdescriptive if it:
    (i) Has been so long and exclusively used by a manufacturer or 
distributor that it is generally understood by the consumer to mean the 
product of a particular manufacturer or distributor; or
    (ii) Is so arbitrary or fanciful that it is not generally understood 
by the consumer to suggest geographic origin.
    (3) A part of the name required by applicable Federal law or 
regulation.
    (4) A name whose market significance is generally understood by the 
consumer to connote a particular class, kind, type, or style of food 
rather than to indicate geographical origin.



             Subpart B--Specific Food Labeling Requirements



Sec. 101.22   Foods; labeling of spices, flavorings, colorings and chemical preservatives.

    (a)(1) The term ``artificial flavor'' or ``artificial flavoring'' 
means any substance, the function of which is to impart flavor, which is 
not derived from a spice, fruit or fruit juice, vegetable or vegetable 
juice, edible yeast, herb, bark, bud, root, leaf or similar plant 
material, meat, fish, poultry, eggs, dairy products, or fermentation 
products thereof. Artificial flavor includes the substances listed in 
Secs. 172.515(b) and 182.60 of this chapter except where these are 
derived from natural sources.

[[Page 73]]

    (2) The term ``spice'' means any aromatic vegetable substance in the 
whole, broken, or ground form, except for those substances which have 
been traditionally regarded as foods, such as onions, garlic and celery; 
whose significant function in food is seasoning rather than nutritional; 
that is true to name; and from which no portion of any volatile oil or 
other flavoring principle has been removed. Spices include the spices 
listed in Sec. 182.10 and Part 184 of this chapter, such as the 
following:

Allspice, Anise, Basil, Bay leaves, Caraway seed, Cardamon, Celery seed, 
Chervil, Cinnamon, Cloves, Coriander, Cumin seed, Dill seed, Fennel 
seed, Fenugreek, Ginger, Horseradish, Mace, Marjoram, Mustard flour, 
Nutmeg, Oregano, Paprika, Parsley, Pepper, black; Pepper, white; Pepper, 
red; Rosemary, Saffron, Sage, Savory, Star aniseed, Tarragon, Thyme, 
Turmeric.

Paprika, turmeric, and saffron or other spices which are also colors, 
shall be declared as ``spice and coloring'' unless declared by their 
common or usual name.
    (3) The term ``natural flavor'' or ``natural flavoring'' means the 
essential oil, oleoresin, essence or extractive, protein hydrolysate, 
distillate, or any product of roasting, heating or enzymolysis, which 
contains the flavoring constituents derived from a spice, fruit or fruit 
juice, vegetable or vegetable juice, edible yeast, herb, bark, bud, 
root, leaf or similar plant material, meat, seafood, poultry, eggs, 
dairy products, or fermentation products thereof, whose significant 
function in food is flavoring rather than nutritional. Natural flavors 
include the natural essence or extractives obtained from plants listed 
in Secs. 182.10, 182.20, 182.40, and 182.50 and part 184 of this 
chapter, and the substances listed in Sec. 172.510 of this chapter.
    (4) The term ``artificial color'' or ``artificial coloring'' means 
any ``color additive'' as defined in Sec. 70.3(f) of this chapter.
    (5) The term ``chemical preservative'' means any chemical that, when 
added to food, tends to prevent or retard deterioration thereof, but 
does not include common salt, sugars, vinegars, spices, or oils 
extracted from spices, substances added to food by direct exposure 
thereof to wood smoke, or chemicals applied for their insecticidal or 
herbicidal properties.
    (b) A food which is subject to the requirements of section 403(k) of 
the act shall bear labeling, even though such food is not in package 
form.
    (c) A statement of artificial flavoring, artificial coloring, or 
chemical preservative shall be placed on the food or on its container or 
wrapper, or on any two or all three of these, as may be necessary to 
render such statement likely to be read by the ordinary person under 
customary conditions of purchase and use of such food. The specific 
artificial color used in a food shall be identified on the labeling when 
so required by regulation in part 74 of this chapter to assure safe 
conditions of use for the color additive.
    (d) A food shall be exempt from compliance with the requirements of 
section 403(k) of the act if it is not in package form and the units 
thereof are so small that a statement of artificial flavoring, 
artificial coloring, or chemical preservative, as the case may be, 
cannot be placed on such units with such conspicuousness as to render it 
likely to be read by the ordinary individual under customary conditions 
of purchase and use.
    (e) A food shall be exempt while held for sale from the requirements 
of section 403(k) of the act (requiring label statement of any 
artificial flavoring, artificial coloring, or chemical preservatives) if 
said food, having been received in bulk containers at a retail 
establishment, is displayed to the purchaser with either (1) the 
labeling of the bulk container plainly in view or (2) a counter card, 
sign, or other appropriate device bearing prominently and conspicuously 
the information required to be stated on the label pursuant to section 
403(k).
    (f) A fruit or vegetable shall be exempt from compliance with the 
requirements of section 403(k) of the act with respect to a chemical 
preservative applied to the fruit or vegetable as a pesticide chemical 
prior to harvest.
    (g) A flavor shall be labeled in the following way when shipped to a 
food manufacturer or processor (but not a consumer) for use in the 
manufacture of a fabricated food, unless it is a flavor for which a 
standard of identity

[[Page 74]]

has been promulgated, in which case it shall be labeled as provided in 
the standard:
    (1) If the flavor consists of one ingredient, it shall be declared 
by its common or usual name.
    (2) If the flavor consists of two or more ingredients, the label 
either may declare each ingredient by its common or usual name or may 
state ``All flavor ingredients contained in this product are approved 
for use in a regulation of the Food and Drug Administration.'' Any 
flavor ingredient not contained in one of these regulations, and any 
nonflavor ingredient, shall be separately listed on the label.
    (3) In cases where the flavor contains a solely natural flavor(s), 
the flavor shall be so labeled, e.g., ``strawberry flavor'', ``banana 
flavor'', or ``natural strawberry flavor''. In cases where the flavor 
contains both a natural flavor and an artificial flavor, the flavor 
shall be so labeled, e.g., ``natural and artificial strawberry flavor''. 
In cases where the flavor contains a solely artificial flavor(s), the 
flavor shall be so labeled, e.g., ``artificial strawberry flavor''.
    (h) The label of a food to which flavor is added shall declare the 
flavor in the statement of ingredients in the following way:
    (1) Spice, natural flavor, and artificial flavor may be declared as 
``spice'', ``natural flavor'', or ``artificial flavor'', or any 
combination thereof, as the case may be.
    (2) An incidental additive in a food, originating in a spice or 
flavor used in the manufacture of the food, need not be declared in the 
statement of ingredients if it meets the requirements of 
Sec. 101.100(a)(3).
    (3) Substances obtained by cutting, grinding, drying, pulping, or 
similar processing of tissues derived from fruit, vegetable, meat, fish, 
or poultry, e.g., powdered or granulated onions, garlic powder, and 
celery powder, are commonly understood by consumers to be food rather 
than flavor and shall be declared by their common or usual name.
    (4) Any salt (sodium chloride) used as an ingredient in food shall 
be declared by its common or usual name ``salt.''
    (5) Any monosodium glutamate used as an ingredient in food shall be 
declared by its common or usual name ``monosodium glutamate.''
    (6) Any pyroligneous acid or other artificial smoke flavors used as 
an ingredient in a food may be declared as artificial flavor or 
artificial smoke flavor. No representation may be made, either directly 
or implied, that a food flavored with pyroligneous acid or other 
artificial smoke flavor has been smoked or has a true smoked flavor, or 
that a seasoning sauce or similar product containing pyroligneous acid 
or other artificial smoke flavor and used to season or flavor other 
foods will result in a smoked product or one having a true smoked 
flavor.
    (7) Because protein hydrolysates function in foods as both 
flavorings and flavor enhancers, no protein hydrolysate used in food for 
its effects on flavor may be declared simply as ``flavor,'' ``natural 
flavor,'' or ``flavoring.'' The ingredient shall be declared by its 
specific common or usual name as provided in Sec. 102.22 of this 
chapter.
    (i) If the label, labeling, or advertising of a food makes any 
direct or indirect representations with respect to the primary 
recognizable flavor(s), by word, vignette, e.g., depiction of a fruit, 
or other means, or if for any other reason the manufacturer or 
distributor of a food wishes to designate the type of flavor in the food 
other than through the statement of ingredients, such flavor shall be 
considered the characterizing flavor and shall be declared in the 
following way:
    (1) If the food contains no artificial flavor which simulates, 
resembles or reinforces the characterizing flavor, the name of the food 
on the principal display panel or panels of the label shall be 
accompanied by the common or usual name of the characterizing flavor, 
e.g., ``vanilla'', in letters not less than one-half the height of the 
letters used in the name of the food, except that:
    (i) If the food is one that is commonly expected to contain a 
characterizing food ingredient, e.g., strawberries in ``strawberry 
shortcake'', and the food contains natural flavor derived from such 
ingredient and an amount of characterizing ingredient insufficient to 
independently characterize the food,

[[Page 75]]

or the food contains no such ingredient, the name of the characterizing 
flavor may be immediately preceded by the word ``natural'' and shall be 
immediately followed by the word ``flavored'' in letters not less than 
one-half the height of the letters in the name of the characterizing 
flavor, e.g., ``natural strawberry flavored shortcake,'' or ``strawberry 
flavored shortcake''.
    (ii) If none of the natural flavor used in the food is derived from 
the product whose flavor is simulated, the food in which the flavor is 
used shall be labeled either with the flavor of the product from which 
the flavor is derived or as ``artificially flavored.''
    (iii) If the food contains both a characterizing flavor from the 
product whose flavor is simulated and other natural flavor which 
simulates, resembles or reinforces the characterizing flavor, the food 
shall be labeled in accordance with the introductory text and paragraph 
(i)(1)(i) of this section and the name of the food shall be immediately 
followed by the words ``with other natural flavor'' in letters not less 
than one-half the height of the letters used in the name of the 
characterizing flavor.
    (2) If the food contains any artificial flavor which simulates, 
resembles or reinforces the characterizing flavor, the name of the food 
on the principal display panel or panels of the label shall be 
accompanied by the common or usual name(s) of the characterizing flavor, 
in letters not less than one-half the height of the letters used in the 
name of the food and the name of the characterizing flavor shall be 
accompanied by the word(s) ``artificial'' or ``artificially flavored'', 
in letters not less than one-half the height of the letters in the name 
of the characterizing flavor, e.g., ``artificial vanilla'', 
``artificially flavored strawberry'', or ``grape artificially 
flavored''.
    (3) Wherever the name of the characterizing flavor appears on the 
label (other than in the statement of ingredients) so conspicuously as 
to be easily seen under customary conditions of purchase, the words 
prescribed by this paragraph shall immediately and conspicuously precede 
or follow such name, without any intervening written, printed, or 
graphic matter, except:
    (i) Where the characterizing flavor and a trademark or brand are 
presented together, other written, printed, or graphic matter that is a 
part of or is associated with the trademark or brand may intervene if 
the required words are in such relationship with the trademark or brand 
as to be clearly related to the characterizing flavor; and
    (ii) If the finished product contains more than one flavor subject 
to the requirements of this paragraph, the statements required by this 
paragraph need appear only once in each statement of characterizing 
flavors present in such food, e.g., ``artificially flavored vanilla and 
strawberry''.
    (iii) If the finished product contains three or more distinguishable 
characterizing flavors, or a blend of flavors with no primary 
recognizable flavor, the flavor may be declared by an appropriately 
descriptive generic term in lieu of naming each flavor, e.g., 
``artificially flavored fruit punch''.
    (4) A flavor supplier shall certify, in writing, that any flavor he 
supplies which is designated as containing no artificial flavor does 
not, to the best of his knowledge and belief, contain any artificial 
flavor, and that he has added no artificial flavor to it. The 
requirement for such certification may be satisfied by a guarantee under 
section 303(c)(2) of the act which contains such a specific statement. A 
flavor used shall be required to make such a written certification only 
where he adds to or combines another flavor with a flavor which has been 
certified by a flavor supplier as containing no artificial flavor, but 
otherwise such user may rely upon the supplier's certification and need 
make no separate certification. All such certifications shall be 
retained by the certifying party throughout the period in which the 
flavor is supplied and for a minimum of three years thereafter, and 
shall be subject to the following conditions:
    (i) The certifying party shall make such certifications available 
upon request at all reasonable hours to any duly authorized office or 
employee of the Food and Drug Administration or any other employee 
acting on behalf of the Secretary of Health and Human

[[Page 76]]

Services. Such certifications are regarded by the Food and Drug 
Administration as reports to the government and as guarantees or other 
undertakings within the meaning of section 301(h) of the act and subject 
the certifying party to the penalties for making any false report to the 
government under 18 U.S.C. 1001 and any false guarantee or undertaking 
under section 303(a) of the act. The defenses provided under section 
303(c)(2) of the act shall be applicable to the certifications provided 
for in this section.
    (ii) Wherever possible, the Food and Drug Administration shall 
verify the accuracy of a reasonable number of certifications made 
pursuant to this section, constituting a representative sample of such 
certifications, and shall not request all such certifications.
    (iii) Where no person authorized to provide such information is 
reasonably available at the time of inspection, the certifying party 
shall arrange to have such person and the relevant materials and records 
ready for verification as soon as practicable: Provided, That, whenever 
the Food and Drug Administration has reason to believe that the supplier 
or user may utilize this period to alter inventories or records, such 
additional time shall not be permitted. Where such additional time is 
provided, the Food and Drug Administration may require the certifying 
party to certify that relevant inventories have not been materially 
disturbed and relevant records have not been altered or concealed during 
such period.
    (iv) The certifying party shall provide, to an officer or 
representative duly designated by the Secretary, such qualitative 
statement of the composition of the flavor or product covered by the 
certification as may be reasonably expected to enable the Secretary's 
representatives to determine which relevant raw and finished materials 
and flavor ingredient records are reasonably necessary to verify the 
certifications. The examination conducted by the Secretary's 
representative shall be limited to inspection and review of inventories 
and ingredient records for those certifications which are to be 
verified.
    (v) Review of flavor ingredient records shall be limited to the 
qualitative formula and shall not include the quantitative formula. The 
person verifying the certifications may make only such notes as are 
necessary to enable him to verify such certification. Only such notes or 
such flavor ingredient records as are necessary to verify such 
certification or to show a potential or actual violation may be removed 
or transmitted from the certifying party's place of business: Provided, 
That, where such removal or transmittal is necessary for such purposes 
the relevant records and notes shall be retained as separate documents 
in Food and Drug Administration files, shall not be copied in other 
reports, and shall not be disclosed publicly other than in a judicial 
proceeding brought pursuant to the act or 18 U.S.C. 1001.
    (j) A food to which a chemical preservative(s) is added shall, 
except when exempt pursuant to Sec. 101.100 bear a label declaration 
stating both the common or usual name of the ingredient(s) and a 
separate description of its function, e.g., ``preservative'', ``to 
retard spoilage'', ``a mold inhibitor'', ``to help protect flavor'' or 
``to promote color retention''.
    (k) The label of a food to which any coloring has been added shall 
declare the coloring in the statement of ingredients in the manner 
specified in paragraphs (k)(1) and (k)(2) of this section, except that 
colorings added to butter, cheese, and ice cream, if declared, may be 
declared in the manner specified in paragraph (k)(3) of this section, 
and colorings added to foods subject to Secs. 105.62 and 105.65 of this 
chapter shall be declared in accordance with the requirements of those 
sections.
    (1) A color additive or the lake of a color additive subject to 
certification under 721(c) of the act shall be declared by the name of 
the color additive listed in the applicable regulation in part 74 or 
part 82 of this chapter, except that it is not necessary to include the 
``FD&C'' prefix or the term ``No.'' in the declaration, but the term 
``Lake'' shall be included in the declaration of the lake of the 
certified color additive (e.g., Blue 1 Lake). Manufacturers may 
parenthetically declare an appropriate alternative name of the certified 
color additive following its common or usual

[[Page 77]]

name as specified in part 74 or part 82 of this chapter.
    (2) Color additives not subject to certification may be declared as 
``Artificial Color,'' ``Artificial Color Added,'' or ``Color Added'' (or 
by an equally informative term that makes clear that a color additive 
has been used in the food). Alternatively, such color additives may be 
declared as ``Colored with --------------'' or ``------------ color'', 
the blank to be filled with the name of the color additive listed in the 
applicable regulation in part 73 of this chapter.
    (3) When a coloring has been added to butter, cheese, or ice cream, 
it need not be declared in the ingredient list unless such declaration 
is required by a regulation in part 73 or part 74 of this chapter to 
ensure safe conditions of use for the color additive. Voluntary 
declaration of all colorings added to butter, cheese, and ice cream, 
however, is recommended.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 44 FR 3963, Jan. 19, 1979; 44 
FR 37220, June 26, 1979; 54 FR 24891, June 12, 1989; 58 FR 2875, Jan. 6, 
1993]



Sec. 101.29   Labeling of kosher and kosher-style foods.

    The term ``kosher'' should be used only on food products that meet 
certain religious dietary requirements. The precise significance of the 
phrase ``kosher style'' as applied to any particular product by the 
public has not been determined. There is a likelihood that the use of 
the term may cause the prospective purchaser to think that the product 
is ``kosher.'' Accordingly, the Food and Drug Administration believes 
that use of the phrase should be discouraged on products that do not 
meet the religious dietary requirements.



Sec. 101.30  Percentage juice declaration for foods purporting to be beverages that contain fruit or vegetable juice.

    (a) This section applies to any food that purports to be a beverage 
that contains any fruit or vegetable juice (i.e., the product's 
advertising, label, or labeling bears the name of, or variation on the 
name of, or makes any other direct or indirect representation with 
respect to, any fruit or vegetable juice), or the label or labeling 
bears any vignette (i.e., depiction of a fruit or vegetable) or other 
pictorial representation of any fruit or vegetable, or the product 
contains color and flavor that gives the beverage the appearance and 
taste of containing a fruit or vegetable juice. The beverage may be 
carbonated or noncarbonated, concentrated, full-strength, diluted, or 
contain no juice. For example, a soft drink (soda) that does not 
represent or suggest by its physical characteristics, name, labeling, 
ingredient statement, or advertising that it contains fruit or vegetable 
juice does not purport to contain juice and therefore does not require a 
percent juice declaration.
    (b)(1) If the beverage contains fruit or vegetable juice, the 
percentage shall be declared by the words ``Contains -------------- 
percent (or %) ------------ juice'' or `` ------------ percent (or %) 
juice,'' or a similar phrase, with the first blank filled in with the 
percentage expressed as a whole number not greater than the actual 
percentage of the juice and the second blank (if used) filled in with 
the name of the particular fruit or vegetable (e.g., ``Contains 50 
percent apple juice'' or ``50 percent juice'').
    (2) If the beverage contains less than 1 percent juice, the total 
percentage juice shall be declared as ``less than 1 percent juice'' or 
``less than 1 percent ------------ juice'' with the blank filled in with 
the name of the particular fruit or vegetable.
    (3) If the beverage contains 100 percent juice and also contains 
non-juice ingredients that do not result in a diminution of the juice 
soluble solids or, in the case of expressed juice, in a change in the 
volume, when the 100 percent juice declaration appears on a panel of the 
label that does not also bear the ingredient statement, it must be 
accompanied by the phrase ``with added ----------,'' the blank filled in 
with a term such as ``ingredient(s),'' ``preservative,'' or 
``sweetener,'' as appropriate (e.g., ``100% juice with added 
sweetener''), except that when the presence of the non-juice 
ingredient(s) is declared as a part of the statement of identity of the 
product, this phrase need not accompany the 100 percent juice 
declaration.

[[Page 78]]

    (c) If a beverage contains minor amounts of juice for flavoring and 
is labeled with a flavor description using terms such as ``flavor'', 
``flavored'', or ``flavoring'' with a fruit or vegetable name and does 
not bear:
    (1) The term ``juice'' on the label other than in the ingredient 
statement; or
    (2) An explicit vignette depicting the fruit or vegetable from which 
the flavor derives, such as juice exuding from a fruit or vegetable; or
    (3) Specific physical resemblance to a juice or distinctive juice 
characteristic such as pulp then total percentage juice declaration is 
not required.
    (d) If the beverage does not meet the criteria for exemption from 
total juice percentage declaration as described in paragraph (c) of this 
section and contains no fruit or vegetable juice, but the labeling or 
color and flavor of the beverage represents, suggests, or implies that 
fruit or vegetable juice may be present (e.g., the product advertising 
or labeling bears the name, a variation of the name, or a pictorial 
representation of any fruit or vegetable, or the product contains color 
and flavor that give the beverage the appearance and taste of containing 
a fruit or vegetable juice), then the label shall declare ``contains 
zero (0) percent (or %) juice''. Alternatively, the label may declare 
``Containing (or contains) no ---------- juice'', or ``no ---------- 
juice'', or ``does not contain ------------ juice'', the blank to be 
filled in with the name of the fruits or vegetables represented, 
suggested, or implied, but if there is a general suggestion that the 
product contains fruit or vegetable juice, such as the presence of fruit 
pulp, the blank shall be filled in with the word ``fruit'' or 
``vegetable'' as applicable (e.g., ``contains no fruit juice'', or 
``does not contain fruit juice'').
    (e) If the beverage is sold in a package with an information panel 
as defined in Sec. 101.2, the declaration of amount of juice shall be 
prominently placed on the information panel in lines generally parallel 
to other required information, appearing:
    (1) Near the top of the information panel, with no other printed 
label information appearing above the statement except the brand name, 
product name, logo, or universal product code; and
    (2) In easily legible boldface print or type in distinct contrast to 
other printed or graphic matter, in a height not less than the largest 
type found on the information panel except that used for the brand name, 
product name, logo, universal product code, or the title phrase 
``Nutrition Facts'' appearing in the nutrition information as required 
by Sec. 101.9.
    (f) The percentage juice declaration may also be placed on the 
principal display panel, provided that the declaration is consistent 
with that presented on the information panel.
    (g) If the beverage is sold in a package that does not bear an 
information panel as defined in Sec. 101.2, the percentage juice 
declaration shall be placed on the principal display panel, in type size 
not less than that required for the declaration of net quantity of 
contents statement in Sec. 101.105(i), and be placed near the name of 
the food.
    (h)(1) In enforcing these regulations, the Food and Drug 
Administration will calculate the labeled percentage of juice from 
concentrate found in a juice or juice beverage using the minimum Brix 
levels listed below where single-strength (100 percent) juice has at 
least the specified minimum Brix listed below:

                                                                        
------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                   100  
                             Juice                               percent
                                                                  juice1
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Acerola........................................................      6.0
Apple..........................................................     11.5
Apricot........................................................     11.7
Banana.........................................................     22.0
Blackberry.....................................................     10.0
Blueberry......................................................     10.0
Boysenberry....................................................     10.0
Cantaloupe Melon...............................................      9.6
Carambola......................................................      7.8
Carrot.........................................................      8.0
Casaba Melon...................................................      7.5
Cashew (Caju)..................................................     12.0
Celery.........................................................      3.1
Cherry, dark, sweet............................................     20.0
Cherry, red, sour..............................................     14.0
Crabapple......................................................     15.4
Cranberry......................................................      7.5
Currant (Black)................................................     11.0
Currant (Red)..................................................     10.5
Date...........................................................     18.5
Dewberry.......................................................     10.0
Elderberry.....................................................     11.0
Fig............................................................     18.2
Gooseberry.....................................................      8.3
Grape..........................................................     16.0

[[Page 79]]

                                                                        
Grapefruit.....................................................    310.0
Guanabana (soursop)............................................     16.0
Guava..........................................................      7.7
Honeydew melon.................................................      9.6
Kiwi...........................................................     15.4
Lemon..........................................................    2 4.5
Lime...........................................................    2 4.5
Loganberry.....................................................     10.5
Mango..........................................................     13.0
Nectarine......................................................     11.8
Orange.........................................................    311.8
Papaya.........................................................     11.5
Passion Fruit..................................................     14.0
Peach..........................................................     10.5
Pear...........................................................     12.0
Pineapple......................................................     12.8
Plum...........................................................     14.3
Pomegranate....................................................     16.0
Prune..........................................................     18.5
Quince.........................................................     13.3
Raspberry (Black)..............................................     11.1
Raspberry (Red)................................................      9.2
Rhubarb........................................................      5.7
Strawberry.....................................................      8.0
Tangerine......................................................    311.8
Tomato.........................................................      5.0
Watermelon.....................................................      7.8
Youngberry.....................................................     10.0
------------------------------------------------------------------------
\1\ Indicates Brix value unless other value specified.                  
\2\ Indicates anhydrous citrus acid percent by weight.                  
\3\ Brix values determined by refractometer for citrus juices may be    
  corrected for citric acid.                                            


    (2) If there is no Brix level specified in paragraph (h)(1) of this 
section, the labeled percentage of that juice from concentrate in a 
juice or juice beverage will be calculated on the basis of the soluble 
solids content of the single-strength (unconcentrated) juice used to 
produce such concentrated juice.

    (i) Juices directly expressed from a fruit or vegetable (i.e., not 
concentrated and reconstituted) shall be considered to be 100 percent 
juice and shall be declared as ``100 percent juice.''
    (j) Calculations of the percentage of juice in a juice blend or a 
diluted juice product made directly from expressed juice (i.e., not from 
concentrate) shall be based on the percentage of the expressed juice in 
the product computed on a volume/volume basis.
    (k) If the product is a beverage that contains a juice whose color, 
taste, or other organoleptic properties have been modified to the extent 
that the original juice is no longer recognizable at the time processing 
is complete, or if its nutrient profile has been diminished to a level 
below the normal nutrient range for the juice, then that juice to which 
such a major modification has been made shall not be included in the 
total percentage juice declaration.
    (l) A beverage required to bear a percentage juice declaration on 
its label, that contains less than 100 percent juice, shall not bear any 
other percentage declaration that describes the juice content of the 
beverage in its label or in its labeling (e.g., ``100 percent natural'' 
or ``100 percent pure''). However, the label or labeling may bear 
percentage statements clearly unrelated to juice content (e.g., 
``provides 100 percent of U.S. RDA of vitamin C'').
    (m) Products purporting to be beverages that contain fruit or 
vegetable juices are exempted from the provisions of this section until 
May 8, 1994. All products that are labeled on or after that date shall 
comply with this section.

[58 FR 2925, Jan. 6, 1993, as amended at 58 FR 44063, Aug. 18, 1993; 58 
FR 49192, Sept. 22, 1993]



Sec. 101.33   Label declaration of D-erythroascorbic acid when it is an ingredient of a fabricated food.

    (a) The article d-erythroascorbic acid (d-araboascorbic acid, d-
erythro-3-keto-hexonic acid lactone) has sometimes been designated as d-
isoascorbic acid. However, this designation is capable of misleading 
purchasers of food in which it is used as an ingredient because of the 
similarity of such designation to the chemical name and the common name 
of vitamin C, which is ascorbic acid. Ascorbic acid (vitamin C) is 
capable of preventing the deficiency disease scurvy, but d-isoascorbc 
acid is ineffective for this purpose.
    (b) The Joint Committee on Nomenclature of the American Institute of 
Nutrition and the Society of Biological Chemists has considered this 
matter, and pursuant to the Committee's recommendation the respective 
scientific organizations approved a resolution to drop the use of the 
designation d-isoascorbic acid and to adopt as a common name the name 
erythorbic acid for d-erythroascorbic acid.
    (c) The compound d-erythroascorbic acid is not specified as an 
ingredient of any food for which a standard has been established. For 
foods other than those for which standards have been established, 
section 403(i)(2) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act requires

[[Page 80]]

that ingredients be listed on labels by their common or usual names. If 
the label on a food that contains d-erythroascorbic acid designates that 
ingredient by the name erythorbic acid, the requirement that the label 
bear the common or usual name of the ingredient will be regarded as 
having been met.



   Subpart C--Specific Nutrition Labeling Requirements and Guidelines

    Source: 55 FR 60890, Nov. 27, 1991, unless otherwise noted.



Sec. 101.36  Nutrition labeling of dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals.

    (a) The label of a dietary supplement of a vitamin or mineral that 
has a Reference Daily Intake (RDI) as established in 
Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv) or a Daily Reference Value (DRV) as established in 
Sec. 101.9(c)(9), shall bear nutrition labeling in accordance with this 
regulation, as illustrated in paragraph (c)(9) of this section, unless 
an exemption is provided for the product in paragraph (f) of this 
section. Dietary supplements of herbs or other similar nutritional 
substances shall bear nutrition labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9.
    (b) The declaration of nutrition information on the label and in 
labeling shall contain the following information, using the headings and 
format specified, under the heading of ``Nutrition Facts''. The 
nutrition information shall be enclosed in a box by use of lines, shall 
be all black or one color type, and shall be printed on a white or other 
neutral contrasting background whenever practical.
    (1) The subheading ``Serving Size'' shall be placed under the 
heading and aligned on the left side of the nutrition label. The serving 
size shall be determined in accordance with Sec. 101.9(b) and 
Sec. 101.12(b), Table 2. Serving size shall be expressed using a term 
that is appropriate for the form of the supplement, such as ``tablets,'' 
``capsules,'' ``packets,'' or ``teaspoonfuls.''
    (2) The subheading ``Servings Per Container'' shall be placed under 
the subheading ``Serving Size'' and aligned on the left side of the 
nutrition label, except that this information need not be provided when 
it is stated in the net quantity of contents declaration.
    (3) A listing of all nutrients required in Sec. 101.9(c) that are 
present in the dietary supplement in quantitative amounts by weight that 
exceed the amount that can be declared as zero in Sec. 101.9(c). Those 
nutrients that are not present, or present in amounts that would be 
declared as zero, shall not be declared. In addition, potassium shall be 
declared except when present in quantitative amounts by weight that 
allow a declaration of zero. The name of each nutrient listed shall be 
immediately followed by the quantitative amount by weight of the 
nutrient. Nutrient names and quantitative amounts shall be presented in 
a column under the heading ``Amount Per Serving'' and aligned on the 
left side of the nutrition label. The heading ``Amount Per Serving'' 
shall be separated from other information on the label by a bar above 
and beneath it, except that when calories are listed, the bar shall be 
placed beneath the calorie declaration. When the serving size of the 
product is one unit (e.g., 1 tablet), a heading consistent with the 
declaration of serving size, such as ``Amount per Tablet'' or ``Each 
Tablet Contains,'' may be used in place of the heading ``Amount per 
Serving.'' Other appropriate terms, such as capsule, packet, or 
teaspoonful, may be used in place of the term ``Serving.''
    (i) These amounts shall be expressed in the increments specified in 
Sec. 101.9(c), except that the amounts of vitamins and minerals, 
excluding sodium and potassium, declared on the nutrition label shall be 
the actual amount of the vitamin or mineral included in the dietary 
supplement, using the units of measure and the levels of significance 
given in Sec. 101.9(c). In declaring the amounts of vitamins and 
minerals, zeros following decimal points may be dropped, and additional 
levels of significance may be used when the number of decimal places 
indicated is not sufficient to express lower amounts (e.g., the RDI for 
copper is given in whole milligrams, but the quantitative amount may be 
declared in tenths of a milligram). Amounts for chloride and manganese 
shall be expressed in mg,

[[Page 81]]

and, amounts for chromium, molybdenum, selenium, and vitamin K shall be 
expressed in micrograms. These values shall be expressed in whole 
numbers.
    (ii) Nutrients that are present shall be listed in the order 
specified in Sec. 101.9(c); except that, when present, vitamin K shall 
follow vitamin E; calcium and iron shall follow pantothenic acid; 
selenium shall follow zinc; and manganese, chromium, molybdenum, 
chloride, sodium, and potassium shall follow copper. This results in the 
following order for vitamins and minerals: Vitamin A, vitamin C, vitamin 
D, vitamin E, vitamin K, thiamin, riboflavin, niacin, vitamin B6, 
folate, vitamin B12, biotin, pantothenic acid, calcium, iron, 
phosphorus, iodine, magnesium, zinc, selenium, copper, manganese, 
chromium, molybdenum, chloride, sodium, and potassium. A bar shall 
separate the last nutrient to be listed from the bottom of the nutrition 
label, as shown in the sample labels in paragraph (c)(9) of this 
section.
    (iii) If the product contains two or more separately packaged 
dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals (e.g., the product has a 
packet of supplements to be taken in the morning and a different packet 
to be taken in the afternoon), the quantitative amounts may be presented 
as specified in this paragraph in individual nutrition labels or in one 
aggregate nutrition label with separate columns declaring the 
quantitative amounts for each package as illustrated in paragraph 
(c)(9)(iii) of this section.
    (iv) The percent of vitamin A that is present as beta-carotene may 
be declared, to the nearest whole percent, immediately adjacent to or 
beneath the nutrient name (e.g., ``Vitamin A 5000 IU (90 percent as 
beta-carotene)''), except that the declaration is required when a claim 
is made about beta-carotene. The amount of beta-carotene in terms of 
international units (IU) may be included in parentheses following the 
percent statement (e.g., ``Vitamin A 5000 IU (90 percent (4500 IU) as 
beta-carotene)'').
    (v) The following synonyms may be added in parenthesis immediately 
following the name of these nutrients: Vitamin C (ascorbic acid), 
thiamin (vitamin B1), riboflavin (vitamin B2), folate--either folic acid 
or folacin may be used, and calories (energy). Energy content per 
serving may be expressed in kilojoules units, added in parentheses 
immediately following the statement of caloric content.
    (vi) All nutrients shall be displayed with uniform type size, style, 
color, and prominence.
    (4) A listing of the percent of the Daily Value (i.e., the percent 
of the RDI as established in Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv) or DRV as established 
in Sec. 101.9(c)(9)), where appropriate, of all nutrients listed in the 
nutrition label, except that the percent for protein may be omitted as 
provided in Sec. 101.9(c)(7), no percent shall be given for sugars, and 
for labels of dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals that are 
represented or purported to be for use by infants, children less than 4 
years of age, or pregnant or lactating women, no percent shall be given 
for vitamin K, selenium, manganese, chromium, molybdenum, or chloride. 
This information shall be presented in one column aligned under the 
heading of ``% Daily Value'' and to the right of the column of nutrient 
names and amounts. The headings ``% Daily Value (DV),'' ``% DV,'' 
``Percent Daily Value,'' or ``Percent DV'' may be substituted for ``% 
Daily Value.'' The heading ``% Daily Value'' shall be placed on the same 
line as the heading ``Amount per Serving'' or placed beneath this 
heading and the bar underneath it, except that ``% Daily Value'' shall 
be placed beneath this bar when calorie information is required to be 
declared. Calorie information shall be placed beneath ``Amount Per 
Serving'' and above the bar.
    (i) The percent of Daily Value shall be calculated by dividing 
either the amount declared on the label for each nutrient or the actual 
amount of each nutrient (i.e., before rounding) by the RDI or DRV for 
the specified nutrient and multiplying by 100, except that the percent 
for protein shall be calculated as specified in Sec. 101.9(c)(7)(ii). 
The numerical value shall be followed by the symbol for percent (i.e., 
%).
    (ii) The percentages based on RDI's and on DRV's shall be expressed 
to the nearest whole percent, except that ``Less than 1%'' may be used 
in place of

[[Page 82]]

``0%'' when the declaration of the quantitative amount by weight is a 
value greater than zero.
    (iii) The percent of Daily Value for vitamins and minerals shall be 
based on RDI values for adults and children 4 or more years of age 
unless the product is represented or purported to be for use by infants, 
children less than 4 years of age, pregnant women, or lactating women, 
in which case the column heading shall clearly state the intended group. 
If the product is for persons within more than one group, the percent of 
daily value for each group shall be presented in separate columns as 
shown in paragraph (c)(9)(ii) of this section.
    (iv) If the product contains two or more separately packaged dietary 
supplements of vitamins and minerals (e.g., the product has a packet of 
supplements to be taken in the morning and a different packet to be 
taken in the afternoon), the percent of Daily Value may be presented as 
specified in paragraph (b)(4) of this section in individual nutrition 
labels or in one aggregate nutrition label with separate columns 
declaring the percent of Daily Value for each package as illustrated in 
paragraph (c)(9)(iii) of this section.
    (v) If the percent of Daily Value is declared for total fat, 
saturated fat, total carbohydrate, dietary fiber, or protein, the value 
shall be followed by an asterisk that refers to another asterisk at the 
bottom of the nutrition label that states ``Percent Daily Values are 
based on a 2,000 calorie diet.''
    (vi) When no percent is given for sugars, or for labels of dietary 
supplements of vitamins and minerals that are represented or purported 
to be for use by infants, children less than 4 years of age, or pregnant 
or lactating women, when no percent is given for vitamin K, selenium, 
manganese, chromium, molybdenum, or chloride, an asterisk shall be 
placed in the ``Percent Daily Value'' column that shall refer to another 
asterisk that is placed at the bottom of the nutrition label and 
followed by the statement ``Daily Value not established.''
    (c) Nutrition information specified in this section shall be 
presented as follows:
    (1) The title of ``Nutrition Facts'' shall be set in a type size 
larger than all other print size in the nutrition label and, unless 
impractical, shall be set full width of the nutrition label. The title 
and all headings shall be highlighted (reverse printing is not permitted 
as a form of highlighting) to distinguish them from other information.
    (2) All information within the nutrition label shall utilize a 
single easy-to-read type style.
    (3) All information within the nutrition label shall utilize upper 
and lower case letters, except that all uppercase lettering may be 
utilized for packages that have a total surface area available to bear 
labeling of less than 12 square inches.
    (4) All information within the nutrition label shall have at least 
one point leading (i.e., space between two lines of text).
    (5) Letters should never touch.
    (6) All information within the nutrition label on packages that have 
a total surface area available to bear labeling of less than 12 square 
inches shall have type size no smaller than 4.5 point; packages that 
have from 12 to 40 square inches of surface area available to bear 
labeling shall have type size no smaller than 6 point; and packages with 
more than 40 square inches of surface area available to bear labeling 
shall have type size no smaller than 8 point, except that on packages 
with more than 40 square inches of available surface area, type size no 
smaller than 6 point may be used for the listing of information on beta-
carotene, as specified in paragraph (b)(3)(iv) of this section, for the 
headings required by paragraphs (b)(3) and (b)(4) of this section (i.e., 
``Amount Per Serving'' and ``% Daily Value''), and for the footnote 
required by paragraph (b)(4)(v) of this section.
    (7) A hairline rule that is centered between the lines of text shall 
separate each nutrient and its corresponding percent Daily Value 
required in paragraph (b)(4) of this section from the nutrient and 
percent Daily Value above and beneath it, as shown in paragraph (c)(9) 
of this section, and shall separate

[[Page 83]]

``Amount Per Serving'' from the calorie statement, when the listing of 
calories is required.
    (8) In the interest of uniformity of presentation, FDA urges that 
the information be presented using the graphic specifications set forth 
in appendix B to part 101, as applicable.
    (9) The following sample labels are presented for the purpose of 
illustration:
    (i) Multiple vitamin.
    [GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.358
    

[[Page 84]]


    (ii) Multiple vitamin for children and adults.
    [GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.359
    

[[Page 85]]


    (iii) Multiple vitamins in packets.
    [GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.360
    
    (10) If space is not adequate to list the required information as 
shown in the sample labels in paragraph (c)(9) of this section, the list 
may be split and continued to the right, as long as the headings are 
repeated. The list to the right shall be set off by a line that 
distinguishes it and sets it apart from the nutrients and percent of 
Daily Value information given to the left. The following sample label 
illustrates this display:

[[Page 86]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.361


    (d)(1) Compliance with this section shall be determined in 
accordance with Sec. 101.9(g)(1) through (g)(8).
    (2) When it is not technologically feasible, or some other 
circumstance makes it impracticable, for firms to comply with the 
requirements of this section, FDA may permit alternative means of 
compliance or additional exemptions to deal with the situation in 
accordance with Sec. 101.9(g)(9). Firms in need of such special 
allowances shall make their request in writing to the Office of Food 
Labeling (HFS-150), Food and Drug Administration, 200 C St. SW., 
Washington, DC 20204.
    (e) Except as provided in paragraph (g) of this section, the 
location of nutrition information on a label shall be in compliance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (f)(1) Dietary supplements of vitamins or minerals are exempt from 
this section when they are offered for sale by a manufacturer, packer, 
or distributor who has annual gross sales made or business done in sales 
to consumers that is not more than $500,000 or has annual gross sales 
made or business done in sales of food to consumers of not more than 
$50,000, Provided, That the food bears no nutrition claims or other 
nutrition information on a label or labeling or in advertising.
    (2) For purposes of the paragraph, calculation of the amount of 
sales shall be based on the most recent 2-year average of business 
activity. Where firms have been in business less than 2 years, 
reasonable estimates must indicate that annual sales will not exceed the 
amounts specified. For foreign firms that ship foods into the United 
States, the business activities to be included shall be the total amount 
of food sales, as well as other sales to consumers, by the firm in the 
United States.
    (g) Dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals shall be subject to 
the special labeling conditions specified in Sec. 101.9(j)(5)(i) and 
(j)(5)(ii) for food, other than infant formula, represented or purported 
to be specifically for infants and children less than 2 years of age and 
4 years of age, respectively; in Sec. 101.9(j)(9) for food products 
shipped in bulk form that are not for distribution

[[Page 87]]

to consumers; in Sec. 101.9(j)(13) for foods in small or intermediate-
sized packages; in Sec. 101.9(j)(15) for foods in multiunit food 
containers; and, in Sec. 101.9(j)(16) for foods sold in bulk containers.
    (h) Dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals shall be subject to 
the misbranding provisions of Sec. 101.9(k).

[59 FR 373, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 24039, May 10, 1994, as amended at 60 FR 
67175, Dec. 28, 1995; 61 FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996; 61 FR 10280, Mar. 13, 
1996]

    Effective Date Notes: 1. At 60 FR 67175, Dec. 28, 1995, in 
Sec. 101.36, paragraphs (b)(3) introductory text, (i), (ii), (b)(4) 
introductory text, and (vi) were revised, effective January 1, 1997. At 
61 FR 10280, Mar. 13, 1996, in Sec. 101.36(b)(3)(ii) the terms ``vitamin 
B6'' and ``vitamin B12'' was corrected to make the numbers subscript, 
effective January 1, 1997. For the convenience of the reader, the 
superseded text is set forth below.
Sec. 101.35  Nutrition labeling of dietary supplements of vitamins and 
minerals.

                                * * * * *

    (b) * * *
    (3) A listing of all nutrients required in Sec. 101.9(c) that are 
present in the dietary supplement in quantitative amounts by weight that 
exceed the amount that can be declared as zero in Sec. 101.9(c). Those 
nutrients that are not present, or that are present in amounts that 
would be declared as zero, shall not be declared. In addition, 
potassium, vitamin K, chloride, chromium, fluoride, manganese, 
molybdenum, and selenium shall be declared, except when present in 
quantitative amounts by weight that allow a declaration of zero. The 
name of each nutrient listed shall be immediately followed by the 
quantitative amount by weight of the nutrient. Nutrient names and 
quantitative amounts shall be presented in a column under the heading of 
``Amount Per Serving'' and aligned on the left side of the nutrition 
label. The heading ``Amount Per Serving'' shall be separated from other 
information on the label by a bar above and beneath it, except that when 
calories are listed, the bar shall be placed beneath the calorie 
declaration. When the serving size of the product is one unit (e.g., one 
tablet), a heading consistent with the declaration of the serving size, 
such as ``Amount Per Tablet'' or ``Each Tablet Contains,'' may be used 
in place of the heading ``Amount Per Serving.'' Other appropriate terms, 
such as capsule, packet, or teaspoonful, may be used in place of the 
term ``Serving.''
    (i) These amounts shall be expressed in the increments specified in 
Sec. 101.9(c), except that the amounts of vitamins and minerals, 
excluding sodium and potassium, declared on the nutrition label shall be 
the actual amount of the vitamin or mineral included in the dietary 
supplement, using the units of measure and the levels of significance 
given in Sec. 101.9(c). In declaring the amounts of vitamins and 
minerals, zeros following decimal points may be dropped, and additional 
levels of significance may be used when the number of decimal places 
indicated is not sufficient to express lower amounts (e.g., the RDI for 
copper is given in whole milligrams (mg), but the quantitative amount 
may be declared in tenths of a mg). Amounts for chloride, fluoride, and 
manganese shall be expressed in mg, and, amounts for chromium, 
molybdenum, selenium, and vitamin K shall be expressed in micrograms. 
These values shall be expressed in whole numbers, except that tenths may 
be used for fluoride.
    (ii) Nutrients that are present shall be listed in the order 
specified in Sec. 101.9(c); except that, when present, vitamin K shall 
follow vitamin E; calcium and iron shall follow pantothenic acid; 
selenium shall follow zinc; and manganese, fluoride, chromium, 
molybdenum, chloride, sodium, and potassium shall follow copper. This 
results in the following order for vitamins and minerals: Vitamin A, 
vitamin C, vitamin D, vitamin E, vitamin K, thiamin, riboflavin, niacin, 
vitamin B6, folate, vitamin B12, biotin, pantothenic acid, calcium, 
iron, phosphorus, iodine, magnesium, zinc, selenium, copper, manganese, 
fluoride, chromium, molybdenum, chloride, sodium, and potassium. A bar 
shall separate the last nutrient to be listed from the bottom of the 
nutrition label, as shown in the sample labels in paragraph (c)(9) of 
this section.

                                * * * * *

    (4) A listing of the percent of the Daily Value (i.e., the percent 
of the RDI as established in Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv) or DRV as established 
in Sec. 101.9(c)(9)), where appropriate, of all nutrients listed in the 
nutrition label, except that the percent for protein may be omitted as 
provided in Sec. 101.9(c)(7) and no percent shall be given for sugars, 
vitamin K, chloride, chromium, fluoride, manganese, molybdenum, and 
selenium. This information shall be presented in one column aligned 
under the heading of``% Daily Value'' and to the right of the column of 
nutrient names and amounts. The headings ``% Daily Value (DV),'' ``% 
DV,'' ``Percent Daily Value,'' or ``Percent DV'' may be substituted for 
``% Daily Value.'' The heading ``% Daily Value'' shall be placed on the 
same line as the heading ``Amount Per Serving'' or placed beneath this 
heading and the bar underneath it, except that ``% Daily Value'' shall 
be placed beneath this bar when calorie information is required to be 
declared. Calorie information

[[Page 88]]

shall be placed beneath ``Amount Per Serving'' and above the bar.

                                * * * * *

    (vi) When no percent is given for sugars, vitamin K, chloride, 
chromium, fluoride, manganese, molybdenum, or selenium, an asterisk 
shall be placed in the ``% Daily Value'' column that shall refer to 
another asterisk that is placed at the bottom of the nutrition label and 
is followed by the statement ``Daily Value not established.''

                                * * * * *

    2. At 61 FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996, in Sec. 101.36, paragraph (b)(3)(v) 
was amended by removing the words ``folate (folacin)'' and by adding in 
their place the words ``folate--either folic acid or folacin may be 
used'', effective April 19, 1996.



Sec. 101.42  Nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish.

    (a) The Food and Drug Administration (FDA) urges food retailers to 
provide nutrition information, as provided in Sec. 101.9(c), for raw 
fruit, vegetables, and fish at the point-of-purchase. If retailers 
choose to provide such information, they should do so in a manner that 
conforms to the guidelines in Sec. 101.45.
    (b) In Sec. 101.44, FDA has listed the 20 varieties of raw fruit, 
vegetables, and fish that are most frequently consumed during a year and 
to which the guidelines apply.
    (c) FDA has also defined in Sec. 101.43, the circumstances that 
constitute substantial compliance by food retailers with the guidelines.
    (d) By May 8, 1993, FDA will issue a report on actions taken by food 
retailers to provide consumers with nutrition information for raw fruit, 
vegetables, and fish under the guidelines established in Sec. 101.45.
    (1) The report will include a determination of whether there is 
substantial compliance, as defined in Sec. 101.43, with the guidelines.
    (2) In evaluating substantial compliance, FDA will consider only the 
20 varieties of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish most frequently consumed 
as identified in Sec. 101.44.
    (e) If FDA finds that there is substantial compliance with the 
guidelines for the nutrition labeling of raw fruit and vegetables or of 
fish, the agency will so state in the report, and the guidelines will 
remain in effect. FDA will reevaluate the market place for substantial 
compliance every 2 years.
    (f) If FDA determines that there is not substantial compliance with 
the guidelines for raw fruit and vegetables or for raw fish, the agency 
will at that time issue proposed regulations requiring that any person 
who offers raw fruit and vegetables or fish to consumers provide, in a 
manner prescribed by regulations, the nutrition information required by 
Sec. 101.9. Final regulations would have to be issued 6 months after 
issuance of proposed regulations, and they would become effective 6 
months after the date of their promulgation.



Sec. 101.43  Substantial compliance of food retailers with the guidelines for the voluntary nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish.

    (a) The Food and Drug Administration (FDA) will judge a food 
retailer who sells raw agricultural commodities or raw fish to be in 
compliance with the guidelines in Sec. 101.45 with respect to raw 
agricultural commodities if the retailer displays or provides nutrition 
labeling for at least 90 percent of the raw agricultural commodities 
listed in Sec. 101.44 that it sells, and with respect to raw fish if the 
retailer displays or provides nutrition labeling for at least 90 percent 
of the types of raw fish listed in Sec. 101.44 that it sells. To be in 
compliance, the nutrition labeling shall:
    (1) Be presented in the store or other type of establishment in a 
manner that is consistent with Sec. 101.45(a);
    (2) Be presented in content and format that are consistent with 
Sec. 101.45(b); and
    (3) Include data that have been provided by FDA (see 
Sec. 101.45(i)), that have been accepted by FDA (see Sec. 101.45 (c), 
(f), and (g)), or that are consistent with Sec. 101.45 (d) and (e) and 
have not been found to be out of compliance after a review under 
Sec. 101.9(e) (see Sec. 101.45(h)).
    (b) To determine whether there is substantial compliance by food 
retailers with the guidelines in Sec. 101.45 for the voluntary nutrition 
labeling of raw fruit and vegetables and of raw fish, FDA will select a 
representative sample of 2,000 stores, allocated by store

[[Page 89]]

type and size, for raw fruit and vegetables and for raw fish.
    (c) FDA will find that there is substantial compliance with the 
guidelines in Sec. 101.45 if it finds based on paragraph (a) of this 
section that at least 60 percent of all stores that are evaluated are in 
compliance.
    (d) FDA will evaluate substantial compliance separately for raw 
agricultural commodities and for raw fish.



Sec. 101.44  Identification of the 20 most frequently consumed raw fruit, vegetables, and fish in the United States.

    (a) The 20 most frequently consumed raw fruit are: Banana, apple, 
watermelon, orange, cantaloupe, grape, grapefruit, strawberry, peach, 
pear, nectarine, honeydew melon, plum, avocado, lemon, pineapple, 
tangerine, sweet cherry, kiwifruit, and lime.
    (b) The 20 most frequently consumed raw vegetables are: Potato, 
iceberg lettuce, tomato, onion, carrot, celery, sweet corn, broccoli, 
green cabbage, cucumber, bell pepper, cauliflower, leaf lettuce, sweet 
potato, mushroom, green onion, green (snap) bean, radish, summer squash, 
and asparagus.
    (c) The 20 most frequently consumed raw fish are: Shrimp, cod, 
pollack, catfish, scallop, Atlantic/coho salmon, flounder, sole, oyster, 
orange roughy, Atlantic/Pacific and jack mackerel, ocean perch, 
rockfish, whiting, clam, haddock, blue crab, rainbow trout, halibut, and 
lobster.



Sec. 101.45  Guidelines for the voluntary nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish.

    Nutrition labeling for raw fruit, vegetables, and fish listed in 
Sec. 101.44 should be presented to the public in the following manner:
    (a) Nutrition labeling information should be displayed at the point 
of purchase by an appropriate means, including by affixing it to the 
food, by posting a sign, or by making the information readily available 
in brochure, notebook, or leaflet form in close proximity to the foods. 
The nutrition labeling information may also be supplemented by a video, 
live demonstration, or other media.
    (b) Nutrition information should be provided on the label or in 
labeling in accordance with Sec. 101.9, as modified by the following 
guidelines:
    (1) The percent U.S. RDA for protein, thiamin, riboflavin, and 
niacin may be declared in the nutrition labeling. Declaration of complex 
carbohydrates, sugars, dietary fiber, saturated fat, and cholesterol is 
also voluntary.
    (2) Nutrition labeling information may be presented on individual 
labels or in charts in vertical columns or in lines. When lines are 
used, any subcomponents declared should be listed parenthetically after 
principal components (e.g., saturated fat should be parenthetically 
listed after fat).
    (3) Declaration of the number of servings per container need not be 
included in nutrition labeling of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish.
    (4) The nutrition label data should be based on raw edible portion 
for fruit and vegetables and on a cooked edible portion for fish. The 
methods used to cook fish should be those that do not add fat, breading, 
or seasoning (e.g., salt or spices).
    (c) Nutrient data and proposed nutrient values for nutrition 
labeling for raw fruit, vegetables, and fish may be submitted to the 
Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition (HFS-150), Food and Drug 
Administration, 200 C St. SW., Washington, DC 20204, for review and 
evaluation. The data and nutrient values for nutrition labeling are 
appropriate for use if they are accepted by the Food and Drug 
Administration (FDA). The submission to FDA should include information 
on the source of the data (names of investigators, name of organization, 
place of analysis, dates of analyses), number of samples, sampling 
scheme, analytical methods, statistical treatment of the data, and 
proposed quantitative label declarations. The nutrient values for the 
nutrition labeling should be determined in accordance with FDA guidance.
    (d) Composite data that reflect representative nutrient levels for 
various varieties, species, cultivars; seasons; and geographic regions 
may be used to label raw fruit, vegetables, and fish. Alternatively, 
data that reflect a specific variety, species, cultivar; season; or 
geographic region may be used to label raw fruit, vegetables, and fish; 
the nutrition labeling information for such

[[Page 90]]

variety, etc., should provide food names and descriptions for the fruit, 
vegetables, and fish that appropriately reflect the samples analyzed for 
nutrient values.
    (e) The FDA manual ``Compliance Procedures for Nutrition Labeling'' 
(or subsequent revisions of this manual) should be used to develop 
nutrition label values from data base values. The manual is available 
from the Division of Nutrition.
    (f) If the agency's Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition 
agrees to all aspects of a submitted data base, FDA will notify a 
submitter in writing of its acceptance of the nutrient data and nutrient 
values for nutrition labeling. FDA's acceptance will be for a period of 
10 years or until other data for the same food are submitted to FDA and 
found to be superior. Those obtaining data base and nutrient value 
acceptance from FDA are responsible for continued maintenance of the 
data base. FDA will renew its acceptance of a data base upon request 
after 10 years unless the data have been superseded by other data on the 
same food or there have been demonstrated changes in agricultural or 
industry practices. When agricultural or industry practices change 
(e.g., a change occurs in a predominant variety produced), or when FDA 
monitoring suggests that the data base or nutrient values are no longer 
representative of the item sold in this country, FDA will take steps to 
revoke its acceptance of the data base and nutrient values. A revised 
data base and proposed nutrient values may be submitted to FDA for 
acceptance.
    (g) If the nutrition information is in accordance with an FDA-
accepted data base, the nutrient values have been computed following FDA 
guidelines, and the food has been handled in accordance with current 
good manufacturing practices to prevent nutrient loss, a nutrition label 
will not be subject to the agency compliance review under Sec. 101.9(e).
    (h) Organizations may use data bases that they believe validly 
reflect the nutrient content of raw fruit, vegetables, and fish; 
however, labeling computed from data bases not reviewed, evaluated, and 
accepted by the agency is subject to the compliance procedures of 
Sec. 101.9(e).
    (i) FDA will publish, and provide an opportunity for comment on, 
updates of the nutrition labeling data for the 20 most frequently 
consumed raw fruit, vegetables, and fish (or a notice that the data sets 
have not changed from the previous publication) at least every 2 years 
in the Federal Register. FDA accepted data for other raw fruit, 
vegetables, and fish, or for other nutrients, are available from the 
Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition (HFS-150), 200 C St. SW., 
Washington, DC 20204.

[55 FR 60890, Nov. 27, 1991, as amended at 61 FR 14479, Apr. 2, 1996]



      Subpart D--Specific Requirements for Nutrient Content Claims

    Source: 58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993, unless otherwise noted.



Sec. 101.54  Nutrient content claims for ``good source,'' ``high,'' and ``more.''

    (a) General requirements. Except as provided in paragraph (e) of 
this section, a claim about the level of a nutrient in a food in 
relation to the Reference Daily Intake (RDI) established for that 
nutrient in Sec. 101.9(c)(8)(iv) or Daily Reference Value (DRV) 
established for that nutrient in Sec. 101.9(c)(9), (excluding total 
carbohydrates) may only be made on the label or in labeling of the food 
if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms defined in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13; and
    (3) The food for which the claim is made is labeled in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, or Sec. 101.36, as applicable.
    (b) ``High'' claims. (1) The terms ``high,'' ``rich in,'' or 
``excellent source of'' may be used on the label or in the labeling of 
foods except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l), main dish 
products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), and dietary supplements of 
vitamins or minerals to characterize the level of any substance that is 
not a vitamin or mineral, provided that the food contains 20 percent or 
more of the RDI or the DRV

[[Page 91]]

per reference amount customarily consumed.
    (2) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(1) of this section may be 
used on the label and in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains a food that meets the definition of 
``high'' in paragraph (b)(1) of this section; and
    (ii) The label or labeling clearly identifies the food that is the 
subject of the claim (e.g., the serving of broccoli in this product is 
high in vitamin C).
    (c) ``Good Source'' claims. (1) The terms ``good source,'' 
``contains,'' or ``provides'' may be used on the label or in labeling of 
foods except meal products as described in Sec. 101.13(l) main dish 
products as described in Sec. 101.13(m), and dietary supplements of 
vitamins or minerals to characterize the level of any substance that is 
not a vitamin or mineral, provided that the food contains 10 to 19 
percent of the RDI or the DRV per reference amount customarily consumed.
    (2) The terms defined in paragraph (c)(1) of this section may be 
used on the label and in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 101.13(m), provided 
that:
    (i) The product contains a food that meets the definition of ``good 
source'' in paragraph (c)(1) of this section; and
    (ii) The label or labeling clearly identifies the food that is the 
subject of the claim (e.g., the serving of sweet potatoes in this 
product is a ``good source'' of fiber).
    (d) ``Fiber'' claims. (1) If a nutrient content claim is made with 
respect to the level of dietary fiber, that is, that the product is high 
in fiber, a good source of fiber, or that the food contains ``more'' 
fiber, and the food is not ``low'' in total fat as defined in 
Sec. 101.62(b)(2) or, in the case of a meal product, as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l), or main dish product, as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), is 
not ``low'' in total fat as defined in Sec. 101.62(b)(3), then the label 
shall disclose the level of total fat per labeled serving.
    (2) The disclosure shall appear in immediate proximity to such 
claim, be in a type size no less than one-half the size of the claim and 
precede the referral statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) (e.g., 
``contains [x amount] of total fat per serving. See [appropriate panel] 
for nutrition information'').
    (e) ``More'' claims. (1) A relative claim using the terms ``more,'' 
``fortified,'' ``enriched,'' ``added,'' and ``extra'' may be used on the 
label or in labeling of foods to describe the level of protein, 
vitamins, minerals,

[[Page 92]]

dietary fiber, or potassium except as limited by Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i) 
and except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l), main dish 
products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), and dietary supplements of 
vitamins or minerals to characterize the level of any substance that is 
not a vitamin or mineral, provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 10 percent more of the RDI for 
vitamins or minerals or of the DRV for protein, dietary fiber, or 
potassium (expressed as a percent of the Daily Value) per reference 
amount customarily consumed than an appropriate reference food; and
    (ii) Where the claim is based on a nutrient that has been added to 
the food, that fortification is in accordance with the policy on 
fortification of foods in Sec. 104.20 of this chapter; and
    (iii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percentage (or 
fraction) that the nutrient is greater relative to the RDI or DRV are 
declared in immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., 
``contains 10 percent more of the Daily Value for fiber than white 
bread''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the nutrient in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Fiber content of white bread is 1 gram (g) per 
serving; (this product) 3.5 g per serving'') is declared adjacent to the 
most prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the 
nutrition label is on the information panel, the quantitative 
information may be located elsewhere on the information panel in 
accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (2) A relative claim using the terms ``more,'' ``fortified,'' 
``enriched,'' ``added,'' and ``extra'' may be used on the label or in 
labeling to describe the level of protein, vitamins, minerals, dietary 
fiber or potassium, except as limited in Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i), in meal 
products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) or main dish products as defined 
in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 10 percent more of the RDI for 
vitamins or minerals or of the DRV for protein, dietary fiber, or 
potassium (expressed as a percent of the Daily Value) per 100 g of food 
than an appropriate reference food.
    (ii) Where the claim is based on a nutrient that has been added to 
the food, that fortification is in accordance with the policy on 
fortification of foods in Sec. 104.20 of this chapter; and
    (iii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percentage (or 
fraction) that the nutrient was increased relative to the RDI or DRV are 
declared in immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., 
``contains 10 percent more of the Daily Value for fiber per 3 oz than 
does `X brand of product'''), and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the nutrient in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``The fiber content of `X brand of product' is 2 g per 3 
oz. This product contains 4.5 g per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the 
most prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the 
nutrition label is on the information panel, the quantitative 
information may be located elsewhere on the information panel in 
accordance with Sec. 101.2.

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17342, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 59 
FR 394, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 15051, Mar. 31, 1994; 60 FR 17206, Apr. 5, 
1995; 61 FR 11731, Mar. 22, 1996]



Sec. 101.56  Nutrient content claims for ``light'' or ``lite.''

    (a) General requirements. A claim using the term ``light'' or 
``lite'' to describe a food may only be made on the label or in labeling 
of the food if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms defined in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13; and
    (3) The food is labeled in accordance with Sec. 101.9 or 
Sec. 101.10, where applicable.
    (b) ``Light'' claims. The terms ``light'' or ``lite'' may be used on 
the label or in the labeling of foods, except meal products as defined 
in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
without further qualification, provided that:
    (1) If the food derives 50 percent or more of its calories from fat, 
its fat content is reduced by 50 percent or more per reference amount 
customarily consumed compared to an appropriate reference food as 
specified in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); or
    (2) If the food derives less than 50 percent of its calories from 
fat:
    (i) The number of calories is reduced by at least one-third (33 1/3 
percent) per reference amount customarily consumed compared to an 
appropriate reference food; or
    (ii) Its fat content is reduced by 50 percent or more per reference 
amount customarily consumed compared to the reference food that it 
resembles or for which it substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); 
and
    (3) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (i) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the calories and the fat were reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim, (e.g., ``1/3 fewer calories 
and 50 percent less fat than our regular cheese cake'');
    (ii) Quantitative information comparing the level of calories and 
fat content in the product per labeled serving size with that of the 
reference food that it replaces (e.g., ``lite cheesecake--200 calories, 
4 grams (g) fat per serving; regular cheesecake--300 calories, 8 g fat 
per serving'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to 
the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2; and
    (iii) If the labeled food contains less than 40 calories or less 
than 3 g fat per reference amount customarily consumed, the percentage 
reduction for that nutrient need not be declared.

[[Page 93]]

    (4) A ``light'' claim may not be made on a food for which the 
reference food meets the definition of ``low fat'' and ``low calorie.''
    (c)(1)(i) A product for which the reference food contains 40 
calories or less and 3 g fat or less per reference amount customarily 
consumed may use the term ``light'' or ``lite'' without further 
qualification if it is reduced by 50 percent or more in sodium content 
compared to the reference food; and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sodium was reduced shall be declared in immediate proximity to 
the most prominent such claim (e.g., 50 percent less sodium than our 
regular soy sauce); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of sodium per 
labeled serving size with that of the reference food that it replaces 
(e.g., ``lite soy sauce 500 milligrams (mg) sodium per serving; regular 
soy sauce 1,000 mg per serving'') is declared adjacent to the most 
prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition 
label is on the information panel, the quantitative information may be 
located elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (2)(i) A product for which the reference food contains more than 40 
calories or more than 3 g fat per reference amount customarily consumed 
may use the term ``light in sodium'' or ``lite in sodium'' if it is 
reduced by 50 percent or more in sodium content compared to the 
reference food, provided that ``light'' or ``lite'' is presented in 
immediate proximity with ``in sodium'' and the entire term is presented 
in uniform type size, style, color, and prominence; and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sodium was reduced shall be declared in immediate proximity to 
the most prominent such claim (e.g., 50 percent less sodium than our 
regular canned peas); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of sodium per 
labeled serving size with that of the reference food that it replaces 
(e.g., ``lite canned peas, 175 mg sodium per serving; regular canned 
peas 350 mg per serving'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent 
claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is 
on the information panel, the quantitative information may be located 
elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Except for meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main 
dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), a ``light in sodium'' claim 
may not be made on a food for which the reference food meets the 
definition of ``low in sodium''.
    (d)(1) The terms ``light'' or ``lite'' may be used on the label or 
in the labeling of a meal product as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and a 
main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food meets the definition of:
    (A) ``Low in calories'' as defined in Sec. 101.60(b)(3); or
    (B) ``Low in fat'' as defined in Sec. 101.62(b)(3); and
    (ii)(A) A statement appears on the principal display panel that 
explains whether ``light'' is used to mean ``low fat,'' ``low 
calories,'' or both (e.g., ``Light Delight, a low fat meal''); and
    (B) The accompanying statement is no less than one-half the type 
size of the ``light'' or ``lite'' claim.
    (2)(i) The term ``light in sodium'' or ``lite in sodium'' may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of a meal product as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and a main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that the food meets the definition of ``low in sodium'' as 
defined in Sec. 101.61(b)(5)(i); and
    (ii) ``Light'' or ``lite'' and ``in sodium'' are presented in 
uniform type size, style, color, and prominence.
    (e) Except as provided in paragraphs (b) through (d) of this 
section, the term ``light'' or ``lite'' may not be used to refer to a 
food that is not reduced in fat by 50 percent, or, if applicable, in 
calories by 1/3 or, when properly qualified, in sodium by 50 percent 
unless:
    (1) It describes some physical or organoleptic attribute of the food 
such as texture or color and the information (e.g., ``light in color'' 
or ``light in texture'') so stated, clearly conveys the nature of the 
product; and

[[Page 94]]

    (2) The attribute (e.g., ``color'' or ``texture'') is in the same 
style, color, and at least one-half the type size as the word ``light'' 
and in immediate proximity thereto.
    (f) If a manufacturer can demonstrate that the word ``light'' has 
been associated, through common use, with a particular food to reflect a 
physical or organoleptic attribute (e.g., light brown sugar, light corn 
syrup, or light molasses) to the point where it has become part of the 
statement of identity, such use of the term ``light'' shall not be 
considered a nutrient content claim subject to the requirements in this 
part.
    (g) The term ``lightly salted'' may be used on a product to which 
has been added 50 percent less sodium than is normally added to the 
reference food as described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i)(B) and 
(j)(1)(ii)(B), provided that if the product is not ``low in sodium'' as 
defined in Sec. 101.61(b)(4), the statement ``not a low sodium food,'' 
shall appear adjacent to the nutrition label of the food bearing the 
claim, or, if the nutrition label is on the information panel, it may 
appear elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2 
and the information required to accompany a relative claim shall appear 
on the label or labeling as specified in Sec. 101.13(j)(2).

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17342, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 60 
FR 17206, Apr. 5, 1995]



Sec. 101.60  Nutrient content claims for the calorie content of foods.

    (a) General requirements. A claim about the calorie or sugar content 
of a food may only be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms defined in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13;
    (3) The food for which the claim is made is labeled in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, or Sec. 101.36, as applicable; and
    (4) For dietary supplements, claims regarding calories may not be 
made on products that meet the criteria in Sec. 101.60(b)(1) or (b)(2) 
for ``calorie free'' or ``low calorie'' claims except when an equivalent 
amount of a similar dietary supplement (e.g., another protein 
supplement) that the labeled food resembles and for which it 
substitutes, normally exceeds the definition for ``low calorie'' in 
Sec. 101.60(b)(2).
    (b) ``Calorie content claims.'' (1) The terms ``calorie free,'' 
``free of calories,'' ``no calories,'' ``zero calories,'' ``without 
calories,'' ``trivial source of calories,'' ``negligible source of 
calories,'' or ``dietarily insignificant source of calories'' may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of foods, provided that:
    (i) The food contains less than 5 calories per reference amount 
customarily consumed and per labeled serving.
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets this 
condition without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower the caloric content, it is 
labeled to disclose that calories are not usually present in the food 
(e.g., ``cider vinegar, a calorie free food'').
    (2) The terms ``low calorie,'' ``few calories,'' ``contains a small 
amount of calories,'' ``low source of calories,'' or ``low in calories'' 
may be used on the label or in labeling of foods, except meal products 
as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 grams (g) or greater than 2 tablespoons and does not provide 
more than 40 calories per reference amount customarily consumed; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and does not provide more than 40 calories 
per reference amount customarily consumed and, except for sugar 
substitutes, per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted 
before typical consumption with water or a diluent containing an 
insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients 
per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g criterion refers 
to the ``as prepared'' form).
    (ii) If a food meets these conditions without the benefit of special 
processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to vary the 
caloric content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its type 
and not merely to the

[[Page 95]]

particular brand to which the label attaches (e.g., ``celery, a low 
calorie food'').
    (3) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this section may be 
used on the label or in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) or main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains 120 calories or less per 100 g; and
    (ii) If the product meets this condition without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
the calorie content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its 
type and not merely to the particular brand to which it attaches.
    (4) The terms ``reduced calorie,'' ``reduced in calories,'' 
``calorie reduced,'' ``fewer calories,'' ``lower calorie,'' or ``lower 
in calories'' may be used on the label or in the labeling of foods, 
except as limited by Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i) and except meal products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent fewer calories per 
reference amount customarily

[[Page 96]]

consumed than an appropriate reference food as described in 
Sec. 101.13(j)(1); and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the calories differ between the two foods are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., reduced calorie 
cupcakes ``33 1/3 percent fewer calories than regular cupcakes''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the nutrient per 
labeled serving size with that of the reference food that it replaces 
(e.g., ``Calorie content has been reduced from 150 to 100 calories per 
serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the 
nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(4) of this section may not 
be made on the label or labeling of foods if the reference food meets 
the definition for ``low calorie.''
    (5) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent fewer calories per 100 g 
of food than

[[Page 97]]

an appropriate reference food as described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the calories differ between the two foods are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., Larry's Reduced 
Calorie Lasagna, ``25 percent fewer calories per oz (or 3 oz) than our 
regular Lasagna''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the nutrient in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Calorie content has been reduced from 108 calories per 
3 oz to 83 calories per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most 
prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition 
label is on the information panel, the quantitative information may be 
located elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(5) of this section may not 
be made on the label or labeling of food if the reference food meets the 
definition for ``low calorie.''
    (c) Sugar content claims--(1) Use of terms such as ``sugar free,'' 
``free of sugar,'' ``no sugar,'' ``zero sugar,'' ``without sugar,'' 
``sugarless,'' ``trivial source of sugar,'' ``negligible source of 
sugar,'' or ``dietarily insignificant source of sugar.'' Consumers may 
reasonably be expected to regard terms that represent that the food 
contains no sugars or sweeteners e.g., ``sugar free,'' or ``no sugar,'' 
as indicating a product which is low in calories or significantly 
reduced in calories. Consequently, except as provided in paragraph 
(c)(2) of this section, a food may not be labeled with such terms 
unless:
    (i) The food contains less than 0.5 g of sugars, as defined in 
Sec. 101.9(c)(6)(ii), per reference amount customarily consumed and per 
labeled serving or, in the case of a meal product or main dish product, 
less than 0.5 g of sugars per labeled serving; and
    (ii) The food contains no ingredient that is a sugar or that is 
generally understood by consumers to contain sugars unless the listing 
of the ingredient in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk 
that refers to the statement below the list of ingredients, which states 
``adds a trivial amount of sugar,'' ``adds a negligible amount of 
sugar,'' or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of sugar;'' and
    (iii)(A) It is labeled ``low calorie'' or ``reduced calorie'' or 
bears a relative claim of special dietary usefulness labeled in 
compliance with paragraphs (b)(2), (b)(3), (b)(4), or (b)(5) of this 
section; or
    (B) Such term is immediately accompanied, each time it is used, by 
either the statement ``not a reduced calorie food,'' ``not a low calorie 
food,'' or ``not for weight control.''
    (2) The terms ``no added sugar,'' ``without added sugar,'' or ``no 
sugar added'' may be used only if:
    (i) No amount of sugars, as defined in Sec. 101.9(c)(6)(ii), or any 
other ingredient that contains sugars that functionally substitute for 
added sugars is added during processing or packaging; and
    (ii) The product does not contain an ingredient containing added 
sugars such as jam, jelly, or concentrated fruit juice; and
    (iii) The sugars content has not been increased above the amount 
present in the ingredients by some means such as the use of enzymes, 
except where the intended functional effect of the process is not to 
increase the sugars content of a food, and a functionally insignificant 
increase in sugars results; and
    (iv) The food that it resembles and for which it substitutes 
normally contains added sugars; and
    (v) The product bears a statement that the food is not ``low 
calorie'' or ``calorie reduced'' (unless the food meets the requirements 
for a ``low'' or ``reduced calorie'' food) and that directs consumers' 
attention to the nutrition panel for further information on sugar and 
calorie content.
    (3) Paragraph (c)(1) of this section shall not apply to a factual 
statement that a food, including foods intended specifically for infants 
and children less than 2 years of age, is unsweetened or contains no 
added sweeteners in the case of a food that contains apparent 
substantial inherent sugar content, e.g., juices.
    (4) The claims provided for in paragraph (c)(1) and (c)(2) of this 
section may be used on labels or in labeling of dietary supplements of 
vitamins or minerals that are intended specifically for use by infants 
and children less than 2 years of age.
    (5) The terms ``reduced sugar,'' ``reduced in sugar,'' ``sugar 
reduced,'' ``less sugar,'' ``lower sugar'' or ``lower in sugar'' may be 
used on the label or in labeling of foods, except meal products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l), main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m), and dietary supplements of vitamins or minerals, 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less sugar per reference 
amount customarily consumed than an appropriate reference food as 
described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sugar differs between the two foods are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``these corn flakes 
contain 25 percent less sugar than our sugar coated corn flakes''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the sugar in the 
product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Sugar content has been lowered from 8 g to 6 g per 
serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the 
nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (6) The terms defined in paragraph (c)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of a meal product as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and a main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less sugars per 100 g of 
food than an appropriate reference food as described in 
Sec. 101.13(j)(1), and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sugars differ between the two foods are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., reduced sweet and sour 
shrimp dinner, ``25 percent less sugar per 3 oz than our regular sweet 
and sour shrimp dinner''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the nutrient in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Sugar content has been reduced from 17 g per 3 oz to 
13 g per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to 
the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17342, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 58 
FR 44031, Aug. 18, 1993; 59 FR 394, Jan. 4, 1994; 60 FR 17206, Apr. 5, 
1995]



Sec. 101.61  Nutrient content claims for the sodium content of foods.

    (a) General requirements. A claim about the level of sodium or salt 
in a food may only be made on the label or in the labeling of the food 
if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms defined in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13; and
    (3) The food for which the claim is made is labeled in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, or Sec. 101.36, as applicable.
    (b) ``Sodium content claims.'' (1) The terms ``sodium free,'' ``free 
of sodium,'' ``no sodium,'' ``zero sodium,'' ``without sodium,'' 
``trivial source of sodium,'' ``negligible source of sodium,'' or 
``dietary insignificant source of sodium'' may be used on the label or 
in the labeling of foods, provided that:
    (i) The food contains less than 5 milligrams (mg) of sodium per 
reference amount customarily consumed and per labeled serving or, in the 
case of a meal product or a main dish product, less than 5 mg of sodium 
per labeled serving; and
    (ii) The food contains no ingredient that is sodium chloride or is 
generally understood by consumers to contain sodium, unless the listing 
of the ingredient in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk 
that refers to the statement below the list of ingredients, which 
states: ``Adds a trivial amount of sodium,'' ``adds a negligible amount 
of sodium'' or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of sodium;'' and
    (iii) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2) if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower the sodium content, it is labeled 
to disclose that sodium is not usually present in the food (e.g., ``leaf 
lettuce, a sodium free food'').
    (2) The terms ``very low sodium,'' or ``very low in sodium,'' may be 
used on the label or in labeling of foods, except meal products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main

[[Page 98]]

dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 grams (g) or greater than 2 tablespoons and contains 35 mg or 
less sodium per reference amount customarily consumed; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and contains 35 mg or less sodium per 
reference amount customarily consumed and per 50 g (for dehydrated foods 
that must be reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a 
diluent containing an insignificant amount, as defined in 
Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount customarily 
consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form);
    (ii) If the food meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to vary 
the sodium content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its 
type and not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches 
(e.g., ``potatoes, a very low-sodium food'').
    (3) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this section may be 
used on the label or in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains 35 mg or less of sodium per 100 g of 
product; and
    (ii) If the product meets this condition without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
the sodium content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its 
type and not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches.
    (4) The terms ``low sodium,'' or ``low in sodium,'' ``little 
sodium,'' ``contains a small amount of sodium,'' or ``low source of 
sodium'' may be used on the label or in the labeling of foods, except 
meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and contains 140 mg or less 
sodium per reference amount customarily consumed; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and contains 140 mg or less sodium per 
reference amount customarily consumed and per 50 g (for dehydrated foods 
that must be reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a 
diluent containing an insignificant amount, as defined in 
Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount customarily 
consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form); 
and
    (ii) If the food meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to vary 
the sodium content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its 
type and not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches 
(e.g., ``fresh spinach, a low sodium food''); and
    (5) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains 140 mg or less sodium per 100 g; and
    (ii) If the product meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
the sodium content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its 
type and not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches.
    (6) The terms ``reduced sodium,'' ``reduced in sodium,'' ``sodium 
reduced,'' ``less sodium,'' ``lower sodium,'' or ``lower in sodium'' may 
be used on the label or in labeling of foods, except meal products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less sodium per reference 
amount customarily consumed than an appropriate reference food as 
described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1).
    (ii) As required for Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:

[[Page 99]]

    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sodium differs from the labeled food are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``reduced sodium ----
------, 50 percent less sodium than regular ----------''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of the sodium in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Sodium content has been lowered from 300 to 150 mg per 
serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the 
nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(6) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low sodium.''
    (7) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(6) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less sodium per 100 g of 
food than an appropriate reference food as described in 
Sec. 101.13(j)(1), and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the sodium differs from the reference food are declared in 
immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., reduced 
sodium eggplant parmigiana dinner ``30 percent less sodium per oz (or 3 
oz) than our regular eggplant parmigiana dinner'').
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of sodium in the 
product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Sodium content has been reduced from 217 mg per 3 oz 
to 150 mg per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim 
or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(7) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low sodium.''
    (c) The term ``salt'' is not synonymous with ``sodium.'' Salt refers 
to sodium chloride. However, references to salt content such as 
``unsalted,'' ``no salt,'' ``no salt added'' are potentially misleading.
    (1) The term ``salt free'' may be used on the label or in labeling 
of foods only if the food is ``sodium free'' as defined in paragraph 
(b)(1) of this section.
    (2) The terms ``unsalted,'' ``without added salt,'' and ``no salt 
added'' may be used on the label or in labeling of foods only if:
    (i) No salt is added during processing;
    (ii) The food that it resembles and for which it substitutes is 
normally processed with salt; and
    (iii) If the food is not sodium free, the statement, ``not a sodium 
free food'' or ``not for control of sodium in the diet'' appears 
adjacent to the nutrition label of the food bearing the claim, or, if 
the nutrition label is on the information panel, it may appear elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (3) Paragraph (c)(2) of this section shall not apply to a factual 
statement that a food intended specifically for infants and children 
less than 2 years of age is unsalted, provided such statement refers to 
the taste of the food and is not otherwise false and misleading.

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17342, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 58 
FR 44032, Aug. 18, 1993; 59 FR 394, Jan. 4, 1994; 60 FR 17206, Apr. 5, 
1995]



Sec. 101.62  Nutrient content claims for fat, fatty acid, and cholesterol content of foods.

    (a) General requirements. A claim about the level of fat, fatty 
acid, and cholesterol in a food may only be made on the label or in the 
labeling of foods if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms defined in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13;
    (3) The food for which the claim is made is labeled in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, or Sec. 101.36, as applicable; and
    (4) For dietary supplements, claims for fat, saturated fat, and 
cholesterol may not be made on products that meet the criteria in 
Sec. 101.60(b)(1) or (b)(2) for ``calorie free'' or ``low calorie'' 
claims.
    (b) ``Fat content claims.'' (1) The terms ``fat free,'' ``free of 
fat,'' ``no fat,'' ``zero fat,'' ``without fat,'' ``nonfat,'' ``trivial 
source of fat,'' ``negligible source of fat,'' or ``dietarily 
insignificant source of fat'' may be used on the label or in labeling of 
foods, provided that:
    (i) The food contains less than 0.5 gram (g) of fat per reference 
amount customarily consumed and per labeled serving or, in the case of a 
meal product or main dish product, less than 0.5 g of fat per labeled 
serving; and
    (ii) The food contains no added ingredient that is a fat or is 
generally understood by consumers to contain fat unless the listing of 
the ingredient in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk 
that refers to the statement below the list of ingredients, which states 
``adds a trivial amount of fat,'' ``adds a negligible amount of fat,'' 
or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of fat;'' and
    (iii) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without

[[Page 100]]

the benefit of special processing, alteration, formulation, or 
reformulation to lower fat content, it is labeled to disclose that fat 
is not usually present in the food (e.g., ``broccoli, a fat free 
food'').
    (2) The terms ``low fat,'' ``low in fat,'' ``contains a small amount 
of fat,'' ``low source of fat,'' or ``little fat'' may be used on the 
label or in labeling of foods, except meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and contains 3 g or less of fat 
per reference amount customarily consumed; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and contains 3 g or less of fat per 
reference amount customarily consumed and per 50 g of food (for 
dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before typical consumption 
with water or a diluent containing an insignificant amount, as defined 
in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount customarily 
consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form); 
and
    (ii) If the food meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
fat content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its type and 
not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches (e.g., 
``frozen perch, a low fat food'').
    (3) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(2) of this section may be 
used on the label or in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) or main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains 3 g or less of total fat per 100 g and not 
more than 30 percent of calories from fat; and
    (ii) If the product meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
fat content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its type and 
not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches.
    (4) The terms ``reduced fat,'' ``reduced in fat,'' ``fat reduced,'' 
``less fat,'' ``lower fat,'' or ``lower in fat'' may be used on the 
label or in the labeling of foods, except meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less fat per reference 
amount customarily consumed than an appropriate reference food as 
described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the fat differs between the two foods and are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``reduced fat--50 
percent less fat than our regular brownies''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of fat in the 
product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g.,

[[Page 101]]

``Fat content has been reduced from 8 g to 4 g per serving.'') is 
declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the nutrition label, 
except that if the nutrition label is on the information panel, the 
quantitative information may be located elsewhere on the information 
panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(4) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low fat.''
    (5) The terms defined in paragraph (b)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less fat per 100 g of food 
than an appropriate reference food as described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); 
and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the fat differs between the two foods are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., reduced fat spinach 
souffle, ``33 percent less fat per 3 oz than our regular spinach 
souffle''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of fat in the 
product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Fat content has been reduced from 7.5 g per 3 oz to 5 
g per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim, to the 
nutrition label, or, if the nutrition label is located on the 
information panel, it may appear elsewhere on the information panel in 
accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (b)(5) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low fat.''
    (6) The term ``------ percent fat free'' may be used on the label or 
in the labeling of foods, provided that:
    (i) The food meets the criteria for ``low fat'' in paragraph (b)(2) 
or (b)(3) of this section;
    (ii) The percent declared and the words ``fat free'' are in uniform 
type size; and
    (iii) A ``100 percent fat free'' claim may be made only on foods 
that meet the criteria for ``fat free'' in paragraph (b)(1) of this 
section, that contain less than 0.5 g of fat per 100 g, and that contain 
no added fat.
    (c) ``Fatty acid content claims.'' The label or labeling of foods 
that bear claims with respect to the level of saturated fat shall 
disclose the level of total fat and cholesterol in the food in immediate 
proximity to such claim each time the claim is made and in type that 
shall be no less than one-half the size of the type used for the claim 
with respect to the level of saturated fat. Declaration of cholesterol 
content may be omitted when the food contains less than 2 milligrams 
(mg) of cholesterol per reference amount customarily consumed or in the 
case of a meal or main dish product less than 2 mg of cholesterol per 
labeled serving. Declaration of total fat may be omitted with the term 
defined in paragraph (c)(1) of this section when the food contains less 
than 0.5 g of total fat per reference amount customarily consumed or, in 
the case of a meal product or a main dish product, when the product 
contains less than 0.5 g of total fat per labeled serving. The 
declaration of total fat may be omitted with the terms defined in 
paragraphs (c)(2) through (c)(5) of this section when the food contains 
3 g or less of total fat per reference amount customarily consumed or in 
the case of a meal product or a main dish product, when the product 
contains 3 g or less of total fat per 100 g and not more than 30 percent 
calories from fat.
    (1) The terms ``saturated fat free,'' ``free of saturated fat,'' 
``no saturated fat,'' ``zero saturated fat,'' ``without saturated fat,'' 
``trivial source of saturated fat,'' ``negligible source of saturated 
fat,'' or ``dietarily insignificant source of saturated fat'' may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of foods, provided that:
    (i) The food contains less than 0.5 g of saturated fat and less than 
0.5 g trans fatty acid per reference amount customarily consumed and per 
labeled serving, or in the case of a meal product or main dish product, 
less than 0.5 g of saturated fat and less than 0.5 g trans fatty acid 
per labeled serving; and
    (ii) The food contains no ingredient that is generally understood by 
consumers to contain saturated fat unless the listing of the ingredient 
in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk that refers to 
the statement below the list of ingredients which states, ``adds a 
trivial amount of saturated fat,'' ``adds a negligible amount of 
saturated fat,'' or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of saturated 
fat;'' and
    (iii) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower saturated fat content, it

[[Page 102]]

is labeled to disclose that saturated fat is not usually present in the 
food.
    (2) The terms ``low in saturated fat,'' ``low saturated fat,'' 
``contains a small amount of saturated fat,'' ``low source of saturated 
fat,'' or ``a little saturated fat'' may be used on the label or in the 
labeling of foods, except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and 
main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food contains 1 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount

[[Page 103]]

customarily consumed and not more than 15 percent of calories from 
saturated fatty acids; and
    (ii) If a food meets these conditions without benefit of special 
processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower saturated 
fat content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of its type and 
not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches (e.g., 
``raspberries, a low saturated fat food'').
    (3) The terms defined in paragraph (c)(2) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The product contains 1 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
100 g and less than 10 percent calories from saturated fat; and
    (ii) If the product meets these conditions without the benefit of 
special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
saturated fat content, it is labeled to clearly refer to all foods of 
its type and not merely to the particular brand to which the label 
attaches.
    (4) The terms ``reduced saturated fat,'' ``reduced in saturated 
fat,'' ``saturated fat reduced,'' ``less saturated fat,'' ``lower 
saturated fat,'' or ``lower in saturated fat'' may be used on the label 
or in the labeling of foods, except as limited by Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i) 
and except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish 
products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less saturated fat per 
reference amount customarily consumed than an appropriate reference food 
as described in Sec. 101.13(j)(1); and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the saturated fat differs between the two foods are declared in 
immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``reduced 
saturated fat. Contains 50 percent less saturated fat than the national 
average for nondairy creamers''); and
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of saturated fat in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Saturated fat reduced from 3 g to 1.5 g per serving'') 
is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the nutrition 
label, except that if the nutrition label is on the information panel, 
the quantitative information may be located elsewhere on the information 
panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (c)(4) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low saturated 
fat.''
    (5) The terms defined in paragraph (c)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) The food contains at least 25 percent less saturated fat per 100 
g of food than an appropriate reference food as described in 
Sec. 101.13(j)(1), and
    (ii) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (A) The identity of the reference food, and the percent (or 
fraction) that the fat differs between the two foods are declared in 
immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., reduced 
saturated fat Macaroni and Cheese, ``33 percent less saturated fat per 3 
oz than our regular Macaroni and Cheese'').
    (B) Quantitative information comparing the level of saturated fat in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Saturated fat content has been reduced from 2.5 g per 
3 oz to 1.7 g per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent 
claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label in 
on the information panel, the quantitative information may be located 
elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (c)(5) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low saturated 
fat.''
    (d) ``Cholesterol content claims.'' (1) The terms ``cholesterol 
free,'' ``free of cholesterol,'' ``zero cholesterol,'' ``without 
cholesterol,'' ``no cholesterol,'' ``trivial source of cholesterol,'' 
``negligible source of cholesterol,'' or ``dietarily insignificant 
source of cholesterol'' may be used on the label or in the labeling of 
foods, provided that:
    (i) For foods that contain 13 g or less of total fat per reference 
amount cutomarily consumed, per labeled serving, and per 50 g if the 
reference amount customarily consumed is 30 g or less or 2 tablespoons 
or less (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before typical 
consumption with water or a diluent containing an insignificant amount, 
as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount 
customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as 
prepared'' form), or, in the case of meal products, 26.0 g or less total 
fat per labeled serving, or, in the case of main dish products, 19.5 g 
or less total fat per labeled serving:
    (A) The food contains less than 2 mg of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed and per labeling serving or, in the case of 
a meal product or main dish product, less than 2 mg of cholesterol per 
labeled serving; and
    (B) The food contains no ingredient that is generally understood by 
consumers to contain cholesterol, unless the listing of the ingredient 
in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk that refers to 
the statement below the list of ingredients, which states ``adds a 
trivial amount of cholesterol,'' ``adds a negligible amount of 
cholesterol,'' or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of 
cholesterol;'' and
    (C) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed or, in the case of a meal product 
or main dish product, 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per labeled 
serving; and
    (D) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food contains less than 
2 mg of cholesterol per reference amount customarily consumed or in the 
case of a meal product or main dish product, less than 2 mg of 
cholesterol per labeled serving without the benefit of special 
processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation to lower 
cholesterol content, it is labeled to disclose that cholesterol is not 
usually present in the food (e.g., ``applesauce, a cholesterol-free 
food'').
    (ii) For food that contain more than 13 g of total fat per reference 
amount customarily consumed, per labeling serving, or per 50 g if the 
reference amount customarily consumed is 30 g or less or 2 tablespoons 
or less (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before typical 
consumption with water or a diluent containing an insignificant amount, 
as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount 
customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as 
prepared'' form), or in the case of a meal product, more than 26 g of 
total fat per labeled serving, or, in the case of a main dish product 
more than 19.5 g of total fat per labeled serving:
    (A) The food contains less than 2 mg of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed and per labeling serving or, in the case of 
a meal product or main dish product, less than 2 mg of cholesterol per 
labeled serving; and
    (B) The food contains no ingredient that is generally understood by 
consumers to contain cholesterol, unless the listing of the ingredient 
in the ingredient statement is followed by an asterisk that refers to 
the statement below the list of ingredients, which states ``adds a 
trivial amount of cholesterol,'' ``adds a negligible amount of 
cholesterol,'' or ``adds a dietarily insignificant amount of 
cholesterol;'' and
    (C) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount cutomarily consumed or, in the case of a meal product 
or main dish product less than 2 g of saturated fatty acids per labeled 
serving; and
    (D) The label or labeling discloses the level of total fat in a 
serving (as declared on the label) of the food. Such disclosure shall 
appear in immediate proximity to such claim preceding the referral 
statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) in type that shall be no less than 
one-half the size of the type used for such claim. If the claim appears 
on more than one panel, the disclosure shall be made on each panel 
except for the panel that bears nutrition labeling. If the claim appears 
more than once on a panel, the disclosure shall be made in immediate 
proximity to the claim that is printed in the largest type; and
    (E) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food contains less than 
2 mg of cholesterol per reference amount customarily consumed or in the 
case of a meal product or main dish product less than 2 mg of 
cholesterol per labeled serving without the benefit of special 
processing, alteration, formulation, or

[[Page 104]]

reformulation to lower cholesterol content, it is labeled to disclose 
that cholesterol is not usually present in the food (e.g., ``canola oil, 
a cholesterol-free food, contains 14 g of fat per serving''); or
    (F) If the food contains less than 2 mg of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed or in the case of a meal product or main 
dish product less than 2 mg of cholesterol per labeled serving only as a 
result of special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation, 
the amount of cholesterol is substantially less (i.e., meets 
requirements of paragraph (d)(4)(ii)(A) of this section) than the food 
for which it substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a 
significant (e.g., 5 percent or more of a national or regional market) 
market share. As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol was reduced are declared in immediate proximity to 
the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``cholesterol-free margarine, 
contains 100 percent less cholesterol than butter''); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Contains no cholesterol compared with 30 mg 
cholesterol in one serving of butter. Contains 13 g of fat per 
serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the 
nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (2) The terms ``low in cholesterol,'' ``low cholesterol,'' 
``contains a small amount of cholesterol,'' ``low source of 
cholesterol,'' or ``little cholesterol'' may be used on the label or in 
the labeling of foods, except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) 
and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) For foods that have a reference amount customarily consumed 
greater than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and contain 13 g or less 
of total fat per reference amount customarily consumed and per labeled 
serving:
    (A) The food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed;
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed; and
    (C) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower cholesterol content, it is 
labeled to clearly refer to all foods of that type and not merely to the 
particular brand to which the label attaches (e.g., ``low fat cottage 
cheese, a low cholesterol food.'').
    (ii) For foods that have a reference amount customarily consumed of 
30 g or less or 2 tablespoons or less and contain 13 g or less of total 
fat per reference amount customarily consumed, per labeled serving, and 
per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before typical 
consumption with water or a diluent containing an insignificant amount, 
as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount 
customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as 
prepared'' form);
    (A) The food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed and per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must 
be reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50-g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form);
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed; and
    (C) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower cholesterol content, it is 
labeled to clearly refer to all foods of that type and not merely to the 
particular brand to which the label attaches (e.g., ``low fat cottage 
cheese, a low cholesterol food'').
    (iii) For foods that have a reference amount customarily consumed 
greater than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and contain more than 13 
g of total fat

[[Page 105]]

per reference amount customarily consumed or per labeled serving,
    (A) The food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed;
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed;
    (C) The label or labeling discloses the level of total fat in a 
serving (as declared on the label) of the food. Such disclosure shall 
appear in immediate proximity to such claim preceding the referral 
statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) in type that shall be no less than 
one-half the size of the type used for such claim. If the claim appears 
on more than one panel, the disclosure shall be made on each panel 
except for the panel that bears nutrition labeling. If the claim is made 
more than once on a panel, the disclosure shall be made in immediate 
proximity to the claim that is printed in the largest type; and
    (D) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower cholesterol content, it is 
labeled to clearly refer to all foods of that type

[[Page 106]]

and not merely to the particular brand to which the label attaches; or
    (E) If the food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol only as a 
result of special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation, 
the amount of cholesterol is substantially less (i.e., meets 
requirements of paragraph (d)(4)(ii)(A) of this section) than the food 
for which it substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a 
significant (e.g., 5 percent or more of a national or regional market) 
market share. As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``low-cholesterol 
peanut butter sandwich crackers, contains 83 percent less cholesterol 
than our regular peanut butter sandwich crackers''); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Cholesterol lowered from 30 mg to 5 mg per serving; 
contains 13 g of fat per serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most 
prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition 
label is on the information panel, the quantitative information may be 
located elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (iv) For foods that have a reference amount customarily consumed of 
30 g or less or 2 tablespoons or less and contain more than 13 g of 
total fat per reference amount customarily consumed, per labeled 
serving, or per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted 
before typical consumption with water or a diluent containing an 
insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients 
per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers 
to the ``as prepared'' form),
    (A) The food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol per reference 
amount customarily consumed and per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must 
be reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50-g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form),
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed;
    (C) The label or labeling discloses the level of total fat in a 
serving (as declared on the label) of the food. Such disclosure shall 
appear in immediate proximity to such claim preceding the referral 
statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) in type that shall be no less than 
one-half the size of the type used for such claim. If the claim appears 
on more than one panel, the disclosure shall be made on each panel 
except for the panel that bears nutrition labeling. If the claim is made 
more than once on a panel, the disclosure shall be made in immediate 
proximity to the claim that is printed in the largest type; and
    (D) As required in Sec. 101.13(e)(2), if the food meets these 
conditions without the benefit of special processing, alteration, 
formulation, or reformulation to lower cholesterol content, it is 
labeled to clearly refer to all foods of that type and not merely to the 
particular brand to which the label attaches; or
    (E) If the food contains 20 mg or less of cholesterol only as a 
result of special processing, alteration, formulation, or reformulation, 
the amount of cholesterol is substantially less (i.e., meets 
requirements of paragraph (d)(4)(ii)(A) of this section) than the food 
for which it substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a 
significant (i.e., 5 percent or more of a national or regional market) 
market share. As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``low-cholesterol 
peanut butter sandwich crackers, contains 83 percent less cholesterol 
than our regular peanut butter sandwich crackers''); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Cholesterol lowered from 30 mg to 5 mg per serving; 
contains 13 g of fat per serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most 
prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition 
label is on the information panel, the quantitative information may be 
located elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (3) The terms defined in paragraph (d)(2) of this section may be 
used on the label and in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) or a main dish product as defined in Sec. 101.13(m) 
provided that the product meets the requirements of paragraph (d)(2) of 
this section except that the determination as to whether paragraph 
(d)(2)(i) or (d)(2)(iii) of this section applies to the product will be 
made only on the basis of whether the meal product contains 26 g or less 
of total fat per labeled serving or the main dish product contain 19.5 g 
or less of total fat per labeled serving, the requirement in paragraphs 
(d)(2)(i)(A) and (d)(2)(iii)(A) of this section shall be limited to 20 
mg of cholesterol per 100 g, and the requirement in paragraphs 
(d)(2)(i)(B) and (d)(2)(iii)(B) of this section shall be modified to 
require that the food contain 2 g or less of saturated fat per 100 g 
rather than per reference amount customarily consumed.
    (4) The terms ``reduced cholesterol,'' ``reduced in cholesterol,'' 
``cholesterol reduced,'' ``less cholesterol,'' ``lower cholesterol,'' or 
``lower in cholesterol'' except as limited by Sec. 101.13(j)(1)(i) may 
be used on the label or in labeling of foods or foods that substitute 
for those foods as specified in Sec. 101.13(d), excluding meal products 
as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m), provided that:
    (i) For foods that contain 13 g or less of total fat per reference 
amount customarily consumed, per labeled serving, and per 50 g if the 
reference amount customarily consumed is 30 g or less or 2 tablespoons 
or less (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before typical 
consumption with water or a diluent containing an insignificant amount, 
as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference amount 
customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers to the ``as 
prepared'' form):
    (A) The food has been specifically formulated, altered, or processed 
to reduce its cholesterol by 25 percent or more from the reference food 
it resembles as defined in Sec. 101.13(j)(1) and for which it 
substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a significant (i.e., 
5 percent or more) market share; and
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed; and
    (C) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim; and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``[labeled product] 50 mg cholesterol per serving; 
[reference product] 30 mg cholesterol per serving'') is declared 
adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except 
that if the nutrition label is on the information panel, the 
quantitative information may be located elsewhere on the

[[Page 107]]

information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (ii) For foods that contain more than 13 g of total fat per 
reference amount customarily consumed, per labeled serving, or per 50 g 
if the reference amount customarily consumed is 30 g or less or 2 
tablespoons or less (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted 
before typical consumption with water or a diluent containing an 
insignificant amount, as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients 
per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50-g criterion refers 
to the ``as prepared'' form):
    (A) The food has been specifically formulated, altered, or processed 
to reduce its cholesterol by 25 percent or more from the reference food 
it resembles as defined in Sec. 101.13(j)(1) and for which it 
substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a significant (i.e., 
5 percent or more of a national or regional market) market share;
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 
reference amount customarily consumed;
    (C) The label or labeling discloses the level of total fat in a 
serving (as declared on the label) of the food. Such disclosure shall 
appear in immediate proximity to such claim preceding the referral 
statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) in type that shall be no less than 
one-half the size of the type used for such claim. If the claim appears 
on more than one panel, the disclosure shall be made on each panel 
except for the panel that bears nutrition labeling. If the claim is made 
more than once on a panel, the disclosure shall be made in immediate 
proximity to the claim that is printed in the largest type; and
    (D) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., 25 percent less 
cholesterol than ----------------); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per labeled serving with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Cholesterol lowered from 55 mg to 30 mg per serving. 
Contains 13 g of fat per serving.'') is declared adjacent to the most 
prominent claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition 
label is on the information panel, the quantitative information may be 
located elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with 
Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (d)(4) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in labeling of a food if the nutrient content of 
the reference food meets the definition for ``low cholesterol.''
    (5) The terms defined in paragraph (d)(4) of this section may be 
used on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), 
provided that:
    (i) For meal products that contain 26.0 g or less of total fat per 
labeled serving or for main dish products that contain 19.5 g or less of 
total fat per labeled serving;
    (A) The food has been specifically formulated, altered, or processed 
to reduce its cholesterol by 25 percent or more from the reference food 
it resembles as defined in Sec. 101.13(j)(1) and for which it 
substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a significant (e.g., 
5 percent or more of a national or regional market) market share;
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 100 
g; and
    (C) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food, and the percent (or 
fraction) that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in 
immediate proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., ``25% less 
cholesterol per 3 oz than --------.''); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Cholesterol content has been reduced from 35 mg per 3 
oz to 25 mg per 3 oz.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent 
claim or to the nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is 
on the information panel, the quantitative information may be located 
elsewhere on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (ii) For meal products that contain more than 26.0 g of total fat 
per labeled

[[Page 108]]

serving or for main dish products that contain more than 19.5 g of total 
fat per labeled serving:
    (A) The food has been specifically formulated, altered, or processed 
to reduce its cholesterol by 25 percent or more from the reference food 
it resembles as defined in Sec. 101.13(j)(1) and for which it 
substitutes as specified in Sec. 101.13(d) that has a significant (e.g., 
5 percent or more of a national or regional market) market share.
    (B) The food contains 2 g or less of saturated fatty acids per 100 
g;
    (C) The label or labeling discloses the level of total fat in a 
serving (as declared on the label) of the food. Such disclosure shall 
appear in immediate proximity to such claim preceding the referral 
statement required in Sec. 101.13(g) in type that shall be no less than 
one-half the size of the type used for such claim. If the claim appears 
on more than one panel the disclosure shall be made on each panel except 
for the panel that bears nutrition labeling. If the claim is made more 
than once on a panel, the disclosure shall be made in immediate 
proximity to the claim that is printed in the largest type; and
    (D) As required in Sec. 101.13(j)(2) for relative claims:
    (1) The identity of the reference food and the percent (or fraction) 
that the cholesterol has been reduced are declared in immediate 
proximity to the most prominent such claim (e.g., 25 percent less 
cholesterol than ------------); and
    (2) Quantitative information comparing the level of cholesterol in 
the product per specified weight with that of the reference food that it 
replaces (e.g., ``Cholesterol lowered from 30 mg to 22 mg per 3 oz of 
product.'') is declared adjacent to the most prominent claim or to the 
nutrition label, except that if the nutrition label is on the 
information panel, the quantitative information may be located elsewhere 
on the information panel in accordance with Sec. 101.2.
    (iii) Claims described in paragraph (d)(5) of this section may not 
be made on the label or in the labeling of a food if the nutrient 
content of the reference food meets the definition for ``low 
cholesterol.''
    (e) ``Lean'' and ``extra lean'' claims. (1) The term ``lean'' may be 
used on the label or in labeling of foods except meal products as 
defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(m) provided that the food is a seafood or game meat product 
and as packaged contains less than 10 g total fat, 4.5 g or less 
saturated fat, and less than 95 mg cholesterol per reference amount 
customarily consumed and per 100 g;
    (2) The term defined in paragraph (e)(1) of this section may be used 
on the label or in the labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) or main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m) 
provided that the food contains less than 10 g total fat, 4.5 g or less 
saturated fat, and less than 95 mg cholesterol per 100 g and per labeled 
serving;
    (3) The term ``extra lean'' may be used on the label or in the 
labeling of foods except meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) and 
main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m) provided that the food 
is a discrete seafood or game meat product and as packaged contains less 
than 5 g total fat, less than 2 g saturated fat, and less than 95 mg 
cholesterol per reference amount customarily consumed and per 100 g; and
    (4) The term defined in paragraph (e)(3) of this section may be used 
on the label or in labeling of meal products as defined in 
Sec. 101.13(l) and main dish products as defined in Sec. 101.13(m) 
provided that the food contains less than 5 g of fat, less than 2 g of 
saturated fat, and less than 95 mg of cholesterol per 100 g and per 
labeled serving.
    (f) Misbranding. Any label or labeling containing any statement 
concerning fat, fatty acids, or cholesterol that is not in conformity 
with this section shall be deemed to be misbranded under sections 
201(n), 403(a), and 403(r) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act.

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17342, 17343, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended 
at 58 FR 44032, Aug. 18, 1993; 58 FR 60105, Nov. 15, 1993; 59 FR 394, 
Jan. 4, 1994; 60 FR 17207, Apr. 5, 1995]



Sec. 101.65  Implied nutrient content claims and related label statements.

    (a) General requirements. An implied nutrient content claim can only 
be

[[Page 109]]

made on the label and in labeling of the food if:
    (1) The claim uses one of the terms described in this section in 
accordance with the definition for that term;
    (2) The claim is made in accordance with the general requirements 
for nutrient content claims in Sec. 101.13; and
    (3) The food for which the claim is made is labeled in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9, Sec. 101.10, or Sec. 101.36, as applicable.
    (b) Label statements that are not implied claims. Certain label 
statements about the nature of a product are not nutrient content claims 
unless such statements are made in a context that would make them an 
implied claim under Sec. 101.13(b)(2). The following types of label 
statements are generally not implied nutrient content claims and, as 
such, are not subject to the requirements of Sec. 101.13 and this 
section:
    (1) A claim that a specific ingredient or food component is absent 
from a product, provided that the purpose of such claim is to facilitate 
avoidance of the substances because of food allergies (see Sec. 105.62 
of this chapter), food intolerance, religious beliefs, or dietary 
practices such as vegetarianism or other nonnutrition related reason, 
e.g., ``100 percent milk free;''
    (2) A claim about a substance that is nonnutritive or that does not 
have a nutritive function, e.g., ``contains no preservatives,'' ``no 
artificial colors;''
    (3) A claim about the presence of an ingredient that is perceived to 
add value to the product, e.g., ``made with real butter,'' ``made with 
whole fruit,'' or ``contains honey,'' except that claims about the 
presence of ingredients other than vitamins or minerals or that are 
represented as a source of vitamins and minerals are not allowed on 
labels or in labeling of dietary supplements of vitamins and minerals 
that are not in conventional food form.
    (4) A statement of identity for a food in which an ingredient 
constitutes essentially 100 percent of a food (e.g., ``corn oil,'' ``oat 
bran,'' ``vitamin C 60 mg tablet'').
    (5) A statement of identity that names as a characterizing 
ingredient, an ingredient associated with a nutrient benefit (e.g., 
``corn oil margarine,'' ``oat bran muffins,'' or ``whole wheat 
bagels''), unless such claim is made in a context in which label or 
labeling statements, symbols, vignettes, or other forms of communication 
suggest that a nutrient is absent or present in a certain amount; and
    (6) A label statement made in compliance with a specific provision 
of part 105 of this chapter, solely to note that a food has special 
dietary usefulness relative to a physical, physiological, pathological, 
or other condition, where the claim identifies the special diet of which 
the food is intended to be a part.
    (c) Particular implied nutrient content claims. (1) Claims about the 
food or an ingredient therein that suggest that a nutrient or an 
ingredient is absent or present in a certain amount (e.g., ``high in oat 
bran'') are implied nutrient content claims and must comply with 
paragraph (a) of this section.
    (2) The phrases ``contains the same amount of [nutrient] as a 
[food]'' and ``as much [nutrient] as a [food]'' may be used on the label 
or in the labeling of foods, provided that the amount of the nutrient in 
the reference food is enough to qualify that food as a ``good source'' 
of that nutrient, and the labeled food, on a per serving basis, is an 
equivalent, good source of that nutrient (e.g., ``as much fiber as an 
apple,'' ``Contains the same amount of Vitamin C as an 8 oz glass of 
orange juice.'').
    (3) Claims may be made that a food contains or is made with an 
ingredient that is known to contain a particular nutrient, or is 
prepared in a way that affects the content of a particular nutrient in 
the food, if the finished food is either ``low'' in or a ``good source'' 
of the nutrient that is associated with the ingredient or type of 
preparation. If a more specific level is claimed (e.g., ``high in ------
----''), that level of the nutrient must be present in the food. For 
example, a claim that a food contains oat bran is a claim that it is a 
good source of dietary fiber; that a food is made only with vegetable 
oil is a claim that it is low in saturated fat; and that a food contains 
no oil is a claim that it is fat free.
    (d) General nutritional claims. (1) Claims about a food that suggest 
that the food because of its nutrient content may be useful in 
maintaining healthy dietary practices and that are made in association 
with an explicit claim or

[[Page 110]]

statement about a nutrient (e.g., ``healthy, contains 3 grams of fat'') 
are implied nutrient content claims covered by this paragraph.
    (2) The term ``healthy'' or any derivative of the term ``healthy,'' 
such as ``health,'' ``healthful,'' ``healthfully,'' ``healthfulness,'' 
``healthier,'' ``healthiest,'' ``healthily,'' and ``healthiness'' may be 
used on the label or in labeling of a food, other than raw, single 
ingredient seafood or game meat products, main dish products as defined 
in Sec. 101.13(m), and meal products as defined in Sec. 101.13(l), as an 
implied nutrient content claim to denote foods that are useful in 
constructing a diet that is consistent with dietary recommendations 
provided that:
    (i) The food meets the definition of ``low'' for fat and saturated 
fat;
    (ii)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 grams (g) or greater than 2 tablespoons and, before January 1, 
1998, contains 480 milligrams (mg) sodium or less per reference amount 
customarily consumed, and per labeled serving; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and, before January 1, 1998, contains 480 
mg sodium or less per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be 
reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form);
    (C)(1) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and, after January 1, 1998, 
contains 360 mg sodium or less per reference amount customarily 
consumed, and per labeled serving; or
    (2) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and, after January 1, 1998, contains 360 
mg sodium or less per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be 
reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form);
    (iii) Cholesterol is not present at a level exceeding the disclosure 
level as described in Sec. 101.13(h);
    (iv) The food, other than a raw fruit or vegetable, contains at 
least 10 percent of the Reference Daily Intake (RDI) or Daily Reference 
Value (DRV) per reference amount customarily consumed of vitamin A, 
vitamin C, calcium, iron, protein, or fiber;
    (v) Where compliance with paragraph (d)(2)(iv) of this section is 
based on a nutrient that has been added to the food, that fortification 
is in accordance with the policy on fortification of foods in 
Sec. 104.20 of this chapter; and
    (vi) The food complies with definitions and declaration requirements 
established in part 101 of this chapter for any specific nutrient 
content claim on the label or in labeling.
    (3) The term ``healthy'' or its derivatives may be used on the label 
or in labeling of raw, single ingredient seafood or game meat as an 
implied nutrient content claim provided that:
    (i) The food contains less than 5 g total fat, less than 2 g 
saturated fat, and less than 95 mg cholesterol per reference amount 
customarily consumed and per 100 g;
    (ii)(A) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and, before January 1, 1998, 
contains 480 mg sodium or less per reference amount customarily 
consumed, and per labeled serving; or
    (B) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or 2 tablespoons or less and, before January 1, 1998, contains 480 
mg sodium or less per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be 
reconstituted before typical consumption with water or a diluent 
containing an insignificant amount as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of 
all nutrients per reference amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g 
criterion refers to the ``as prepared'' form);
    (C)(1) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed greater 
than 30 g or greater than 2 tablespoons and, after January 1, 1998, 
contains 360 mg sodium or less per reference amount customarily 
consumed, and per labeled serving; or
    (2) The food has a reference amount customarily consumed of 30 g or 
less or

[[Page 111]]

2 tablespoons or less and, after January 1, 1998, contains 360 mg sodium 
or less per 50 g (for dehydrated foods that must be reconstituted before 
typical consumption with water or a diluent containing an insignificant 
amount as defined in Sec. 101.9(f)(1), of all nutrients per reference 
amount customarily consumed, the per 50 g criterion refers to the ``as 
prepared'' form);
    (iii) The food contains at least 10 percent of the RDI or DRV per 
reference amount customarily consumed of vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, 
iron, protein, or fiber;
    (iv) Where compliance with paragraph (d)(3)(iii) of this section is 
based on a nutrient that has been added to the food, that fortification 
is in accordance with the policy on fortification of foods in 
Sec. 104.20 of this chapter; and
    (v) The food complies with definitions and declaration requirements 
established in this part for any specific nutrient content claim on the 
label or in labeling.
    (4) The term ``healthy'' or its derivatives may be used on the label 
or in labeling of main dish products, as defined in Sec. 101.13(m), and 
meal products, as defined in Sec. 101.13(l) as an implied nutrient 
content claim provided that:
    (i) The food meets the definition of ``low'' for fat and saturated 
fat;
    (ii)(A) Before January 1, 1998, sodium is not present at a level 
exceeding 600 mg per labeled serving, or
    (B) After January 1, 1998, sodium is not present at a level 
exceeding 480 mg per labeled serving;
    (iii) Cholesterol is not present at a level exceeding 90 mg per 
labeled serving;
    (iv) The food contains at least 10 percent of the RDI or DRV per 
labeled serving of two (for main dish products) or three (for meal 
products) of the following nutrients--vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, 
iron, protein, or fiber;
    (v) Where compliance with paragraph (d)(4)(iv) of this section is 
based on a nutrient that has been added to the food, that fortification 
is in accordance with the policy on fortification of foods in 
Sec. 104.20 of this chapter; and
    (vi) The food complies with definitions and declaration requirements 
established in this part for any specific nutrient content claim on the 
label or in labeling.

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17343, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 59 
FR 394, Jan. 4, 1994; 59 FR 24249, May 10, 1994; 59 FR 50828, Oct. 6, 
1994]



Sec. 101.67  Use of nutrient content claims for butter.

    (a) Claims may be made to characterize the level of nutrients, 
including fat, in butter if:
    (1) The claim complies with the requirements of Sec. 101.13 and with 
the requirements of the regulations in this subpart that define the 
particular nutrient content claim that is used and how it is to be 
presented. In determining whether a claim is appropriate, the 
calculation of the percent fat reduction in milkfat shall be based on 
the 80 percent milkfat requirement provided by the statutory standard 
for butter (21 U.S.C. 321a);
    (2) The product contains cream or milk, including milk constituents 
(including, but not limited to, whey, casein, modified whey, and salts 
of casein), or both, with or without added salt, with or without safe 
and suitable colorings, with or without nutrients added to comply with 
paragraph (a)(3) of this section, and with or without safe and suitable 
bacterial cultures. The product may contain safe and suitable 
ingredients to improve texture, prevent syneresis, add flavor, extend 
shelf life, improve appearance, and add sweetness. The product may 
contain water to replace milkfat although the amount of water in the 
product shall be less than the amount of cream, milk, or milk 
constituents;
    (3) The product is not nutritionally inferior, as defined in 
Sec. 101.3(e)(4), to butter as produced under 21 U.S.C. 321a; and
    (4) If the product would violate 21 U.S.C. 321a but for the nutrient 
content claim that characterizes the level of nutrients, that claim 
shall be an explicit claim that is included as part of the common or 
usual name of the product.
    (b) Deviations from the ingredient provisions of 21 U.S.C. 321a must 
be the minimum necessary to achieve similar performance characteristics 
as butter as produced under 21 U.S.C. 321a, or the

[[Page 112]]

food will be deemed to be adulterated under section 402(b) of the act. 
The performance characteristics (e.g., physical properties, organoleptic 
characteristics, functional properties, shelf life) of the product shall 
be similar to butter as produced under 21 U.S.C. 321a. If there is a 
significant difference in performance characteristics (that materially 
limits the uses of the product compared to butter,) the label shall 
include a statement informing the consumer of such difference (e.g., if 
appropriate, ``not recommended for baking purposes''). Such statement 
shall comply with the requirements of Sec. 101.13(d). The modified 
product shall perform at least one of the principal functions of butter 
substantially as well as butter as produced under 21 U.S.C. 321a.
    (c)(1) Each of the ingredients used in the food shall be declared on 
the label as required by the applicable sections of this part.
    (2) Safe and suitable ingredients added to improve texture, prevent 
syneresis, add flavor, extend shelf life, improve appearance, or add 
sweetness and water added to replace milkfat shall be identified with an 
asterisk in the ingredient statement. The statement ``*Ingredients not 
in regular butter'' shall immediately follow the ingredient statement in 
the same type size.

[58 FR 2455, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.69  Petitions for nutrient content claims.

    (a) This section pertains to petitions for claims, expressed or 
implied, that:
    (1) Characterize the level of any nutrient which is of the type 
required to be in the label or labeling of food by section 403(q)(1) or 
(q)(2) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act); and
    (2) That are not exempted under section 403(r)(5)(A) through 
(r)(5)(C) of the act from the requirements for such claims in section 
403(r)(2).
    (b) Petitions included in this section are:
    (1) Petitions for a new (heretofore unauthorized) nutrient content 
claim;
    (2) Petitions for a synonymous term (i.e., one that is consistent 
with a term defined by regulation) for characterizing the level of a 
nutrient; and
    (3) Petitions for the use of an implied claim in a brand name.
    (c) An original and one copy of the petition to be filed under the 
provisions of section 403(r)(4) of the act shall be submitted, or the 
petitioner may submit an original and a computer readable disk 
containing the petition. Contents of the disk should be in a standard 
format, such as ASCII format. Petitioners interested in submitting a 
disk should contact FDA's Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition 
for details. If any part of the material submitted is in a foreign 
language, it shall be accompanied by an accurate and complete English 
translation. The petition shall state the petitioner's post office 
address to which published notices as required by section 403 of the act 
may be sent.
    (d) Pertinent information may be incorporated in, and will be 
considered as part of, a petition on the basis of specific reference to 
such information submitted to and retained in the files of the Food and 
Drug Administration. However, any reference to unpublished information 
furnished by a person other than the applicant will not be considered 
unless use of such information is authorized (with the understanding 
that such information may in whole or part be subject to release to the 
public) in a written statement signed by the person who submitted it. 
Any reference to published information should be accompanied by reprints 
or photostatic copies of such references.
    (e) If nonclinical laboratory studies are included in a petition 
submitted under section 403(r)(4) of the act, the petition shall 
include, with respect to each nonclinical study contained in the 
petition, either a statement that the study has been, or will be, 
conducted in compliance with the good laboratory practice regulations as 
set forth in part 58 of this chapter or, if any such study was not 
conducted in compliance with such regulations, a brief statement of the 
reason for the noncompliance.
    (f) If clinical investigations are included in a petition submitted 
under section 403(r)(4) of the act, the petition shall include a 
statement regarding each such clinical investigation relied upon in the 
petition that the study either was conducted in compliance with

[[Page 113]]

the requirements for institutional review set forth in part 56 of this 
chapter or was not subject to such requirements in accordance with 
Sec. 56.104 or Sec. 56.105 of this chapter, and that it was conducted in 
compliance with the requirements for informed consent set forth in part 
50 of this chapter.
    (g) The availability for public disclosure of petitions submitted to 
the agency under this section will be governed by the rules specified in 
Sec. 10.20(j) of this chapter.
    (h) All petitions submitted under this section shall include either 
a claim for a categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this chapter or 
an environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter.
    (i) The data specified under the several lettered headings should be 
submitted on separate sheets or sets of sheets, suitably identified. If 
such data have already been submitted with an earlier application from 
the petitioner, the present petition may incorporate it by specific 
reference to the earlier petition.
    (j) The petition must be signed by the petitioner or by his attorney 
or agent, or (if a corporation) by an authorized official.
    (k) The petition shall include a statement signed by the person 
responsible for the petition, that to the best of his knowledge, it is a 
representative and balanced submission that includes unfavorable 
information, as well as favorable information, known to him pertinent to 
the evaluation of the petition.
    (l) All applicable provisions of part 10--Administrative Practices 
and Procedures, may be used by the Commissioner of Food and Drugs, the 
petitioner or any outside party with respect to any agency action on the 
petition.
    (m)(1) Petitions for a new nutrient content claim shall include the 
following data and be submitted in the following form.
    ------------
    (Date)
Name of petitioner ------------
Post office address ------------
Subject of the petition ------------
Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150)
Food and Drug Administration,
Department of Health and Human Services,
Washington, DC 20204.
To Whom It May Concern:
    The undersigned, -- submits this petition under section 403(r)(4) of 
the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act) with respect to 
(statement of the claim and its proposed use).
    Attached hereto and constituting a part of this petition, are the 
following:
    A. A statement identifying the descriptive term and the nutrient 
that the term is intended to characterize with respect to the level of 
such nutrient. The statement should address why the use of the term as 
proposed will not be misleading. The statement should provide examples 
of the nutrient content claim as it will be used on labels or labeling, 
as well as the types of foods on which the claim will be used. The 
statement shall specify the level at which the nutrient must be present 
or what other conditions concerning the food must be met for the use of 
the term in labels or labeling to be appropriate, as well as any factors 
that would make the use of the term inappropriate.
    B. A detailed explanation, supported by any necessary data, of why 
use of the food component characterized by the claim is of importance in 
human nutrition by virtue of its presence or absence at the levels that 
such claim would describe. This explanation shall also state what 
nutritional benefit to the public will derive from use of the claim as 
proposed, and why such benefit is not available through the use of 
existing terms defined by regulation under section 403(r)(2)(A)(i) of 
the act. If the claim is intended for a specific group within the 
population, the analysis should specifically address nutritional needs 
of such group, and should include scientific data sufficient for such 
purpose.
    C. Analytical data that shows the amount of the nutrient that is the 
subject of the claim and that is present in the types of foods for which 
the claim is intended. The assays should be performed on representative 
samples using the Association of Official Analytical Chemists 
International (AOAC International) methods where available. If no AOAC 
International method is available, the petitioner shall submit the assay 
method used, and data establishing the validity of the method for 
assaying the nutrient in the particular food. The validation data should 
include a statistical analysis of the analytical and product 
variability.
    D. A detailed analysis of the potential effect of the use of the 
proposed claim on food consumption and of any corresponding changes in 
nutrient intake. The latter item shall specifically address the intake 
of nutrients that have beneficial and negative consequences in the total 
diet. If the claim is intended for a specific group within the 
population, the above analysis shall specifically address the dietary 
practices of such group and shall include data sufficient to

[[Page 114]]

demonstrate that the dietary analysis is representative of such group.
    E. The petitioner is required to submit either a claim for 
categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this chapter or an 
environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter.
    Yours very truly,
    Petitioner ------------
    By ------------
    (Indicate authority)
    (2) Within 15 days of receipt of the petition, the petitioner will 
be notified by letter of the date on which the petition was received by 
the agency. Such notice will inform the petitioner:
    (i) That the petition is undergoing agency review (in which case a 
docket number will be assigned to the petition), and the petitioner will 
subsequently be notified of the agency's decision to file or deny the 
petition; or
    (ii) That the petition is incomplete, e.g., it lacks any of the data 
required by this part, it presents such data in a manner that is not 
readily understood, or it has not been submitted in quadruplicate, in 
which case the petition will be denied, and the petitioner will be 
notified as to what respect the petition is incomplete.
    (3) Within 100 days of the date of receipt of the petition, the 
Commissioner of Food and Drugs will notify the petitioner by letter that 
the petition has either been filed or denied. If denied, the 
notification shall state the reasons therefor. If filed, the date of the 
notification letter becomes the date of filing for the purposes of 
section 403(r)(4)(A)(i) of the act. A petition that has been denied 
shall not be made available to the public. A filed petition shall be 
available to the public as provided under paragraph (g) of this section.
    (4) Within 90 days of the date of filing the Commissioner of Food 
and Drugs will by letter of notification to the petitioner:
    (i) Deny the petition; or
    (ii) Inform the petitioner that a proposed regulation to provide for 
the requested use of the new term will be published in the Federal 
Register. The Commissioner of Food and Drugs will publish the proposal 
to amend the regulations to provide for the requested use of the 
nutrient content claim in the Federal Register within 90 days of the 
date of filing. The proposal will also announce the availability of the 
petition for public disclosure.
    (n)(1) Petitions for a synonymous term shall include the following 
data and be submitted in the following form.
    ------------
    (Date)
Name of petitioner ------------
Post office address ------------
Subject of the petition ------------
Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150)
Food and Drug Administration,
Department of Health and Human Services,
Washington, DC 20204.
To Whom It May Concern:
    The undersigned, ------------ submits this petition under section 
403(r)(4) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act) with 
respect to (statement of the synonymous term and its proposed use in a 
nutrient content claim that is consistent with an existing term that has 
been defined under section 403(r)(2) of the act).
    Attached hereto and constituting a part of this petition, are the 
following:
    A. A statement identifying the synonymous descriptive term, the 
existing term defined by a regulation under section 403(r)(2)(A)(i) of 
the act with which the synonymous term is claimed to be consistent. The 
statement should address why the proposed synonymous term is consistent 
with the term already defined by the agency, and why the use of the 
synonymous term as proposed will not be misleading. The statement should 
provide examples of the nutrient content claim as it will be used on 
labels or labeling, as well as the types of foods on which the claim 
will be used. The statement shall specify whether any limitations not 
applicable to the use of the defined term are intended to apply to the 
use of the synonymous term.
    B. A detailed explanation, supported by any necessary data, of why 
use of the proposed term is requested, including an explanation of 
whether the existing defined term is inadequate for the purpose of 
effectively characterizing the level of a nutrient. This item shall also 
state what nutritional benefit to the public will derive from use of the 
claim as proposed, and why such benefit is not available through the use 
of existing term defined by regulation. If the claim is intended for a 
specific group within the population, the analysis should specifically 
address nutritional needs of such group, and should include scientific 
data sufficient for such purpose.
    C. The petitioner is required to submit either a claim for 
categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this chapter or an 
environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter.
    Yours very truly,
    Petitioner ------------
    By ------------

[[Page 115]]

    (Indicate authority)
    (2) Within 15 days of receipt of the petition the petitioner will be 
notified by letter of the date on which the petition

[[Page 116]]

was received. Such notice will inform the petitioner:
    (i) That the petition is undergoing agency review (in which case a 
docket number will be assigned to the petition) and the petitioner will 
subsequently be notified of the agency's decision to grant the 
petitioner permission to use the proposed term or to deny the petition; 
or
    (ii) That the petition is incomplete, e.g., it lacks any of the data 
required by this part, it presents such data in a manner that is not 
readily understood, or it has not been submitted in quadruplicate, in 
which case the petition will be denied, and the petitioner will be 
notified as to what respect the petition is incomplete.
    (3) Within 90 days of the date of receipt of the petition that is 
accepted for review (i.e., that has not been found to be incomplete and 
consequently denied, the Commissioner of Food and Drugs will notify the 
petitioner by letter of the agency's decision to grant the petitioner 
permission to use the proposed term, with any conditions or limitations 
on such use specified, or to deny the petition, in which case the letter 
shall state the reasons therefor. Failure of the petition to fully 
address the requirements of this section shall be grounds for denial of 
the petition.
    (4) As soon as practicable following the agency's decision to either 
grant or deny the petition, the Commissioner of Food and Drugs will 
publish a notice in the Federal Register informing the public of his 
decision. If the petition is granted the Food and Drug Administration 
will list, the approved synonymous term in the regulations listing terms 
permitted for use in nutrient content claims.
    (o)(1) Petitions for the use of an implied nutrient content claim in 
a brand name shall include the following data and be submitted in the 
following form:
    ------------
    (Date)
Name of petitioner ------------
Post office address ------------
Subject of the petition ------------
Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150)
Food and Drug Administration,
Department of Health and Human Services,
Washington, DC 20204.
To Whom It May Concern:
    The undersigned, -------------------------------- submits this 
petition under section 403(r)(4) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic 
Act (the act) with respect to (statement of the implied nutrient content 
claim and its proposed use in a brand name).
    Attached hereto and constituting a part of this petition, are the 
following:
    A. A statement identifying the implied nutrient content claim, the 
nutrient the claim is intended to characterize, the corresponding term 
for characterizing the level of such nutrient as defined by a regulation 
under section 403(r)(2)(A)(i) of the act, and the brand name of which 
the implied claim is intended to be a part. The statement should address 
why the use of the brandname as proposed will not be misleading. It 
should address in particular what information is required to accompany 
the claim or other ways in which the claim meets the requirements of 
sections 201(n) and 403(a) of the act. The statement should provide 
examples of the types of foods on which the brand name will appear. It 
shall also include data showing that the actual level of the nutrient in 
the food qualifies the food to bear the corresponding term defined by 
regulation. Assay methods used to determine the level of a nutrient 
should meet the requirements stated under petition format item C in 
paragraph (k)(1) of this section.
    B. A detailed explanation, supported by any necessary data, of why 
use of the proposed brand name is requested. This item shall also state 
what nutritional benefit to the public will derive from use of the brand 
name as proposed. If the branded product is intended for a specific 
group within the population, the analysis should specifically address 
nutritional needs of such group and should include scientific data 
sufficient for such purpose.
    C. The petitioner is required to submit either a claim for 
categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this chapter or an 
environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter.
    Yours very truly,
    Petitioner ------------
    By ------------
    (2) Within 15 days of receipt of the petition the petitioner will be 
notified by letter of the date on which the petition was received. Such 
notice will inform the petitioner:
    (i) That the petition is undergoing agency review (in which case a 
docket number will be assigned to the petition); or
    (ii) That the petition is incomplete, e.g., it lacks any of the data 
required by this part, it presents such data in a manner that is not 
readily understood, or it has not been submitted in quadruplicate, in 
which case the petition will be denied, and the petitioner will be 
notified as to what respect the petition is incomplete.
    (3) The Commissioner of Food and Drugs will publish a notice of the 
petition in the Federal Register announcing its availability to the 
public and seeking comment on the petition. The petition shall be 
available to the public to the extent provided under paragraph (g) of 
this section. The notice shall allow 30 days for comments.
    (4) Within 100 days of the date of receipt of the petition that is 
accepted for review (i.e., that has not been found to be incomplete and 
subsequently returned to the petitioner), the Commissioner of Food and 
Drugs will:
    (i) Notify the petitioner by letter of the agency's decision to 
grant the petitioner permission to use the proposed brand name if such 
use is not misleading, with any conditions or limitations on such use 
specified; or
    (ii) Deny the petition, in which case the letter shall state the 
reasons therefor. Failure of the petition to fully address the 
requirements of this section shall be grounds for denial of the 
petition. Should the Commissioner of Food and Drugs not notify the 
petitioner of his decision on the petition within 100 days, the petition 
shall be considered to be granted.
    (5) As soon as practicable following the granting of a petition, the 
Commissioner of Food and Drugs will publish a notice in the Federal 
Register informing the public of such fact.

(Information collection requirements in this section were approved by 
the Office of Management and Budget (OMB) and assigned OMB control 
number ------------)

[58 FR 2413, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17343, Apr. 2, 1993, as amended at 58 
FR 44033, Aug. 18, 1993]



           Subpart E--Specific Requirements for Health Claims



Sec. 101.70  Petitions for health claims.

    (a) Any interested person may petition the Food and Drug 
Administration (FDA) to issue a regulation regarding a health claim. An 
original and one copy of the petition shall be submitted, or the 
petitioner may submit an original and a computer readable disk 
containing the petition. Contents of the disk should be in a standard 
format, such as ASCII format. (Petitioners interested in submitting a 
disk should contact the Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition for 
details.) If any part of the material submitted is in a foreign 
language, it shall be accompanied by an accurate and complete English 
translation. The petition shall state the petitioner's post office 
address to which any correspondence required by section 403 of the 
Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act may be sent.
    (b) Pertinent information may be incorporated in, and will be 
considered as part of, a petition on the basis of specific reference to 
such information submitted to and retained in the files of FDA. Such 
information may include any findings, along with the basis of the 
findings, of an outside panel with expertise in the subject area. Any 
reference to published information shall be accompanied by reprints, or 
easily readable copies of such information.
    (c) If nonclinical laboratory studies are included in a petition, 
the petition shall include, with respect to each nonclinical study 
contained in the petition, either a statement that the study has been 
conducted in compliance with the good laboratory practice regulations as 
set forth in part 58 of this chapter, or, if any such study was not 
conducted in compliance with such regulations, a brief statement of the 
reason for the noncompliance.
    (d) If clinical or other human investigations are included in a 
petition, the petition shall include a statement that they were either 
conducted in compliance with the

[[Page 117]]

requirements for institutional review set forth in part 56 of this 
chapter, or were not subject to such requirements in accordance with 
Sec. 56.104 or Sec. 56.105, and a statement that they were conducted in 
compliance with the requirements for informed consent set forth in part 
50 of this chapter.
    (e) All data and information in a health claim petition are 
available for public disclosure after the notice of filing of petition 
is issued to the petitioner, except that clinical investigation reports, 
adverse reaction reports, product experience reports, consumer 
complaints, and other similar data and information shall only be 
available after deletion of:
    (1) Names and any information that would identify the person using 
the product.
    (2) Names and any information that would identify any third party 
involved with the report, such as a physician or hospital or other 
institution.
    (f) Petitions for a health claim shall include the following data 
and be submitted in the following form:

    --------------
    (Date)
Name of petitioner ------------
Post office address ------------
Subject of the petition ------------
Food and Drug Administration,
Office of Food Labeling (HFS-150),
200 C St. SW.,
Washington, DC 20204,
    The undersigned, -------------------- submits this petition pursuant 
to section 403(r)(4) or 403(r)(5)(D) of the Federal Food, Drug, and 
Cosmetic Act with respect to (statement of the substance and its health 
claim).
    Attached hereto, and constituting a part of this petition, are the 
following:
    A. Preliminary requirements. A complete explanation of how the 
substance conforms to the requirements of Sec. 101.14(b) (21 CFR 
101.14(b)). For petitions where the subject substance is a food 
ingredient or a component of a food ingredient, the petitioner should 
compile a comprehensive list of the specific ingredients that will be 
added to the food to supply the substance in the food bearing the health 
claim. For each such ingredient listed, the petitioner should state how 
the ingredient complies with the requirements of Sec. 101.14(b)(3)(ii), 
e.g., that its use is generally recognized as safe (GRAS), listed as a 
food additive, or authorized by a prior sanction issued by the agency, 
and what the basis is for the GRAS claim, the food additive status, or 
prior sanctioned status.
    B. Summary of scientific data. The summary of scientific data 
provides the basis upon which authorizing a health claim can be 
justified as providing the health benefit. The summary must establish 
that, based on the totality of publicly available scientific evidence 
(including evidence from well-designed studies conducted in a manner 
which is consistent with generally recognized scientific procedures and 
principles), there is significant scientific agreement among experts 
qualified by scientific training and experience to evaluate such claims, 
that the claim is supported by such evidence.
    The summary shall state what public health benefit will derive from 
use of the claim as proposed. If the claim is intended for a specific 
group within the population, the summary shall specifically address 
nutritional needs of such group and shall include scientific data 
showing how the claim is likely to assist in meeting such needs.
    The summary shall concentrate on the findings of appropriate review 
articles, National Institutes of Health consensus development 
conferences, and other appropriate resource materials. Issues addressed 
in the summary shall include answers to such questions as:
    1. Is there an optimum level of the particular substance to be 
consumed beyond which no benefit would be expected?
    2. Is there any level at which an adverse effect from the substance 
or from foods containing the substance occurs for any segment of the 
population?
    3. Are there certain populations that must receive special 
consideration?
    4. What other nutritional or health factors (both positive and 
negative) are important to consider when consuming the substance?
    In addition, the summary of scientific data shall include a detailed 
analysis of the potential effect of the use of the proposed claim on 
food consumption, specifically any change due to significant alterations 
in eating habits and corresponding changes in nutrient intake resulting 
from such changes in food consumption. The latter item shall 
specifically address the effect on the intake of nutrients that have 
beneficial and negative consequences in the total diet.
    If the claim is intended for a significant subpopulation within the 
general U.S. population, the analysis shall specifically address the 
dietary practices of such group, and shall include data sufficient to 
demonstrate that the dietary analysis is representative of such group 
(e.g., adolescents or the elderly).
    If appropriate, the petition shall explain the prevalence of the 
disease or health-related condition in the U.S. population and the 
relevance of the claim in the context of the total daily diet.
    Also, the summary shall demonstrate that the substance that is the 
subject of the proposed claim conforms to the definition of the term 
``substance'' in Sec. 101.14(a)(2).
    C. Analytical data that show the amount of the substance that is 
present in representative foods that would be candidates to bear the 
claim should be obtained from

[[Page 118]]

representative samples using methods from the Association of Official 
Analytical Chemists (AOAC), where available. If no AOAC method is 
available, the petitioner shall submit the assay method used and data 
establishing the validity of the method for assaying the substance in 
food. The validation data should include a statistical analysis of the 
analytical and product variability.
    D. Model health claim. One or more model health claims that 
represent label statements that may be used on a food label or in 
labeling for a food to characterize the relationship between the 
substance in a food to a disease or health-related condition that is 
justified by the summary of scientific data provided in section C of the 
petition. The model health claim shall include:
    1. A brief capsulized statement of the relevant conclusions of the 
summary, and
    2. A statement of how this substance helps the consumer to attain a 
total dietary pattern or goal associated with the health benefit that is 
provided.
    E. The petition shall include the following attachments:
    1. Copies of any computer literature searches done by the petitioner 
(e.g., Medline).
    2. Copies of articles cited in the literature searches and other 
information as follows:
    a. All information relied upon for the support of the health claim, 
including copies of publications or other information cited in review 
articles and used to perform meta-analyses.
    b. All information concerning adverse consequences to any segment of 
the population (e.g., sensitivity to the substance).
    c. All information pertaining to the U.S. population.
    F. The petitioner is required to submit either a claim for 
categorical exclusion under Sec. 25.24 of this chapter or an 
environmental assessment under Sec. 25.31 of this chapter.
     Yours very truly,
     Petitioner ------------
     By ------------
     (Indicate authority)

    (g) The data specified under the several lettered headings should be 
submitted on separate pages or sets of pages, suitably identified. If 
such data have already been submitted with an earlier application from 
the petitioner or any other final petition, the present petition may 
incorporate it by specific reference to the earlier petition.
    (h) The petition shall include a statement signed by the person 
responsible for the petition that, to the best of his/her knowledge, it 
is a representative and balanced submission that includes unfavorable 
information as well as favorable information, known to him/her to be 
pertinent to the evaluation of the proposed health claim.
    (i) The petition shall be signed by the petitioner or by his/her 
attorney or agent, or (if a corporation) by an authorized official.
    (j) Agency action on the petition. (1) Within 15 days of receipt of 
the petition, the petitioner will be notified by letter of the date on 
which the petition was received. Such notice will inform the petitioner 
that the petition is undergoing agency review and that the petitioner 
will subsequently be notified of the agency's decision to file for 
comprehensive review or deny the petition.
    (2) Within 100 days of the date of receipt of the petition, FDA will 
notify the petitioner by letter that the petition has either been filed 
for comprehensive review or denied. The agency will deny a petition 
without reviewing the information contained in B. Summary of Scientific 
Data if the information in A. Preliminary Requirements is inadequate in 
explaining how the substance conforms to the requirements of 
Sec. 101.14(b). If the petition is denied, the notification will state 
the reasons therefor, including justification of the rejection of any 
report from an authoritative scientific body of the U.S. Government. If 
filed, the date of the notification letter becomes the date of filing 
for the purposes of this regulation. A petition that has been denied 
without filing will not be made available to the public. A filed 
petition will be available to the public to the extent provided under 
paragraph (e) of this section.
    (3) Within 90 days of the date of filing, FDA will by letter of 
notification to the petitioner:
    (i) Deny the petition, or
    (ii) Inform the petitioner that a proposed regulation to provide for 
the requested use of the health claim will be published in the Federal 
Register. If the petition is denied, the notification will state the 
reasons therefor, including justification for the rejection of any 
report from an authoritative scientific body of the U.S. Government. FDA 
will publish the proposal to amend the regulations to provide for the 
requested use of the health claim in the Federal Register within 90

[[Page 119]]

days of the date of filing. The proposal will also announce the 
availability of the petition for public review.

[58 FR 2534, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17097, Apr. 1, 1993, as amended at 59 
FR 425, Jan. 4, 1994]



Sec. 101.71  Health claims: claims not authorized.

    Health claims not authorized for foods in conventional food form or 
for dietary supplements of vitamins, minerals, herbs, or other similar 
substances:
    (a) Dietary fiber and cancer.
    (b) Dietary fiber and cardiovascular disease.
    (c) Antioxidant vitamins and cancer.
    (d) Zinc and immune function in the elderly.
    (e) Omega-3 fatty acids and coronary heart disease.

[58 FR 2534, Jan. 6, 1993, as amended at 58 FR 2548, 2578, 2620, 2639, 
2664, 2714, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17100, Apr. 1, 1993; 59 FR 437, Jan. 4, 
1994]



Sec. 101.72  Health claims: calcium and osteoporosis.

    (a) Relationship between calcium and osteoporosis. An inadequate 
calcium intake contributes to low peak bone mass and has been identified 
as one of many risk factors in the development of osteoporosis. Peak 
bone mass is the total quantity of bone present at maturity, and experts 
believe that it has the greatest bearing on whether a person will be at 
risk of developing osteoporosis and related bone fractures later in 
life. Another factor that influences total bone mass and susceptibility 
to osteoporosis is the rate of bone loss after skeletal maturity. An 
adequate intake of calcium is thought to exert a positive effect during 
adolescence and early adulthood in optimizing the amount of bone that is 
laid down. However, the upper limit of peak bone mass is genetically 
determined. The mechanism through which an adequate calcium intake and 
optimal peak bone mass reduce the risk of osteoporosis is thought to be 
as follows. All persons lose bone with age. Hence, those with higher 
bone mass at maturity take longer to reach the critically reduced mass 
at which bones can fracture easily. The rate of bone loss after skeletal 
maturity also influences the amount of bone present at old age and can 
influence an individual's risk of developing osteoporosis. Maintenance 
of an adequate intake of calcium later in life is thought to be 
important in reducing the rate of bone loss particularly in the elderly 
and in women during the first decade following menopause.
    (b) Significance of calcium. Calcium intake is not the only 
recognized risk factor in the development of osteoporosis, a 
multifactorial bone disease. Other factors including a person's sex, 
race, hormonal status, family history, body stature, level of exercise, 
general diet, and specific life style choices such as smoking and excess 
alcohol consumption affect the risk of osteoporosis.
    (1) Heredity and being female are two key factors identifying those 
individuals at risk for the development of osteoporosis. Hereditary risk 
factors include race: Notably, Caucasians and Asians are characterized 
by low peak bone mass at maturity. Caucasian women, particularly those 
of northern European ancestry, experience the highest incidence of 
osteoporosis-related bone fracture. American women of African heritage 
are characterized by the highest peak bone mass and lowest incidence of 
osteoporotic fracture, despite the fact that they have low calcium 
intake.
    (2) Maintenance of an adequate intake of calcium throughout life is 
particularly important for a subpopulation of individuals at greatest 
risk of developing osteoporosis and for whom adequate dietary calcium 
intake may have the most important beneficial effects on bone health. 
This target subpopulation includes adolescent and young adult Caucasian 
and Asian American women.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating calcium with a reduced risk of osteoporosis may be made on 
the label or lableing of a food describe in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this 
section, provided that:
    (A) The claim makes clear that adequate calcium intake throughout 
life is not the only recognized risk factor in this multifactorial bone 
disease by

[[Page 120]]

listing specific factors, including sex, race, and age that place 
persons at risk of developing osteoporosis and stating that an adequate 
level of exercise and a healthful diet are also needed;
    (B) The claim does not state or imply that the risk of osteoporosis 
is equally applicable to the general United States population. The claim 
shall identify the populations at particular risk for the development of 
osteoporosis. These populations include white (or the term 
``Caucasian'') women and Asian women in their bone forming years 
(approximately 11 to 35 years of age or the phrase ``during teen or 
early adult years'' may be used). The claim may also identify menopausal 
(or the term ``middle-aged'') women, persons with a family history of 
the disease, and elderly (or ``older'') men and women as being at risk;
    (C) The claim states that adequate calcium intake throughout life is 
linked to reduced risk of osteoporosis through the mechanism of 
optimizing peak bone mass during adolescence and early adulthood. The 
phrase ``build and maintain good bone health'' may be used to convey the 
concept of optimizing peak bone mass. When reference is made to persons 
with a family history of the disease, menopausal women, and elderly men 
and women, the claim may also state that adequate calcium intake is 
linked to reduced risk of osteoporosis through the mechanism of slowing 
the rate of bone loss;
    (D) The claim does not attribute any degree of reduction in risk of 
osteoporosis to maintaining an adequate calcium intake throughout life; 
and
    (E) The claim states that a total dietary intake greater than 200 
percent of the recommended daily intake (2,000 milligrams (mg) of 
calcium) has no further known benefit to bone health. This requirement 
does not apply to foods that contain less than 40 percent of the 
recommended daily intake of 1,000 mg of calcium per day or 400 mg of 
calcium per reference amount customarily consumed as defined in 
Sec. 101.12 (b) or per total daily recommended supplement intake.
    (ii) Nature of the food. (A) The food shall meet or exceed the 
requirements for a ``high'' level of calcium as defined in 
Sec. 101.54(c);
    (B) The calcium content of the product shall be assimilable;
    (C) Dietary supplements shall meet the United States Pharmacopeia 
(U.S.P.) standards for disintegration and dissolution applicable to 
their component calcium salts, except that dietary supplements for which 
no U.S.P. standards exist shall exhibit appropriate assimilability under 
the conditions of use stated on the product label;
    (D) A food or total daily recommended supplement intake shall not 
contain more phosphorus than calcium on a weight per weight basis.
    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may include information from 
paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section.
    (2) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have osteoporosis. The sources of this information 
must be identified, and it must be current information from the National 
Center for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of Health, or 
``Dietary Guidelines for Americans.''
    (e) Model health claim. The following model health claims may be 
used in food labeling to describe the relationship between calcium and 
osteoporosis:

       Model Health Claim Appropriate for Most Conventional Foods:

    Regular exercise and a healthy diet with enough calcium helps teen 
and young adult white and Asian women maintain good bone health and may 
reduce their high risk of osteoporosis later in life.

 Model Health Claim Appropriate for Foods Exceptionally High in Calcium 
                      and Most Calcium Supplements:

    Regular exercise and a healthy diet with enough calcium helps teen 
and young adult white and Asian women maintain good bone health and may 
reduce their high risk of osteoporosis later in life. Adequate calcium 
intake is important, but daily intakes above about 2,000 mg are not 
likely to provide any additional benefit.

[58 FR 2676, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17101, Apr. 1, 1993]



Sec. 101.73  Health claims: dietary lipids and cancer.

     (a) Relationship between fat and cancer. (1) Cancer is a 
constellation of

[[Page 121]]

more than 100 different diseases, each characterized by the uncontrolled 
growth and spread of abnormal cells. Cancer has many causes and stages 
in its development. Both genetic and environmental risk factors may 
affect the risk of cancer. Risk factors include a family history of a 
specific type of cancer, cigarette smoking, alcohol consumption, 
overweight and obesity, ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, exposure to 
cancer-causing chemicals, and dietary factors.
     (2) Among dietary factors, the strongest positive association has 
been found between total fat intake and risk of some types of cancer. 
Based on the totality of the publicly available scientific evidence, 
there is significant scientific agreement among experts, qualified by 
training and experience to evaluate such evidence, that diets high in 
total fat are associated with an increased cancer risk. Research to 
date, although not conclusive, demonstrates that the total amount of 
fats, rather than any specific type of fat, is positively associated 
with cancer risk. The mechanism by which total fat affects cancer has 
not yet been established.
     (3) A question that has been the subject of considerable research 
is whether the effect of fat on cancer is site-specific. Neither human 
nor animal studies are consistent in the association of fat intake with 
specific cancer sites.
     (4) Another question that has been raised is whether the 
association of total fat intake to cancer risk is independently 
associated with energy intakes, or whether the association of fat with 
cancer risk is the result of the higher energy (caloric) intake normally 
associated with high fat intake. FDA has concluded that evidence from 
both animal and human studies indicates that total fat intake alone, 
independent of energy intake, is associated with cancer risk.
    (b) Significance of the relationship between fat intake and risk of 
cancer. (1) Cancer is ranked as a leading cause of death in the United 
States. The overall economic costs of cancer, including direct health 
care costs and losses due to morbidity and mortality, are very high.
    (2) U.S. diets tend to be high in fat and high in calories. The 
average U.S. diet is estimated to contain 36 to 37 percent of calories 
from total fat. Current dietary guidelines from the Federal Government 
and other national health professional organizations recommend that 
dietary fat intake be reduced to a level of 30 percent or less of energy 
(calories) from total fat. In order to reduce intake of total fat, 
individuals should choose diets which are high in vegetables, fruits, 
and grain products (particularly whole grain products), choose lean cuts 
of meats, fish, and poultry, substitute low-fat dairy products for 
higher fat products, and use fats and oils sparingly.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating diets low in fat with reduced risk of cancer may be made on 
the label or labeling of a food described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of 
this section, provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in fat ``may'' or ``might'' 
reduce the risk of some cancers;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the following terms: 
``some types of cancer'' or ``some cancers'';
    (C) In specifying the nutrient, the claim uses the term ``total 
fat'' or ``fat'';
    (D) The claim does not specify types of fat or fatty acid that may 
be related to the risk of cancer;
    (E) The claim does not attribute any degree of cancer risk reduction 
to diets low in fat; and
    (F) The claim indicates that the development of cancer depends on 
many factors.
    (ii) Nature of the food. The food shall meet all of the nutrient 
content requirements of Sec. 101.62 for a ``low fat'' food; except that 
fish and game meats (i.e., deer, bison, rabbit, quail, wild turkey, 
geese, ostrich) may meet the requirements for ``extra lean'' in 
Sec. 101.62.
     (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may identify one or more of 
the following risk factors for development of cancer: Family history of 
a specific type of cancer, cigarette smoking, alcohol consumption, 
overweight and obesity, ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, exposure to 
cancer-causing chemicals, and dietary factors.

[[Page 122]]

    (2) The claim may include information from paragraphs (a) and (b) of 
this section which summarize the relationship between dietary fat and 
cancer and the significance of the relationship.
    (3) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' U.S. Department of 
Agriculture (USDA) and Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS), 
Government Printing Office.
    (4) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have cancer. The sources of this information must be 
identified, and it must be current information from the National Center 
for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of Health, or ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' USDA and DHHS, 
Government Printing Office.
    (e) Model health claims. The following model health claims may be 
used in food labeling to describe the relationship between dietary fat 
and cancer:
    (1) Development of cancer depends on many factors. A diet low in 
total fat may reduce the risk of some cancers.
    (2) Eating a healthful diet low in fat may help reduce the risk of 
some types of cancers. Development of cancer is associated with many 
factors, including a family history of the disease, cigarette smoking, 
and what you eat.

[58 FR 2801, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17343, Apr. 2, 1993]



Sec. 101.74  Health claims: sodium and hypertension.

    (a) Relationship between sodium and hypertension (high blood 
pressure). (1) Hypertension, or high blood pressure, generally means a 
systolic blood pressure of greater than 140 millimeters of mercury (mm 
Hg) or a diastolic blood pressure of greater than 90 mm Hg. 
Normotension, or normal blood pressure, is a systolic blood pressure 
below 140 mm Hg and diastolic blood pressure below 90 mm Hg. Sodium is 
specified here as the chemical entity or electrolyte ``sodium'' and is 
distinguished from sodium chloride, or salt, which is 39 percent sodium 
by weight.
    (2) The scientific evidence establishes that diets high in sodium 
are associated with a high prevalence of hypertension or high blood 
pressure and with increases in blood pressure with age, and that diets 
low in sodium are associated with a low prevalence of hypertension or 
high blood pressure and with a low or no increase of blood pressure with 
age.
    (b) Significance of sodium in relation to high blood pressure. (1) 
High blood pressure is a public health concern primarily because it is a 
major risk factor for mortality from coronary heart disease and stroke. 
Early management of high blood pressure is a major public health goal 
that can assist in reducing mortality associated with coronary heart 
disease and stroke. There is a continuum of mortality risk that 
increases as blood pressures rise. Individuals with high blood pressure 
are at greatest risk, and individuals with moderately high, high normal, 
and normal blood pressure are at steadily decreasing risk. The 
scientific evidence indicates that reducing sodium intake lowers blood 
pressure and associated risks in many but not all hypertensive 
individuals. There is also evidence that reducing sodium intake lowers 
blood pressure and associated risks in many but not all normotensive 
individuals as well.
    (2) The populations at greatest risk for high blood pressure, and 
those most likely to benefit from sodium reduction, include those with 
family histories of high blood pressure, the elderly, males because they 
develop hypertension earlier in life than females, and black males and 
females. Although some population groups are at greater risk than 
others, high blood-pressure is a disease of public health concern for 
all population groups. Sodium intake, alcohol consumption, and obesity 
are identified risk factors for high blood pressure.
    (3) Sodium intakes exceed recommended levels in almost every group 
in the United States. One of the major public health recommendations 
relative to high blood pressure is to decrease consumption of salt. On a 
population-wide basis, reducing the average sodium intake would have a 
small but significant effect on reducing the average blood pressure, 
and, consequently,

[[Page 123]]

reducing mortality from coronary heart disease and stroke.
    (4) Sodium is an essential nutrient, and experts have recommended a 
safe minimum level of 500 milligrams (mg) sodium per day and an upper 
level of 2,400 mg sodium per day, the FDA Daily Value for sodium.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating diets low in sodium with reduced risk of high blood pressure 
may be made on the label or labeling of a food described in paragraph 
(c)(2)(ii) of this section, provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in sodium ``may'' or ``might'' 
reduce the risk of high blood pressure;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the term ``high blood 
pressure'';
    (C) In specifying the nutrient, the claim uses the term ``sodium'';
    (D) The claim does not attribute any degree of reduction in risk of 
high blood pressure to diets low in sodium; and
    (E) The claim indicates that development of high blood pressure 
depends on many factors.
    (ii) Nature of the food. The food shall meet all of the nutrient 
content requirements of Sec. 101.61 for a ``low sodium'' food.
    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may identify one or more of 
the following risk factors for development of high blood pressure in 
addition to dietary sodium consumption: Family history of high blood 
pressure, growing older, alcohol consumption, and excess weight.
    (2) The claim may include information from paragraphs (a) and (b) of 
this section, which summarizes the relationship between dietary sodium 
and high blood pressure and the significance of the relationship.
    (3) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have high blood pressure. The sources of this 
information must be identified, and it must be current information from 
the National Center for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of 
Health, or ``Nutrition and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for 
Americans,'' U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS) and 
U.S. Department of Argiculture (USDA), Government Printing Office.
    (4) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: U.S. Dietary Guidelines for Americans, DHHS and USDA, 
Government Printing Office.
    (5) In specifying the nutrient, the claim may include the term 
``salt'' in addition to the term ``sodium.''
    (6) In specifying the disease, the claim may include the term 
``hypertension'' in addition to the term ``high blood pressure.''
    (7) The claim may state that individuals with high blood pressure 
should consult their physicians for medical advice and treatment. If the 
claim defines high or normal blood pressure, then the health claim must 
state that individuals with high blood pressure should consult their 
physicians for medical advice and treatment.
    (e) Model health claims. The following are model health claims that 
may be used in food labeling to describe the relationship between 
dietary sodium and high blood pressure:
    (1) Diets low in sodium may reduce the risk of high blood pressure, 
a disease associated with many factors.
    (2) Development of hypertension or high blood pressure depends on 
many factors. [This product] can be part of a low sodium, low salt diet 
that might reduce the risk of hypertension or high blood pressure.

[58 FR 2836, Jan. 6, 1993; 58 FR 17100, Apr. 1, 1993]



Sec. 101.75  Health claims: dietary saturated fat and cholesterol and risk of coronary heart disease.

    (a) Relationship between dietary saturated fat and cholesterol and 
risk of coronary heart disease. (1) Cardiovascular disease means 
diseases of the heart and circulatory system. Coronary heart disease is 
the most common and serious form of cardiovascular disease and refers to 
diseases of the heart muscle and supporting blood vessels. High blood 
total- and low density lipoprotein (LDL)- cholesterol levels are major 
modifiable risk factors in the development of coronary heart disease. 
High coronary heart disease rates

[[Page 124]]

occur among people with high blood cholesterol levels of 240 milligrams/
decaliter (mg/dL) (6.21 millimoles per liter (mmol/L)) or above and LDL-
cholesterol levels of 160 mg/dL (4.13 mmol/L) or above. Borderline high 
risk blood cholesterol levels range from 200 to 239 mg/dL (5.17 to 6.18 
mmol/L) and 130 to 159 mg/dL (3.36 to 4.11 mmol/L) of LDL-cholesterol. 
Dietary lipids (fats) include fatty acids and cholesterol. Total fat, 
commonly referred to as fat, is composed of saturated fat (fatty acids 
containing no double bonds), and monounsaturated and polyunsaturated fat 
(fatty acids containing one or more double bonds).
    (2) The scientific evidence establishes that diets high in saturated 
fat and cholesterol are associated with increased levels of blood total- 
and LDL-cholesterol and, thus, with increased risk of coronary heart 
disease. Diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol are associated with 
decreased levels of blood total- and LDL-cholesterol, and thus, with 
decreased risk of developing coronary heart disease.
    (b) Significance of the relationship between dietary saturated fat 
and cholesterol and risk of coronary heart disease. (1) Coronary heart 
disease is a major public health concern in the United States, primarily 
because it accounts for more deaths than any other disease or group of 
diseases. Early management of risk factors for coronary heart disease is 
a major public health goal that can assist in reducing risk of coronary 
heart disease. There is a continuum of mortality risk from coronary 
heart disease that increases with increasing levels of blood LDL-
cholesterol. Individuals with high blood LDL-cholesterol are at greatest 
risk. A larger number of individuals with more moderately elevated 
cholesterol also have increased risk of coronary events; such 
individuals comprise a substantial proportion of the adult U.S. 
population. The scientific evidence indicates that reducing saturated 
fat and cholesterol intakes lowers blood LDL-cholesterol and risk of 
heart disease in most individuals. There is also evidence that reducing 
saturated fat and cholesterol intakes in persons with blood cholesterol 
levels in the normal range also reduces risk of heart disease.
    (2) Other risk factors for coronary heart disease include a family 
history of heart disease, high blood pressure, diabetes, cigarette 
smoking, obesity (body weight 30 percent greater than ideal body 
weight), and lack of regular physical exercise.
    (3) Intakes of saturated fat exceed recommended levels in many 
people in the United States. Intakes of cholesterol are, on average, at 
or above recommended levels. One of the major public health 
recommendations relative to coronary heart disease risk is to consume 
less than 10 percent of calories from saturated fat, and an average of 
30 percent or less of total calories from all fat. Recommended daily 
cholesterol intakes are 300 mg or less per day.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol with reduced risk 
of coronary heart disease may be made on the label or labeling of a food 
described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol 
``may'' or ``might'' reduce the risk of heart disease;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the terms ``heart 
disease'' or ``coronary heart disease;''
    (C) In specifying the nutrient, the claim uses the terms ``saturated 
fat'' and ``cholesterol'' and lists both;
    (D) The claim does not attribute any degree of risk reduction for 
coronary heart disease to diets low in dietary saturated fat and 
cholesterol; and
    (E) The claim states that coronary heart disease risk depends on 
many factors.
    (ii) Nature of the food. The food shall meet all of the nutrient 
content requirements of Sec. 101.62 for a ``low saturated fat,'' ``low 
cholesterol,'' and ``low fat'' food; except that fish and game meats 
(i.e., deer, bison, rabbit, quail, wild turkey, geese, and ostrich) may 
meet the requirements for ``extra lean'' in Sec. 101.62.

[[Page 125]]

    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may identify one or more of 
the following risk factors in addition to saturated fat and cholesterol 
about which there is general scientific agreement that they are major 
risk factors for this disease: A family history of coronary heart 
disease, elevated blood total and LDL-cholesterol, excess body weight, 
high blood pressure, cigarette smoking, diabetes, and physical 
inactivity.
    (2) The claim may indicate that the relationship of saturated fat 
and cholesterol to heart disease is through the intermediate link of 
``blood cholesterol'' or ``blood total- and LDL cholesterol.''
    (3) The claim may include information from paragraphs (a) and (b) of 
this section, which summarize the relationship between dietary saturated 
fat and cholesterol and risk of coronary heart disease, and the 
significance of the relationship.
    (4) In specifying the nutrients, the claim may include the term 
``total fat'' in addition to the terms ``saturated fat'' and 
``cholesterol''.
    (5) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have coronary heart disease. The sources of this 
information shall be identified, and it shall be current information 
from the National Center for Health Statistics, the National Institutes 
of Health, or ``Nutrition and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for 
Americans,'' U.S. Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS) and 
U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA), Government Printing Office.
    (6) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' DHHS and USDA, 
Government Printing Office.
    (7) The claim may state that individuals with elevated blood total- 
or LDL-cholesterol should consult their physicians for medical advice 
and treatment. If the claim defines high or normal blood total- or LDL-
cholesterol levels, then the claim shall state that individuals with 
high blood cholesterol should consult their physicians for medical 
advice and treatment.
    (e) Model health claims.The following are model health claims that 
may be used in food labeling to describe the relationship between 
dietary saturated fat and cholesterol and risk of heart disease:
    (1) While many factors affect heart disease, diets low in saturated 
fat and cholesterol may reduce the risk of this disease;
    (2) Development of heart disease depends upon many factors, but its 
risk may be reduced by diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol and 
healthy lifestyles;
    (3) Development of heart disease depends upon many factors, 
including a family history of the disease, high blood LDL-cholesterol, 
diabetes, high blood pressure, being overweight, cigarette smoking, lack 
of exercise, and the type of dietary pattern. A healthful diet low in 
saturated fat, total fat, and cholesterol, as part of a healthy 
lifestyle, may lower blood cholesterol levels and may reduce the risk of 
heart disease;
    (4) Many factors, such as a family history of the disease, increased 
blood- and LDL-cholesterol levels, high blood pressure, cigarette 
smoking, diabetes, and being overweight, contribute to developing heart 
disease. A diet low in saturated fat, cholesterol, and total fat may 
help reduce the risk of heart disease; and
    (5) Diets low in saturated fat, cholesterol, and total fat may 
reduce the risk of heart disease. Heart disease is dependent upon many 
factors, including diet, a family history of the disease, elevated blood 
LDL-cholesterol levels, and physical inactivity.

[58 FR 2757, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.76   Health claims: fiber-containing grain products, fruits, and vegetables and cancer.

    (a) Relationship between diets low in fat and high in fiber-
containing grain products, fruits, and vegetables and cancer risk. (1) 
Cancer is a constellation of more than 100 different diseases, each 
characterized by the uncontrolled growth and spread of abnormal cells. 
Cancer has many causes and stages in its development. Both genetic and 
environmental risk factors may affect the risk of cancer. Risk factors 
include: A family history of a specific type of cancer, cigarette 
smoking, overweight

[[Page 126]]

and obesity, alcohol consumption, ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, 
exposure to cancer-causing chemicals, and dietary factors.
    (2) The scientific evidence establishes that diets low in fat and 
high in fiber-containing grain products, fruits, and vegetables are 
associated with a reduced risk of some types of cancer. Although the 
specific role of total dietary fiber, fiber components, and the multiple 
nutrients and other substances contained in these foods are not yet 
fully understood, many studies have shown that diets low in fat and high 
in fiber-containing foods are associated with reduced risk of some types 
of cancer.
    (b) Significance of the relationship between consumption of diets 
low in fat and high in fiber-containing grain products, fruits, and 
vegetables and risk of cancer. (1) Cancer is ranked as a leading cause 
of death in the United States. The overall economic costs of cancer, 
including direct health care costs and losses due to morbidity and 
mortality, are very high.
    (2) U.S. diets tend to be high in fat and low in grain products, 
fruits, and vegetables. Studies in various parts of the world indicate 
that populations who habitually consume a diet high in plant foods have 
lower risks of some cancers. These diets generally are low in fat and 
rich in many nutrients, including, but not limited to, dietary fiber. 
Current dietary guidelines from Federal government agencies and 
nationally recognized health professional organizations recommend 
decreased consumption of fats (less than 30 percent of calories), 
maintenance of desirable body weight, and increased consumption of 
fruits and vegetables (five or more servings daily), and grain products 
(six or more servings daily).
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating diets low in fat and high in fiber-containing grain 
products, fruits, and vegetables with reduced risk of cancer may be made 
on the label or labeling of a food described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of 
this section, provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in fat and high in fiber-
containing grain products, fruits, and vegetables ``may'' or ``might'' 
reduce the risk of some cancers;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the following terms: 
``some types of cancer,'' or ``some cancers'';
    (C) The claim is limited to grain products, fruits, and vegetables 
that contain dietary fiber;
    (D) The claim indicates that development of cancer depends on many 
factors;
    (E) The claim does not attribute any degree of cancer risk reduction 
to diets low in fat and high in fiber-containing grain products, fruits, 
and vegetables;
    (F) In specifying the dietary fiber component of the labeled food, 
the claim uses the term ``fiber'', ``dietary fiber'' or ``total dietary 
fiber''; and
    (G) The claim does not specify types of dietary fiber that may be 
related to risk of cancer.
    (ii) Nature of the food. (A) The food shall be or shall contain a 
grain product, fruit, or vegetable.
    (B) The food shall meet the nutrient content requirements of 
Sec. 101.62 for a ``low fat'' food.
    (C) The food shall meet, without fortification, the nutrient content 
requirements of Sec. 101.54 for a ``good source'' of dietary fiber.
    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may include information from 
paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section, which summarize the relationship 
between diets low in fat and high in fiber-containing grain products, 
fruits, and vegetables, and some types of cancer and the significance of 
the relationship.
    (2) The claim may identify one or more of the following risk factors 
for development of cancer: Family history of a specific type of cancer, 
cigarette smoking, overweight and obesity, alcohol consumption, 
ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, exposure to cancer causing chemicals, 
and dietary factors.
    (3) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' U.S. Department of 
Agriculture (USDA) and Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS), 
Government Printing Office.
    (4) The claim may include information on the number of people in the

[[Page 127]]

United States who have cancer. The sources of this information must be 
identified, and it must be current information from the National Center 
for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of Health, or ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' USDA and DHHS, 
Government Printing Office.
    (e) Model health claims. The following model health claims may be 
used in food labeling to characterize the relationship between diets low 
in fat and high in fiber-containing grain products, fruits, and 
vegetables and cancer risk:
    (1) Low fat diets rich in fiber-containing grain products, fruits, 
and vegetables may reduce the risk of some types of cancer, a disease 
associated with many factors.
    (2) Development of cancer depends on many factors. Eating a diet low 
in fat and high in grain products, fruits, and vegetables that contain 
dietary fiber may reduce your risk of some cancers.

[58 FR 2548, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.77  Health claims: fruits, vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber, particularly soluble fiber, and risk of coronary heart disease.

    (a) Relationship between diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol 
and high in fruits, vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber, 
particularly soluble fiber, and risk of coronary heart disease. (1) 
Cardiovascular disease means diseases of the heart and circulatory 
system. Coronary heart disease is the most common and serious form of 
cardiovascular disease and refers to diseases of the heart muscle and 
supporting blood vessels. High blood total- and low density lipoprotein 
(LDL)- cholesterol levels are major modifiable risk factors in the 
development of coronary heart disease. High coronary heart disease rates 
occur among people with high blood cholesterol levels of 240 milligrams 
per deciliter (mg/dL) (6.21 (mmol/L)) or above and LDL-cholesterol 
levels of 160 mg/dL (4.13 mmol/L) or above. Borderline high risk blood 
cholesterol levels range from 200 to 239 mg/dL (5.17 to 6.18 mmol/L) and 
130 to 159 mg/dL (3.36 to 4.11 mmol/L) of LDL-cholesterol. Dietary 
lipids (fats) include fatty acids and cholesterol. Total fat, commonly 
referred to as fat, is composed of saturated fat (fatty acids containing 
no double bonds), and monounsaturated and polyunsaturated fat (fatty 
acids containing one or more double bonds).
    (2) The scientific evidence establishes that diets high in saturated 
fat and cholesterol are associated with increased levels of blood total- 
and LDL-cholesterol and, thus, with increased risk of coronary heart 
disease. Diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol are associated with 
decreased levels of blood total- and LDL-cholesterol, and thus, with 
decreased risk of developing coronary heart disease.
    (3) Populations with relatively low blood cholesterol levels tend to 
have dietary patterns that are not only low in total fat, especially 
saturated fat and cholesterol, but are also relatively high in fruits, 
vegetables, and grain products. Although the specific roles of these 
plant foods are not yet fully understood, many studies have shown that 
diets high in plant foods are associated with reduced risk of coronary 
heart disease. These studies correlate diets rich in fruits, vegetables, 
and grain products and nutrients from these diets, such as some types of 
fiber, with reduced coronary heart disease risk. Persons consuming these 
diets frequently have high intakes of dietary fiber, particularly 
soluble fibers. Currently, there is not scientific agreement as to 
whether a particular type of soluble fiber is beneficial, or whether the 
observed protective effects of fruits, vegetables, and grain products 
against heart disease are due to other components, or a combination of 
components, in these diets, including, but not necessarily limited to, 
some types of soluble fiber, other fiber components, other 
characteristics of the complex carbohydrate content of these foods, 
other nutrients in these foods, or displacement of saturated fat and 
cholesterol from the diet.
    (b) Significance of the relationship between diets low in saturated 
fat and cholesterol, and high in fruits, vegetables, and grain products 
that contain fiber, particularly soluble fiber, and risk of coronary 
heart disease. (1) Coronary heart disease is a major public health 
concern in the United States, primarily because it accounts for more 
deaths

[[Page 128]]

than any other disease or group of diseases. Early management of risk 
factors for coronary heart disease is a major public health goal that 
can assist in reducing risk of coronary heart disease. There is a 
continuum of mortality risk from coronary heart disease that increases 
with increasing levels of blood LDL-cholesterol. Individuals with high 
blood LDL-cholesterol are at greatest risk. A larger number of 
individuals with more moderately elevated cholesterol also have 
increased risk of coronary events; such individuals comprise a 
substantial proportion of the adult U.S. population. The scientific 
evidence indicates that reducing saturated fat and cholesterol intakes 
lowers blood LDL-cholesterol and risk of heart disease in most 
individuals, including persons with blood cholesterol levels in the 
normal range. Additionally, consuming diets high in fruits, vegetables, 
and grain products, foods that contain soluble fiber, may be a useful 
adjunct to a low saturated fat and low cholesterol diet.
    (2) Other risk factors for coronary heart disease include a family 
history of heart disease, high blood pressure, diabetes, cigarette 
smoking, obesity (body weight 30 percent greater than ideal body 
weight), and lack of regular physical exercise.
    (3) Intakes of saturated fat exceed recommended levels in many 
people in the United States. Intakes of cholesterol are, on average, at 
or above recommended levels. Intakes of fiber-containing fruits, 
vegetables, and grain products are about half of recommended intake 
levels. One of the major public health recommendations relative to 
coronary heart disease risk is to consume less than 10 percent of 
calories from saturated fat, and an average of 30 percent or less of 
total calories from all fat. Recommended daily cholesterol intakes are 
300 mg or less per day. Recommended total dietary fiber intakes are 
about 25 grams (g) daily, of which about 25 percent (about 6 g) should 
be soluble fiber.
    (4) Current dietary guidance recommendations encourage decreased 
consumption of dietary fat, especially saturated fat and cholesterol, 
and increased consumption of fiber-rich foods to help lower blood LDL-
cholesterol levels. Results of numerous studies have shown that fiber-
containing fruits, vegetables, and grain products can help lower blood 
LDL-cholesterol.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol and high in 
fruits, vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber, particularly 
soluble fiber, with reduced risk of heart disease may be made on the 
label or labeling of a food described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this 
section, provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol 
and high in fruits, vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber 
``may'' or ``might'' reduce the risk of heart disease;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the following terms: 
``heart disease'' or ``coronary heart disease;''
    (C) The claim is limited to those fruits, vegetables, and grains 
that contain fiber;
    (D) In specifying the dietary fiber, the claim uses the term 
``fiber,'' ``dietary fiber,'' ``some types of dietary fiber,'' ``some 
dietary fibers,'' or ``some fibers;'' the term ``soluble fiber'' may be 
used in addition to these terms;
    (E) In specifying the fat component, the claims uses the terms 
``saturated fat'' and ``cholesterol;'' and
    (F) The claim indicates that development of heart disease depends on 
many factors; and
    (G) The claim does not attribute any degree of risk reduction for 
coronary heart disease to diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol and 
high in fruits, vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber.
    (ii) Nature of the food. (A) The food shall be or shall contain a 
fruit, vegetable, or grain product.
    (B) The food shall meet the nutrient content requirements of 
Sec. 101.62 for a ``low saturated fat,'' ``low cholesterol,'' and ``low 
fat'' food.
    (C) The food contains, without fortification, at least 0.6 g of 
soluble fiber per reference amount customarily consumed;
    (D) The content of soluble fiber shall be declared in the nutrition

[[Page 129]]

information panel, consistent with Sec. 101.9(c)(6)(i)(A).
    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may identify one or more of 
the following risk factors for heart disease about which there is 
general scientific agreement: A family history of coronary heart 
disease, elevated blood-, total- and LDL-cholesterol, excess body 
weight, high blood pressure, cigarette smoking, diabetes, and physical 
inactivity.
    (2) The claim may indicate that the relationship of diets low in 
saturated fat and cholesterol, and high in fruits, vegetables, and grain 
products that contain fiber to heart disease is through the intermediate 
link of ``blood cholesterol'' or ``blood total- and LDL-cholesterol.''
    (3) The claim may include information from paragraphs (a) and (b) of 
this section, which summarize the relationship between diets low in 
saturated fat and cholesterol and high in fruits, vegetables, and grain 
products that contain fiber and coronary heart disease, and the 
significance of the relationship.
    (4) In specifying the nutrients, the claim may include the term 
``total fat'' in addition to the terms ``saturated fat'' and 
``cholesterol.''
    (5) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' U.S. Department of 
Agriculture (USDA) and Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS), 
Government Printing Office (GPO).
    (6) The claim may state that individuals with elevated blood total- 
and LDL-cholesterol should consult their physicians for medical advice 
and treatment. If the claim defines high or normal blood total- and LDL-
cholesterol levels, then the claim shall state that individuals with 
high blood cholesterol should consult their physicians for medical 
advice and treatment.
    (7) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have heart disease. The sources of this information 
shall be identified, and it shall be current information from the 
National Center for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of 
Health, or ``Nutrition and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for 
Americans,'' USDA and DHHS, GPO.
    (e) Model health claims. The following model health claims may be 
used in food labeling to characterize the relationship between diets low 
in saturated fat and cholesterol and high in fruits, vegetables, and 
grain products that contain soluble fiber:
    (1) Diets low in saturated fat and cholesterol and rich in fruits, 
vegetables, and grain products that contain some types of dietary fiber, 
particularly soluble fiber, may reduce the risk of heart disease, a 
disease associated with many factors.
    (2) Development of heart disease depends on many factors. Eating a 
diet low in saturated fat and cholesterol and high in fruits, 
vegetables, and grain products that contain fiber may lower blood 
cholesterol levels and reduce your risk of heart disease.

[58 FR 2578, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.78  Health claims: fruits and vegetables and cancer.

    (a) Relationship between substances in diets low in fat and high in 
fruits and vegetables and cancer risk. (1) Cancer is a constellation of 
more than 100 different diseases, each characterized by the uncontrolled 
growth and spread of abnormal cells. Cancer has many causes and stages 
in its development. Both genetic and environmental risk factors may 
affect the risk of cancer. Risk factors include a family history of a 
specific type of cancer, cigarette smoking, alcohol consumption, 
overweight and obesity, ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, exposure to 
cancer-causing chemicals, and dietary factors.
    (2) Although the specific roles of the numerous potentially 
protective substances in plant foods are not yet understood, many 
studies have shown that diets high in plant foods are associated with 
reduced risk of some types of cancers. These studies correlate diets 
rich in fruits and vegetables and nutrients from these diets, such as 
vitamin C, vitamin A, and dietary fiber, with reduced cancer risk. 
Persons consuming these diets frequently have high intakes of these 
nutrients. Currently, there is not scientific agreement as to whether 
the observed protective effects of fruits and vegetables

[[Page 130]]

against cancer are due to a combination of the nutrient components of 
diets rich in fruits and vegetables, including but not necessarily 
limited to dietary fiber, vitamin A (as beta-carotene) and vitamin C, to 
displacement of fat from such diets, or to intakes of other substances 
in these foods which are not nutrients but may be protective against 
cancer risk.
    (b) Significance of the relationship between consumption of diets 
low in fat and high in fruits and vegetables and risk of cancer. (1) 
Cancer is ranked as a leading cause of death in the United States. The 
overall economic costs of cancer, including direct health care costs and 
losses due to morbidity and mortality, are very high.
    (2) U.S. diets tend to be high in fat and low in fruits and 
vegetables. Studies in various parts of the world indicate that 
populations who habitually consume a diet high in plant foods have lower 
risks of some cancers. These diets generally are low in fat and rich in 
many nutrients, including, but not limited to, dietary fiber, vitamin A 
(as beta-carotene), and vitamin C. Current dietary guidelines from 
Federal Government agencies and nationally recognized health 
professional organizations recommend decreased consumption of fats (less 
than 30 percent of calories), maintenance of desirable body weight, and 
increased consumption of fruits and vegetables (5 or more servings 
daily), particularly those fruits and vegetables which contain dietary 
fiber, vitamin A, and vitamin C.
    (c) Requirements. (1) All requirements set forth in Sec. 101.14 
shall be met.
    (2) Specific requirements. (i) Nature of the claim. A health claim 
associating substances in diets low in fat and high in fruits and 
vegetables with reduced risk of cancer may be made on the label or 
labeling of a food described in paragraph (c)(2)(ii) of this section, 
provided that:
    (A) The claim states that diets low in fat and high in fruits and 
vegetables ``may'' or ``might'' reduce the risk of some cancers;
    (B) In specifying the disease, the claim uses the following terms: 
``some types of cancer'', or ``some cancers'';
    (C) The claim characterizes fruits and vegetables as foods that are 
low in fat and may contain vitamin A, vitamin C, and dietary fiber;
    (D) The claim characterizes the food bearing the claim as containing 
one or more of the following, for which the food is a good source under 
Sec. 101.54: dietary fiber, vitamin A, or vitamin C;
    (E) The claim does not attribute any degree of cancer risk reduction 
to diets low in fat and high in fruits and vegetables;
    (F) In specifying the fat component of the labeled food, the claim 
uses the term ``total fat'' or ``fat'';
    (G) The claim does not specify types of fats or fatty acids that may 
be related to risk of cancer;
    (H) In specifying the dietary fiber component of the labeled food, 
the claim uses the term ``fiber'', ``dietary fiber'', or ``total dietary 
fiber'';
    (I) The claim does not specify types of dietary fiber that may be 
related to risk of cancer; and
    (J) The claim indicates that development of cancer depends on many 
factors.
    (ii) Nature of the food. (A) The food shall be or shall contain a 
fruit or vegetable.
    (B) The food shall meet the nutrient content requirements of 
Sec. 101.62 for a ``low fat'' food.
    (C) The food shall meet, without fortification, the nutrient content 
requirements of Sec. 101.54 for a ``good source'' of at least one of the 
following: vitamin A, vitamin C, or dietary fiber.
    (d) Optional information. (1) The claim may include information from 
paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section, which summarize the relationship 
between diets low in fat and high in fruits and vegetables and some 
types of cancer and the significance of the relationship.
    (2) The claim may identify one or more of the following risk factors 
for development of cancer: Family history of a specific type of cancer, 
cigarette smoking, alcohol consumption, overweight and obesity, 
ultraviolet or ionizing radiation, exposure to cancer-causing chemicals, 
and dietary factors.
    (3) The claim may use the word ``beta-carotene'' in parentheses 
after the term vitamin A, provided that the vitamin A in the food 
bearing the claim is beta-carotene.

[[Page 131]]

    (4) The claim may indicate that it is consistent with ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' U.S. Department of 
Agriculture (USDA) and the Department of Health and Human Services 
(DHHS), Government Printing Office.
    (5) The claim may include information on the number of people in the 
United States who have cancer. The sources of this information must be 
identified, and it must be current information from the National Center 
for Health Statistics, the National Institutes of Health, or ``Nutrition 
and Your Health: Dietary Guidelines for Americans,'' USDA and DHHS, 
Government Printing Office.
    (e) Model health claims. The following model health claims may be 
used in food labeling to characterize the relationship between 
substances in diets low in fat and high in fruits and vegetables and 
cancer:
    (1) Low fat diets rich in fruits and vegetables (foods that are low 
in fat and may contain dietary fiber, vitamin A, and vitamin C) may 
reduce the risk of some types of cancer, a disease associated with many 
factors. Broccoli is high in vitamins A and C, and it is a good source 
of dietary fiber.
    (2) Development of cancer depends on many factors. Eating a diet low 
in fat and high in fruits and vegetables, foods that are low in fat and 
may contain vitamin A, vitamin C, and dietary fiber, may reduce your 
risk of some cancers. Oranges, a food low in fat, are a good source of 
fiber and vitamin C.

[58 FR 2639, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.79  Health claims: Folate and neural tube defects.

    (a) Relationship between folate and neural tube defects--(1) 
Definition. Neural tube defects are serious birth defects of the brain 
or spinal cord that can result in infant mortality or serious 
disability. The birth defects anencephaly and spina bifida are the most 
common forms of neural tube defects and account for about 90 percent of 
these defects. These defects result from failure of closure of the 
covering of the brain or spinal cord during early embryonic development. 
Because the neural tube forms and closes during early pregnancy, the 
defect may occur before a woman realizes that she is pregnant.
    (2) Relationship. The available data show that diets adequate in 
folate may reduce the risk of neural tube defects. The strongest 
evidence for this relationship comes from an intervention study by the 
Medical Research Council of the United Kingdom that showed that women at 
risk of recurrence of a neural tube defect pregnancy who consumed a 
supplement containing 4 milligrams (mg)(4,000 micrograms (mcg)) folic 
acid daily before conception and continuing into early pregnancy had a 
reduced risk of having a child with a neural tube defect. (Products 
containing this level of folic acid are drugs). In addition, based on 
its review of a Hungarian intervention trial that reported 
periconceptional use of a multivitamin and multimineral preparation 
containing 800 mcg (0.8 mg) of folic acid, and its review of the 
observational studies that reported periconceptional use of 
multivitamins containing 0 to 1,000 mcg of folic acid, the Food and Drug 
Administration concluded that most of these studies had results 
consistent with the conclusion that folate, at levels attainable in 
usual diets, may reduce the risk of neural tube defects.
    (b) Significance of folate--(1) Public health concern. Neural tube 
defects occur in approximately 0.6 of 1,000 live births in the United 
States (i.e., approximately 6 of 10,000 live births; about 2,500 cases 
among 4 million live births annually). Neural tube defects are believed 
to be caused by many factors. The single greatest risk factor for a 
neural tube defect-affected pregnancy is a personal or family history of 
a pregnancy affected with a such a defect. However, about 90 percent of 
infants with a neural tube defect are born to women who do not have a 
family history of these defects. The available evidence shows that diets 
adequate in folate may reduce the risk of neural tube defects but not of 
other birth defects.
    (2) Populations at risk. Prevalence rates for neural tube defects 
have been reported to vary with a wide range of factors including 
genetics, geography, socioeconomic status, maternal birth cohort, month 
of conception, race,

[[Page 132]]

nutrition, and maternal health, including maternal age and reproductive 
history. Women with a close relative (i.e., sibling, niece, nephew) with 
a neural tube defect, those with insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus, 
and women with seizure disorders who are being treated with valproic 
acid or carbamazepine are at significantly increased risk compared with 
women without these characteristics. Rates for neural tube defects vary 
within the United States, with lower rates observed on the west coast 
than on the east coast.
    (3) Those who may benefit. Based on a synthesis of information from 
several studies, including those which used multivitamins containing 
folic acid at a daily dose level of 400 mcg (0.4 
mg), the Public Health Service has inferred that folate alone at levels 
of 400 mcg (0.4 mg) per day may reduce the risk of neural tube defects. 
The protective effect found in studies of lower dose folate measured by 
the reduction in neural tube defect incidence, ranges from none to 
substantial; a reasonable estimate of the expected reduction in the 
United States is 50 percent. It is expected that consumption of adequate 
folate will avert some, but not all, neural tube defects. The underlying 
causes of neural tube defects are not known. Thus, it is not known what 
proportion of neural tube defects will be averted by adequate folate 
consumption. From the available evidence, the Public Health Service 
estimates that there is the potential for averting 50 percent of cases 
that now occur (i.e., about 1,250 cases annually). However, until 
further research is done, no firm estimate of this proportion will be 
available.
    (c) Requirements. The label or labeling of food may contain a 
folate/neural tube defect health claim provided that:
    (1) General requirements. The health claim for a food meets all of 
the general requirements of Sec. 101.14 for health claims, except that a 
food may qualify to bear the health claim if it meets the definition of 
the term ``good source.''
    (2) Specific requirements--(i) Nature of the claim--(A) 
Relationship. A health claim that women who are capable of becoming 
pregnant and who consume adequate amounts of folate daily during their 
childbearing years may reduce their risk of having a pregnancy affected 
by spina bifida or other neural tube defects may be made on the label or 
labeling of food provided that:
    (B) Specifying the nutrient. In specifying the nutrient, the claim 
shall use the terms ``folate,'' ``folic acid,'' ``folacin,'' ``folate, a 
B vitamin,'' ``folic acid, a B vitamin,'' or ``folacin, a B vitamin.''
    (C) Specifying the condition. In specifying the health- related 
condition, the claim shall identify the birth defects as ``neural tube 
defects,'' ``birth defects spina bifida or anencephaly,'' ``birth 
defects of the brain or spinal cord anencephaly or spina bifida,'' 
``spina bifida and anencephaly, birth defects of the brain or spinal 
cord,'' ``birth defects of the brain or spinal cord;'' or ``brain or 
spinal cord birth defects.''
    (D) Multifactorial nature. The claim shall not imply that folate 
intake is the only recognized risk factor for neural tube defects.
    (E) Reduction in risk. The claim shall not attribute any specific 
degree of reduction in risk of neural tube defects from maintaining an 
adequate folate intake throughout the childbearing years. The claim 
shall state that some women may reduce their risk of a neural tube 
defect pregnancy by maintaining adequate intakes of folate during their 
childbearing years. Optional statements about population-based estimates 
of risk reduction may be made in accordance with paragraph (c)(3)(vi) of 
this section.
    (F) Safe upper limit of daily intake. Claims on foods that contain 
more than 100 percent of the Daily Value (DV) (400 mcg) when labeled for 
use by adults and children 4 or more years of age, or 800 mcg when 
labeled for use by pregnant or lactating women) shall identify the safe 
upper limit of daily intake with respect to the DV. The safe upper limit 
of daily intake value of 1,000 mcg (1 mg) may be included in 
parentheses.
    (G) The claim. The claim shall not state that a specified amount of 
folate per serving from one source is more effective in reducing the 
risk of neural tube defects than a lower amount per serving from another 
source.
    (H) The claim shall state that folate needs to be consumed as part 
of a healthful diet.

[[Page 133]]

    (ii) Nature of the food--(A) Requirements. The food shall meet or 
exceed the requirements for a ``good source'' of folate as defined in 
Sec. 101.54;
    (B) Dietary supplements. Dietary supplements shall meet the United 
States Pharmacopeia (USP) standards for disintegration and dissolution, 
except that if there are no applicable USP standards, the folate in the 
dietary supplement shall be shown to be bioavailable under the 
conditions of use stated on the product label.
    (iii) Limitation. The claim shall not be made on foods that contain 
more than 100 percent of the RDI for vitamin A as retinol or preformed 
vitamin A or vitamin D per serving or per unit.
    (iv) Nutrition labeling. The nutrition label shall include 
information about the amount of folate in the food. This information 
shall be declared after the declaration for iron if only the levels of 
vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, and iron are provided, or in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9 (c)(8) and (c)(9) if other optional vitamins or minerals 
are declared.
    (3) Optional information--(i) Risk factors. The claim may 
specifically identify risk factors for neural tube defects. Where such 
information is provided, it may consist of statements from 
Sec. 101.79(b)(1) or (b)(2) (e.g., Women at increased risk include those 
with a personal history of a neural tube defect-affected pregnancy, 
those with a close relative (i.e., sibling, niece, nephew) with a neural 
tube defect; those with insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus; those with 
seizure disorders who are being treated with valproic acid or 
carbamazepine) or from other parts of this paragraph (c)(3)(i).
    (ii) Relationship between folate and neural tube defects. The claim 
may include statements from paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section that 
summarize the relationship between folate and neural tube defects and 
the significance of the relationship except for information specifically 
prohibited from the claim.
    (iii) Personal history of a neural tube defect-affected pregnancy. 
The claim may state that women with a history of a neural tube defect 
pregnancy should consult their physicians or health care providers 
before becoming pregnant. If such a statement is provided, the claim 
shall also state that all women should consult a health care provider 
when planning a pregnancy.
    (iv) Daily value. The claim may identify 100 percent of the DV (100% 
DV; 400 mcg) for folate as the target intake goal.
    (v) Prevalence. The claim may provide estimates, expressed on an 
annual basis, of the number of neural tube defect-affected births among 
live births in the United States. Current estimates are provided in 
Sec. 101.79(b)(1), and are approximately 6 of 10,000 live births 
annually (i.e., about 2,500 cases among 4 million live births annually). 
Data provided in Sec. 101.79(b)(1) shall be used, unless more current 
estimates from the U.S. Public Health Service are available, in which 
case the latter may be cited.
    (vi) Reduction in risk. An estimate of the reduction in the number 
of neural tube defect-affected births that might occur in the United 
States if all women consumed adequate folate throughout their 
childbearing years may be included in the claim. Information contained 
in paragraph (b)(3) of this section may be used. If such an estimate 
(i.e., 50 percent) is provided, the estimate shall be accompanied by 
additional information that states that the estimate is population-based 
and that it does not reflect risk reduction that may be experienced by 
individual women.
    (vii) Diets adequate in folate. The claim may identify diets 
adequate in folate by using phrases such as ``Sources of folate include 
fruits, vegetables, whole grain products, fortified cereals, and dietary 
supplements.'' or ``Adequate amounts of folate can be obtained from 
diets rich in fruits, dark green leafy vegetables, legumes, whole grain 
products, fortified cereals, or dietary supplements.'' or ``Adequate 
amounts of folate can be obtained from diets rich in fruits, including 
citrus fruits and juices, vegetables, including dark green leafy 
vegetables, legumes, whole grain products, including breads, rice, and 
pasta, fortified cereals, or a dietary supplement.''
    (d) Model health claims. The following are examples of model health 
claims that may be used in food labeling to

[[Page 134]]

describe the relationship between folate and neural tube defects:
    (1) Examples 1 and 2. Model health claims appropriate for foods 
containing 100 percent or less of the DV for folate per serving or per 
unit (general population). The examples contain only the required 
elements:
    (i) Healthful diets with adequate folate may reduce a woman's risk 
of having a child with a brain or spinal cord birth defect.
    (ii) Adequate folate in healthful diets may reduce a woman's risk of 
having a child with a brain or spinal cord birth defect.
    (2) Example 3. Model health claim appropriate for foods containing 
100 percent or less of the DV for folate per serving or per unit. The 
example contains all required elements plus optional information: Women 
who consume healthful diets with adequate folate throughout their 
childbearing years may reduce their risk of having a child with a birth 
defect of the brain or spinal cord. Sources of folate include fruits, 
vegetables, whole grain products, fortified cereals, and dietary 
supplements.
    (3) Example 4. Model health claim appropriate for foods intended for 
use by the general population and containing more than 100 percent of 
the DV of folate per serving or per unit: Women who consume healthful 
diets with adequate folate may reduce their risk of having a child with 
birth defects of the brain or spinal cord. Folate intake should not 
exceed 250% of the DV (1,000 mcg).

[61 FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996]

    Effective Date Note: At 61 FR 8779, Mar. 5, 1996, Sec. 101.79 was 
revised, effective April 19, 1996. For the convenience of the reader, 
the superseded text is set forth below.
Sec. 101.79  Health claims: folate and neural tube defects.
    (a) Relationship between folate and neural tube defects--(1) 
Definition. Neural tube defects are serious birth defects of the brain 
or spinal cord that can result in infant mortality or serious 
disability. The birth defects anencephaly and spina bifida are the most 
common forms of neural tube defects and account for about 90 percent of 
these defects. These defects result from failure of closure of the 
covering of the brain or spinal cord during early embryonic development. 
Because the neural tube forms and closes during early pregnancy, the 
defect may occur before a woman realizes that she is pregnant.
    (2) Relationship. The available data show that diets adequate in 
folate may reduce the risk of neural tube defects. The strongest 
evidence for this relationship comes from an intervention study by the 
Medical Research Council of the United Kingdom that showed that women at 
risk of recurrence of a neural tube defect pregnancy who consumed a 
supplement containing 4 milligrams (mg) (4,000 micrograms (g)) 
folic acid daily had a reduced risk of having a child with a neural tube 
defect. (Products that contain this level of folic acid are drugs.) In 
addition, based on its review of a Hungarian intervention trial that 
used a multivitamin and multimineral preparation containing 800 
g (0.8 mg) of folic acid, and its review of the observational 
studies that reported use of multivitamins containing 0 to 1,000 
g of folic acid, the Food and Drug Administration concluded 
that most of these studies had results consistent with the conclusion 
that folate, at levels attainable in usual diets, may reduce the risk of 
neural tube defects.
    (b) Significance of folate--(1) Public health concern. Neural tube 
defects occur in approximately 0.6 of 1,000 live births in the United 
States (i.e., about 2,500 cases among 4 million live births annually). 
Neural tube defects are believed to be caused by many factors. The 
single greatest risk factor for a neural tube defect-affected pregnancy 
is a personal or family history of a pregnancy affected with a such a 
defect. However, about 90 percent of infants with a neural tube defect 
are born to women who do not have a family history of these defects. The 
available evidence shows that diets adequate in folate may reduce the 
risk of neural tube defects but not of other birth defects.
    (2) Populations at risk. Prevalence rates for neural tube defects 
have been reported to vary with a wide range of factors, including 
genetics, geography, socioeconomic status, maternal birth cohort, month 
of conception, race, nutrition, and maternal health, including maternal 
age and reproductive history. Women with a close relative (i.e., 
sibling, niece, nephew) with a neural tube defect, those with insulin-
dependent diabetes mellitus, and women with seizure disorders who are 
being treated with valproic acid or carbamazepine are at significantly 
increased risk compared with women without these characteristics. Rates 
for neural tube defects vary within the United States, with lower rates 
observed on the west coast than on the east coast.
    (3) Those who may benefit. Based on a synthesis of the results of 
several observational studies, the Public Health Service has estimated 
that about 50 percent of neural tube defect-affected pregnancies in the 
United

[[Page 135]]

States (e.g., about 1,250) may be averted annually if all women consume 
adequate amounts of folate daily (i.e., 0.4 mg) throughout their 
childbearing years.
    (c) Requirements. The label or labeling of food in conventional food 
form or dietary supplements may contain a folate/neural tube defect 
health claim provided that:
    (1) General requirements. The health claim for a food or supplement 
meets all of the general requirements of Sec. 101.14 for health claims, 
except that a food or dietary supplement may qualify to bear the health 
claim if it meets the definition of the term ``good source.''
    (2) Specific requirements--(i) Nature of the claim--(A) 
Relationship. A health claim that women who are capable of becoming 
pregnant and who consume adequate amounts of folate daily during their 
childbearing years may reduce their risk of having a pregnancy affected 
by spina bifida or other neural tube defects may be made on the label or 
labeling of foods in conventional food form or of dietary supplements 
provided that:
    (B) Specifying the nutrient. In specifying the nutrient, the claim 
shall use the terms ``folate,'' ``folic acid,'' ``folacin,'' ``folate, a 
B vitamin,'' ``folic acid, a B vitamin,'' or ``folacin, a B vitamin.''
    (C) Specifying the condition. In specifying the health-related 
condition, the claim shall identify the birth defects as ``neural tube 
defects,'' ``birth defects, spina bifida, or anencephaly,'' ``birth 
defects of the brain or spinal cord anencephaly or spina bifida,'' or 
``spina bifida or anencephaly, birth defects of the brain or spinal 
cord;''
    (D) Multifactorial nature. The claim shall state that neural tube 
defects have many causes and shall not imply that folate intake is the 
only recognized risk factor for neural tube defects.
    (E) Prevalence. In specifying the prevalence of neural tube defects 
among women in the general population, the claim shall state that such 
birth defects ``which, while not widespread, are extremely significant'' 
or ``* * * birth defects * * * that, while not widespread, are extremely 
significant.''
    (F) Reduction in risk. The claim shall not attribute any specific 
degree of reduction in risk of neural tube defects, including mention of 
the Public Health Service estimate that 50 percent of neural tube 
defects may be averted annually, to maintaining an adequate folate 
intake throughout the childbearing years. The claim shall state that 
some women may reduce their risk of a neural tube defect pregnancy by 
maintaining adequate intakes of folic acid during their childbearing 
years.
    (G) Safe upper limit of daily intake. Claims on fortified foods in 
conventional form and on dietary supplements that contain more than 25 
percent of the RDI for folate (100 g per serving or per unit) 
shall state that 1 mg folate per day is the safe upper limit of intake 
(e.g., ``Folate consumption should be limited to 1,000 g per 
day from all sources.'')
    (H) The claim. The claim shall not state that a specified amount of 
folate (e.g., 400 g in a dietary supplement) is more effective 
in reducing the risk of neural tube defects than a lower amount (e.g., 
100 g in a breakfast cereal or from diets rich in fruits and 
vegetables).
    (ii) Nature of the food--(A) Requirements. The food or supplement 
shall meet or exceed the requirements for a good source of folate as 
defined in Sec. 101.54;
    (B) Diets adequate in folate. The claim shall identify diets 
adequate in folate by using phrases such as ``* * * diets that include 2 
to 4 servings per day of fruits) including citrus fruits and juices), 3 
to 5 servings of vegetables (including dark green leafy vegetables and 
legumes), 6 to 11 servings of enriched grain products (such as breads, 
rice, and pasta) and fortified cereals. Such diets provide many 
essential minerals and vitamins, including folate. Women who do not eat 
well-balanced diets or who may be concerned about their diets may choose 
to obtain folate from dietary supplements.''; or ``Adequate amounts of 
folate, a B vitamin, can be obtained from diets rich in fruits, 
including citrus fruits and juices, vegetables, including dark green 
leafy vegetables and legumes, enriched grain products, including breads, 
rice, and pasta, fortified cereals, or a dietary supplement.''; or 
``Adequate amounts of folate, a B vitamin, can be obtained from diets 
rich in fruits, dark green leafy vegetables and legumes, enriched grain 
products, fortified cereals, or from dietary supplements.''
    (C) Dietary supplements. Dietary supplements shall meet the United 
States Pharmacopeia (U.S.P.) standards for disintegration and 
dissolution, except that if there are no applicable U.S.P. standards, 
the folate in the dietary supplement shall be shown to be bioavailable 
under the conditions of use stated on the product label.
    (iii) Limitation. The claim shall not be made on foods in 
conventional food form or dietary supplements that contain more than 100 
percent of the RDI for vitamin A as retinol or preformed vitamin A or 
vitamin D.
    (iv) Nutrition labeling. The nutrition label shall include 
information about the amount of folate in the food. This information 
shall be declared after the declaration for iron if only the levels of 
vitamin A, vitamin C, calcium, and iron are provided, or in accordance 
with Sec. 101.9(c)(8) and (c)(9) if other optional vitamins or minerals 
are declared.
    (3) Optional information--(i) Risk factors. The claim may 
specifically identify risk factors for neural tube defects;
    (ii) Relationship between folate and neural tube defects. The claim 
may include statements from paragraphs (a) and (b) of this

[[Page 136]]

section that summarize the relationship between folate and neural tube 
defects and the significance of the relationship except for information 
specifically prohibited from the claim.
    (iii) Personal history of a neural tube defect-affected pregnancy. 
The claim may state that women with a history of a neural tube defect 
pregnancy should consult their physicians or health care providers 
before becoming pregnant.
    (iv) Daily value. The claim may identify the daily value level of 
400 g of folate per day as the target intake goal.
    (d) Model health claims. The following are examples of model health 
claims that may be used in food labeling to describe the relationship 
between folate and neural tube defects:
    (1) Example 1. Women who consume adequate amounts of folate, a B 
vitamin, daily throughout their childbearing years may reduce their risk 
of having a child with a neural tube birth defect. Such birth defects, 
while not widespread, are very serious. They can have many causes. 
Adequate amounts of folate can be obtained from diets rich in fruits, 
dark green leafy vegetables and legumes, enriched grain products, 
fortified cereals, or a supplement. Folate consumption should be limited 
to 1,000 g per day from all sources.
    (2) Example 2. Women who consume adequate amounts of folate daily 
throughout their childbearing years may reduce their risk of having a 
child with a birth defect of the brain and spinal cord. Such birth 
defects, while not widespread, are very serious. They can have many 
causes. Adequate amounts of folate, a B vitamin, can be obtained from 
diets rich in fruits, dark green leafy vegetables and legumes, enriched 
grain products, fortified cereals, or a supplement. Women who have had a 
child with a spinal cord birth defect should consult a physician before 
becoming pregnant. Folate consumption should be limited to 1,000 
g per day from all sources.
    (3) Example 3. Women who take steps to ensure that their folate 
intake is adequate throughout their childbearing years may reduce their 
risk of having a child with a neural tube defect. Such birth defects, 
while not widespread, are very serious. They can have many causes. 
Adequate amounts of folate, a B vitamin, can be obtained from diets rich 
in citrus fruits and juices, dark green leafy vegetables and legumes, 
enriched grain products such as breads, rice, and pasta, fortified 
cereal, or a supplement. Folate consumption should be limited to 1,000 
g per day from all sources.
    (4) Example 4. Women who take steps to ensure that their folate 
intake is at least 400 g daily throughout their childbearing 
years may reduce their risk of having a child with spina bifida or 
anencephaly, birth defects of the brain or spinal cord that, while not 
widespread, are very serious. These birth defects can have many causes. 
Adequate amounts of folate, a B vitamin, can be obtained from diets rich 
in fruits, including citrus fruits and juices, vegetables, including 
dark green leafy vegetables and legumes, enriched grain products, 
including breads, rice, and pasta, fortified cereals, or from a 
supplement. Women who have had a pregnancy affected with a neural tube 
defect should consult a physician before becoming pregnant. Folate 
consumption should be limited to 1,000 g per day from all 
sources.

    (5) Example 5. Some women who consume the Daily Value of folate (400 
g) throughout their childbearing years may reduce their risk of 
having a child affected with spina bifida or anencephaly, birth defects 
of the brain or spinal cord that, while not widespread, are very 
serious. These birth defects can have many causes. Women of childbearing 
age should choose well-balanced diets that include 2 to 4 servings per 
day of fruits (including citrus fruits and juices), 3 to 5 servings of 
vegetables (including dark green leafy vegetables and legumes), 6 to 11 
servings of enriched grain products (such as breads, rice, and pasta) or 
fortified cereals throughout their childbearing years. Such diets 
provide many essential minerals and vitamins, including folate. Women 
who may be concerned about their diets may choose to obtain folate from 
a supplement. Folate consumption should be limited to 1,000 g 
per day from all sources.

    (e) Effective date. For fortified foods, this regulation is 
effective on the date the food additive regulation on the use of folic 
acid that was proposed on October 14, 1993, becomes effective.

[59 FR 434, Jan. 4, 1994]



Subpart F--Specific Requirements for Descriptive Claims that are Neither 
                Nutrient Content Claims nor Health Claims



Sec. 101.95  ``Fresh,'' ``freshly frozen,'' ``fresh frozen,'' ``frozen fresh.''

    The terms defined in this section may be used on the label or in 
labeling of a food in conformity with the provisions of this section. 
The requirements of the section pertain to any use of the subject terms 
as described in paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section that expressly or 
implicitly refers to the food on labels or labeling, including use in a 
brand name and use as a sensory modifier. However, the use of the term 
``fresh'' on labels or labeling is not subject to the requirements of

[[Page 137]]

paragraph (a) of this section if the term does not suggest or imply that 
a food is unprocessed or unpreserved. For example, the term ``fresh'' 
used to describe pasteurized whole milk is not subject to paragraph (a) 
of this section because the term does not imply that the food is 
unprocessed (consumers commonly understand that milk is nearly always 
pasteurized). However, the term ``fresh'' to describe pasta sauce that 
has been pasteurized or that contains pasteurized ingredients would be 
subject to paragraph (a) of this section because the term implies that 
the food is not processed or preserved. Uses of fresh not subject to 
this regulation will be governed by the provisions of 403(a) of the 
Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act).
    (a) The term ``fresh,'' when used on the label or in labeling of a 
food in a manner that suggests or implies that the food is unprocessed, 
means that the food is in its raw state and has not been frozen or 
subjected to any form of thermal processing or any other form of 
preservation, except as provided in paragraph (c) of this section.
    (b) The terms ``fresh frozen'' and ``frozen fresh,'' when used on 
the label or in labeling of a food, mean that the food was quickly 
frozen while still fresh (i.e., the food had been recently harvested 
when frozen). Blanching of the food before freezing will not preclude 
use of the term ``fresh frozen'' to describe the food. ``Quickly 
frozen'' means frozen by a freezing system such as blast-freezing (sub-
zero Fahrenheit temperature with fast moving air directed at the food) 
that ensures the food is frozen, even to the center of the food, quickly 
and that virtually no deterioration has taken place.
    (c) Provisions and restrictions--(1) The following do not preclude 
the food from use of the term ``fresh:''
    (i) The addition of approved waxes or coatings;
    (ii) The post-harvest use of approved pesticides;
    (iii) The application of a mild chlorine wash or mild acid wash on 
produce; or
    (iv) The treatment of raw foods with ionizing radiation not to 
exceed the maximum dose of 1 kiloGray in accordance with Sec. 179.26 of 
this chapter.
    (2) A food meeting the definition in paragraph (a) of this section 
that is refrigerated is not precluded from use of ``fresh'' as provided 
by this section.

[58 FR 2426, Jan. 6, 1993]



          Subpart G--Exemptions From Food Labeling Requirements



Sec. 101.100   Food; exemptions from labeling.

    (a) The following foods are exempt from compliance with the 
requirements of section 403(i)(2) of the act (requiring a declaration on 
the label of the common or usual name of each ingredient when the food 
is fabricated from two or more ingredients).
    (1) An assortment of different items of food, when variations in the 
items that make up different packages packed from such assortment 
normally occur in good packing practice and when such variations result 
in variations in the ingredients in different packages, with respect to 
any ingredient that is not common to all packages. Such exemption, 
however, shall be on the condition that the label shall bear, in 
conjunction with the names of such ingredients as are common to all 
packages, a statement (in terms that are as informative as practicable 
and that are not misleading) indicating by name other ingredients which 
may be present.
    (2) A food having been received in bulk containers at a retail 
establishment, if displayed to the purchaser with either:
    (i) The labeling of the bulk container plainly in view, provided 
ingredient information appears prominently and conspicuously in 
lettering of not less than one-fourth of an inch in height; or
    (ii) A counter card, sign, or other appropriate device bearing 
prominently and conspicuously, but in no case with lettering of less 
than one-fourth of an inch in height, the information required to be 
stated on the label pursuant to section 403(i)(2) of the Federal Food, 
Drug, and Cosmetic Act (the act).
    (3) Incidental additives that are present in a food at insignificant 
levels and do not have any technical or functional effect in that food. 
For the

[[Page 138]]

purposes of this paragraph (a)(3), incidental additives are:
    (i) Substances that have no technical or functional effect but are 
present in a food by reason of having been incorporated into the food as 
an ingredient of another food, in which the substance did have a 
functional or technical effect.
    (ii) Processing aids, which are as follows:
    (a) Substances that are added to a food during the processing of 
such food but are removed in some manner from the food before it is 
packaged in its finished form.
    (b) Substances that are added to a food during processing, are 
converted into constituents normally present in the food, and do not 
significantly increase the amount of the constitutents naturally found 
in the food.
    (c) Substances that are added to a food for their technical or 
functional effect in the processing but are present in the finished food 
at insignificant levels and do not have any technical or functional 
effect in that food.
    (iii) Substances migrating to food from equipment or packaging or 
otherwise affecting food that are not food additives as defined in 
section 201(s) of the act; or if they are food additives as so defined, 
they are used in conformity with regulations established pursuant to 
section 409 of the act.
    (4) For the purposes of paragraph (a)(3) of this section, any 
sulfiting agent (sulfur dioxide, sodium sulfite, sodium bisulfite, 
potasssium bisulfite, sodium metabisulfite, and potassium metabisulfite) 
that has been added to any food or to any ingredient in any food and 
that has no technical effect in that food will be considered to be 
present in an insignificant amount only if no detectable amount of the 
agent is present in the finished food. A detectable amount of sulfiting 
agent is 10 parts per million or more of the sulfite in the finished 
food. Compliance with this paragraph will be determined using sections 
20.123-20.125, ``Total Sulfurous Acid,'' in ``Official Methods of 
Analysis of the Association of Official Analytical Chemists,'' 14th Ed. 
(1984), which is incorporated by reference and the refinements of the 
``Total Sulfurous Acid'' procedure in the ``Monier-Williams Procedure 
(with Modifications) for Sulfites in Foods,'' which is Appendix A to 
Part 101. A copy of sections 20.123-20-125 of the Official Methods of 
Analysis of the Association of Official Analytical Chemists'' is 
available from the Association of Official Analytical Chemists, P.O. Box 
540, Benjamin Franklin Station, Washington, DC 20044, or available for 
inspection at the Office of the Federal Register, 800 North Capitol 
Street, NW., suite 700, Washington, DC.
    (b) A food repackaged in a retail establishment is exempt from the 
following provisions of the act if the conditions specified are met.
    (1) Section 403(e)(1) of the act (requiring a statement on the label 
of the name and place of business of the manufacturer, packer, or 
distributor).
    (2) Section 403(g)(2) of the act (requiring the label of a food 
which purports to be or is represented as one for which a definition and 
standard of identity has been prescribed to bear the name of the food 
specified in the definition and standard and, insofar as may be required 
by the regulation establishing the standard the common names of the 
optional ingredients present in the food), if the food is displayed to 
the purchaser with its interstate labeling clearly in view, or with a 
counter card, sign, or other appropriate device bearing prominently and 
conspicuously the information required by these provisions.
    (3) Section 403(i)(1) of the act (requiring the label to bear the 
common or usual name of the food), if the food is displayed to the 
purchaser with its interstate labeling clearly in view, or with a 
counter card, sign, or other appropriate device bearing prominently and 
conspicuously the common or usual name of the food, or if the common or 
usual name of the food is clearly revealed by its appearance.
    (c) An open container (a container of rigid or semirigid 
construction, which is not closed by lid, wrapper, or otherwise other 
than by an uncolored transparent wrapper which does not obscure the 
contents) of a fresh fruit or fresh vegetable, the quantity of contents 
of which is not more than 1 dry quart, shall be exempt from the labeling 
requirements of sections 403(e), (g)(2)

[[Page 139]]

(with respect to the name of the food specified in the definition and 
standard), and (i)(1) of the act; but such exemption shall be on the 
condition that if two or more such containers are enclosed in a crate or 
other shipping package, such crate or package shall bear labeling 
showing the number of such containers enclosed therein and the quantity 
of the contents of each.
    (d) Except as provided by paragraphs (e) and (f) of this section, a 
shipment or other delivery of a food which is, in accordance with the 
practice of the trade, to be processed, labeled, or repacked in 
substantial quantity at an establishment other than that where 
originally processed or packed, shall be exempt, during the time of 
introduction into and movement in interstate commerce and the time of 
holding in such establishment, from compliance with the labeling 
requirements of section 403 (c), (e), (g), (h), (i), (k), and (q) of the 
act if:
    (1) The person who introduced such shipment or delivery into 
interstate commerce is the operator of the establishment where such food 
is to be processed, labeled, or repacked; or
    (2) In case such person is not such operator, such shipment or 
delivery is made to such establishment under a written agreement, signed 
by and containing the post office addresses of such person and such 
operator, and containing such specifications for the processing, 
labeling, or repacking, as the case may be, of such food in such 
establishment as will ensure, if such specifications are followed, that 
such food will not be adulterated or misbranded within the meaning of 
the act upon completion of such processing, labeling, or repacking. Such 
person and such operator shall each keep a copy of such agreement until 
2 years after the final shipment or delivery of such food from such 
establishment, and shall make such copies available for inspection at 
any reasonable hour to any officer or employee of the Department who 
requests them.
    (3) The article is an egg product subject to a standard of identity 
promulgated in part 160 of this chapter, is to be shipped under the 
conditions specified in paragraph (d) (1) or (2) of this section and for 
the purpose of pasteurization or other treatment as required in such 
standard, and each container of such egg product bears a conspicuous tag 
or label reading ``Caution--This egg product has not been pasteurized or 
otherwise treated to destroy viable Salmonella microorganisms''. In 
addition to safe and suitable bactericidal processes designed 
specifically for Salmonella destruction in egg products, the term 
``other treatment'' in the first sentence of this paragraph shall 
include use in acidic dressings in the processing of which the pH is not 
above 4.1 and the acidity of the aqueous phase, expressed as acetic 
acid, is not less than 1.4 percent, subject also to the conditions that:
    (i) The agreement required in paragraph (d) (2) of this section 
shall also state that the operator agrees to utilize such unpasteurized 
egg products in the processing of acidic dressings according to the 
specifications for pH and acidity set forth in this paragraph, agrees 
not to deliver the acidic dressing to a user until at least 72 hours 
after such egg product is incorporated in such acidic dressing, and 
agrees to maintain for inspection adequate records covering such 
processing for 2 years after such processing.
    (ii) In addition to the caution statement referred to above, the 
container of such egg product shall also bear the statement 
``Unpasteurized ------ for use in acidic dressings only'', the blank 
being filled in with the applicable name of the eggs or egg product.
    (e) Conditions affecting expiration of exemptions: (1) An exemption 
of a shipment or other delivery of a food under paragraph (d) (1) or (3) 
of this section shall, at the beginning of the act of removing such 
shipment or delivery, or any part thereof, from such establishment 
become void ab initio if the food comprising such shipment, delivery, or 
part is adulterated or misbranded within the meaning of the act when so 
removed.
    (2) An exemption of a shipment or other delivery of a food under 
paragraph (d) (2) or (3) of this section shall become void ab initio 
with respect to the person who introduced such shipment or delivery into 
interstate commerce upon refusal by such person to make available for 
inspection a copy of

[[Page 140]]

the agreement, as required by paragraph (d) (2) or (3) of this section.
    (3) An exemption of a shipment or other delivery of a food under 
paragraph (d) (2) or (3) of this section shall expire:
    (i) At the beginning of the act of removing such shipment or 
delivery, or any part thereof, from such establishment if the food 
constituting such shipment, delivery, or part is adulterated or 
misbranded within the meaning of the act when so removed; or
    (ii) Upon refusal by the operator of the establishment where such 
food is to be processed, labeled, or repacked, to make available for 
inspection a copy of the agreement, as required by such paragraph.
    (f) The word ``processed'' as used in this paragraph shall include 
the holding of cheese in a suitable warehouse at a temperature of not 
less than 35 deg. F for the purpose of aging or curing to bring the 
cheese into compliance with requirements of an applicable definition and 
standard of identity. The exemptions provided for in paragraph (d) of 
this section shall apply to cheese which is, in accordance with the 
practice of the trade, shipped to a warehouse for aging or curing, on 
condition that the cheese is identified in the manner set forth in one 
of the applicable following paragraphs, and in such case the provisions 
of paragraph (e) of this section shall also apply:
    (1) In the case of varieties of cheese for which definitions and 
standards of identity require a period of aging whether or not they are 
made from pasteurized milk, each such cheese shall bear on the cheese a 
legible mark showing the date at which the preliminary manufacturing 
process has been completed and at which date curing commences, and to 
each cheese, on its wrapper or immediate container, shall be affixed a 
removable tag bearing the statement ``Uncured ------ cheese for 
completion of curing and proper labeling'', the blank being filled in 
with the applicable name of the variety of cheese. In the case of swiss 
cheese, the date at which the preliminary manufacturing process had been 
completed and at which date curing commences is the date on which the 
shaped curd is removed from immersion in saturated salt solution as 
provided in the definition and standard of identity for swiss cheese, 
and such cheese shall bear a removable tag reading, ``To be cured and 
labeled as `swiss cheese,' but if eyes do not form, to be labeled as 
`swiss cheese for manufacturing' ''.
    (2) In the case of varieties of cheeses which when made from 
unpasteurized milk are required to be aged for not less than 60 days, 
each such cheese shall bear a legible mark on the cheese showing the 
date at which the preliminary manufacturing process has been completed 
and at which date curing commences, and to each such cheese or its 
wrapper or immediate container shall be affixed a removable tag reading, 
``------ cheese made from unpasteurized milk. For completion of curing 
and proper labeling'', the blank being filled in with the applicable 
name of the variety of cheese.
    (3) In the case of cheddar cheese, washed curd cheese, colby cheese, 
granular cheese, and brick cheese made from unpasteurized milk, each 
such cheese shall bear a legible mark on the cheese showing the date at 
which the preliminary manufacturing process has been completed and at 
which date curing commences, and to each such cheese or its wrapper or 
immediate container shall be affixed a removable tag reading ``------ 
cheese made from unpasteurized milk. For completion of curing and proper 
labeling, or for labeling as ------ cheese for manufacturing'', the 
blank being filled in with the applicable name of the variety of cheese.
    (g) The label declaration of a harmless marker used to identify a 
particular manufacturer's product may result in unfair competition 
through revealing a trade secret. Exemption from the label declaration 
of such a marker is granted, therefore, provided that the following 
conditions are met:
    (1) The person desiring to use the marker without label declaration 
of its presence has submitted to the Commissioner of Food and Drugs full 
information concerning the proposed usage and the reasons why he 
believes label declaration of the marker should be subject to this 
exemption; and
    (2) The person requesting the exemption has received from the

[[Page 141]]

Commissioner of Food and Drugs a finding that the marker is harmless and 
that the exemption has been granted.
    (h) Wrapped fish fillets of nonuniform weight intended to be 
unpacked and marked with the correct weight at or before the point of 
retail sale in an establishment other than that where originally packed 
shall be exempt from the requirement of section 403(e)(2) of the act 
during introduction and movement in interstate commerce and while held 
for sale prior to weighing and marking:
    (1) Provided, That (i) The outside container bears a label 
declaration of the total net weight; and
    (ii) The individual packages bear a conspicuous statement ``To be 
weighed at or before time of sale'' and a correct statement setting 
forth the weight of the wrapper;
    (2) Provided further, That it is the practice of the retail 
establishment to weigh and mark the individual packages with a correct 
net-weight statement prior to or at the point of retail sale. A 
statement of the weight of the wrapper shall be set forth so as to be 
readily read and understood, using such term as ``wrapper tare--ounce'', 
the blank being filled in with the correct average weight of the wrapper 
used.
    (3) The act of delivering the wrapped fish fillets during the retail 
sale without the correct net-weight statement shall be deemed an act 
which results in the product's being misbranded while held for sale. 
Nothing in this paragraph shall be construed as requiring net-weight 
statements for wrapped fish fillets delivered into institutional trade 
provided the outside container bears the required information.
    (i) Wrapped clusters (consumer units) of bananas of nonuniform 
weight intended to be unpacked from a master carton or container and 
weighed at or before the point of retail sale in an establishment other 
than that where originally packed shall be exempt from the requirements 
of section 403(e)(2) of the act during introduction and movement in 
interstate commerce and while held for sale prior to weighing:
    (1) Provided, That (i) The master carton or container bears a label 
declaration of the total net weight; and
    (ii) The individual packages bear a conspicuous statement ``To be 
weighed at or before the time of sale'' and a correct statement setting 
forth the weight of the wrapper; using such term as ``wrapper tare ----
-- ounce'', the blank being filled in with the correct average weight of 
the wrapper used;
    (2) Provided further, That it is the practice of the retail 
establishment to weigh the individual packages either prior to or at the 
time of retail sale.
    (3) The act of delivering the wrapped clusters (consumer units) 
during the retail sale without an accurate net weight statement or 
alternatively without weighing at the time of sale shall be deemed an 
act which results in the product's being misbranded while held for sale. 
Nothing in this paragraph shall be construed as requiring net-weight 
statements for clusters (consumer units) delivered into institutional 
trade, provided that the master container or carton bears the required 
information.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 51 FR 25017, July 9, 1986; 58 
FR 2188, 2876, Jan. 6, 1993]



Sec. 101.103   Petitions requesting exemptions from or special requirements for label declaration of ingredients.

    The Commissioner of Food and Drugs, either on his own initiative or 
on behalf of any interested person who has submitted a petition pursuant 
to part 10 of this chapter may issue a proposal to amend Sec. 101.4 to 
specify the manner in which an ingredient(s) shall be declared, i.e., by 
specific or class name, or Sec. 101.100 to exempt an ingredient(s) from 
the requirements for label declaration.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 42 FR 15673, Mar. 22, 1977]



Sec. 101.105   Declaration of net quantity of contents when exempt.

    (a) The principal display panel of a food in package form shall bear 
a declaration of the net quantity of contents. This shall be expressed 
in the terms of weight, measure, numerical count, or a combination of 
numerical count and weight or measure. The

[[Page 142]]

statement shall be in terms of fluid measure if the food is liquid, or 
in terms of weight if the food is solid, semisolid, or viscous, or a 
mixture of solid and liquid; except that such statement may be in terms 
of dry measure if the food is a fresh fruit, fresh vegetable, or other 
dry commodity that is customarily sold by dry measure. If there is a 
firmly established general consumer usage and trade custom of declaring 
the contents of a liquid by weight, or a solid, semisolid, or viscous 
product by fluid measure, it may be used. Whenever the Commissioner 
determines that an existing practice of declaring net quantity of 
contents by weight, measure, numerical count, or a combination in the 
case of a specific packaged food does not facilitate value comparisons 
by consumers and offers opportunity for consumer confusion, he will by 
regulation designate the appropriate term or terms to be used for such 
commodity.
    (b)(1) Statements of weight shall be in terms of avoirdupois pound 
and ounce.
    (2) Statements of fluid measure shall be in terms of the U.S. gallon 
of 231 cubic inches and quart, pint, and fluid ounce subdivisions 
thereof, and shall:
    (i) In the case of frozen food that is sold and consumed in a frozen 
state, express the volume at the frozen temperature.
    (ii) In the case of refrigerated food that is sold in the 
refrigerated state, express the volume at 40 deg. F (4 deg. C).
    (iii) In the case of other foods, express the volume at 68 deg. F 
(20 deg. C).
    (3) Statements of dry measure shall be in terms of the U.S. bushel 
of 2,150.42 cubic inches and peck, dry quart, and dry pint subdivisions 
thereof.
    (c) When the declaration of quantity of contents by numerical count 
does not give adequate information as to the quantity of food in the 
package, it shall be combined with such statement of weight, measure, or 
size of the individual units of the foods as will provide such 
information.
    (d) The declaration may contain common or decimal fractions. A 
common fraction shall be in terms of halves, quarters, eighths, 
sixteenths, or thirty-seconds; except that if there exists a firmly 
established general consumer usage and trade custom of employing 
different common fractions in the net quantity declaration of a 
particular commodity, they may be employed. A common fraction shall be 
reduced to its lowest terms; a decimal fraction shall not be carried out 
to more than two places. A statement that includes small fractions of an 
ounce shall be deemed to permit smaller variations than one which does 
not include such fractions.
    (e) The declaration shall be located on the principal display panel 
of the label, and with respect to packages bearing alternate principal 
panels it shall be duplicated on each principal display panel.
    (f) The declaration shall appear as a distinct item on the principal 
display panel, shall be separated (by at least a space equal to the 
height of the lettering used in the declaration) from other printed 
label information appearing above or below the declaration and (by at 
least a space equal to twice the width of the letter ``N'' of the style 
of type used in the quantity of contents statement) from other printed 
label information appearing to the left or right of the declaration. It 
shall not include any term qualifying a unit of weight, measure, or 
count (such as ``jumbo quart'' and ``full gallon'') that tends to 
exaggerate the amount of the food in the container. It shall be placed 
on the principal display panel within the bottom 30 percent of the area 
of the label panel in lines generally parallel to the base on which the 
package rests as it is designed to be displayed: Provided, That on 
packages having a principal display panel of 5 square inches or less, 
the requirement for placement within the bottom 30 percent of the area 
of the label panel shall not apply when the declaration of net quantity 
of contents meets the other requirements of this part.
    (g) The declaration shall accurately reveal the quantity of food in 
the package exclusive of wrappers and other material packed therewith: 
Provided, That in the case of foods packed in containers designed to 
deliver the food under pressure, the declaration shall state the net 
quantity of the contents

[[Page 143]]

that will be expelled when the instructions for use as shown on the 
container are followed. The propellant is included in the net quantity 
declaration.
    (h) The declaration shall appear in conspicuous and easily legible 
boldface print or type in distinct contrast (by typography, layout, 
color, embossing, or molding) to other matter on the package; except 
that a declaration of net quantity blown, embossed, or molded on a glass 
or plastic surface is permissible when all label information is so 
formed on the surface. Requirements of conspicuousness and legibility 
shall include the specifications that:
    (1) The ratio of height to width (of the letter) shall not exceed a 
differential of 3 units to 1 unit (no more than 3 times as high as it is 
wide).
    (2) Letter heights pertain to upper case or capital letters. When 
upper and lower case or all lower case letters are used, it is the lower 
case letter ``o'' or its equivalent that shall meet the minimum 
standards.
    (3) When fractions are used, each component numeral shall meet one-
half the minimum height standards.
    (i) The declaration shall be in letters and numerals in a type size 
established in relationship to the area of the principal display panel 
of the package and shall be uniform for all packages of substantially 
the same size by complying with the following type specifications:
    (1) Not less than one-sixteenth inch in height on packages the 
principal display panel of which has an area of 5 square inches or less.
    (2) Not less than one-eighth inch in height on packages the 
principal display panel of which has an area of more than 5 but not more 
than 25 square inches.
    (3) Not less than three-sixteenths inch in height on packages the 
principal display panel of which has an area of more than 25 but not 
more than 100 square inches.
    (4) Not less than one-fourth inch in height on packages the 
principal display panel of which has an area of more than 100 square 
inches, except not less than \1/2\ inch in height if the area is more 
than 400 square inches.

Where the declaration is blown, embossed, or molded on a glass or 
plastic surface rather than by printing, typing, or coloring, the 
lettering sizes specified in paragraphs (h)(1) through (4) of this 
section shall be increased by one-sixteenth of an inch.
    (j) On packages containing less than 4 pounds or 1 gallon and 
labeled in terms of weight or fluid measure:
    (1) The declaration shall be expressed both in ounces, with 
identification by weight or by liquid measure and, if applicable (1 
pound or 1 pint or more) followed in parentheses by a declaration in 
pounds for weight units, with any remainder in terms of ounces or common 
or decimal fractions of the pound (see examples set forth in paragraphs 
(m) (1) and (2) of this section), or in the case of liquid measure, in 
the largest whole units (quarts, quarts and pints, or pints, as 
appropriate) with any remainder in terms of fluid ounces or common or 
decimal fractions of the pint or quart (see examples in paragraphs (m) 
(3) and (4) of this section).
    (2) If the net quantity of contents declaration appears on a random 
package, that is a package which is one of a lot, shipment, or delivery 
of packages of the same consumer commodity with varying weights and with 
no fixed weight pattern, it may, when the net weight exceeds 1 pound, be 
expressed in terms of pounds and decimal fractions of the pound carried 
out to not more than two decimal places. When the net weight does not 
exceed 1 pound, the declaration on the random package may be in decimal 
fractions of the pound in lieu of ounces (see example in paragraph 
(m)(5) of this section).
    (3) The declaration may appear in more than one line. The term ``net 
weight'' shall be used when stating the net quantity of contents in 
terms of weight. Use of the terms ``net'' or ``net contents'' in terms 
of fluid measure or numerical count is optional. It is sufficient to 
distinguish avoirdupois ounce from fluid ounce through association of 
terms; for example, ``Net wt. 6 oz'' or ``6 oz Net wt.'' and ``6 fl oz'' 
or ``Net contents 6 fl oz''.
    (k) On packages containing 4 pounds or 1 gallon or more and labeled 
in terms of weight or fluid measure, the declaration shall be expressed 
in pounds for weight units with any remainder in terms of ounces or 
common

[[Page 144]]

or decimal fraction of the pound, or in the case of fluid measure, it 
shall be expressed in the largest whole unit (gallons followed by common 
or decimal fraction of a gallon or by the next smaller whole unit or 
units (quarts, or quarts and pints)) with any remainder in terms of 
fluid ounces or common or decimal fractions of the pint or quart (see 
paragraph (m)(6) of this section).
    (l) [Reserved]
    (m) Examples:
    (1) A declaration of 1\1/2\ pounds weight shall be expressed as 
``Net Wt. 24 oz (1 lb 8 oz),'' ``Net Wt. 24 oz (1\1/2\ lb),'' or ``Net 
Wt. 24 oz (1.5 lb)''.
    (2) A declaration of three-fourths pound avoirdupois weight shall be 
expressed as ``Net Wt. 12 oz''.
    (3) A declaration of 1 quart liquid measure shall be expressed as 
``Net 32 fl oz (1 qt)''.
    (4) A declaration of 1\3/4\ quarts liquid measure shall be expressed 
as ``Net contents 56 fluid ounces (1 quart 1\1/2\ pints)'' or as ``Net 
56 fluid oz (1 qt 1 pt 8 oz)'', but not in terms of quart and ounce such 
as ``Net 56 fluid oz (1 quart 24 ounces)''.
    (5) On a random package, declaration of three-fourths pound 
avoirdupois may be expressed as ``Net Wt. .75 lb''.
    (6) A declaration of 2\1/2\ gallons liquid measure shall be 
expressed as ``Net contents 2\1/2\ gallons,'' ``Net contents 2.5 
gallons,'' or ``Net contents 2 gallons 2 quarts'' and not as ``2 gallons 
4 pints''.
    (n) For quantities, the following abbreviations and none other may 
be employed (periods and plural forms are optional):

weight wt                             pint pt                           
ounce oz                              quart qt                          
pound lb                              fluid fl                          
gallon gal                                                              
                                                                        

    (o) Nothing in this section shall prohibit supplemental statements 
at locations other than the principal display panel(s) describing in 
nondeceptive terms the net quantity of contents; Provided, that such 
supplemental statements of net quantity of contents shall not include 
any term qualifying a unit of weight, measure, or count that tends to 
exaggerate the amount of the food contained in the package; for example, 
``jumbo quart'' and ``full gallon''. Dual or combination declarations of 
net quantity of contents as provided for in paragraphs (a), (c), and (j) 
of this section (for example, a combination of net weight plus numerical 
count, net contents plus dilution directions of a concentrate, etc.) are 
not regarded as supplemental net quantity statements and may be located 
on the principal display panel.
    (p) A separate statement of the net quantity of contents in terms of 
the metric system is not regarded as a supplemental statement and an 
accurate statement of the net quantity of contents in terms of the 
metric system of weight or measure may also appear on the principal 
display panel or on other panels.
    (q) The declaration of net quantity of contents shall express an 
accurate statement of the quantity of contents of the package. 
Reasonable variations caused by loss or gain of moisture during the 
course of good distribution practice or by unavoidable deviations in 
good manufacturing practice will be recognized. Variations from stated 
quantity of contents shall not be unreasonably large.
    (r) The declaration of net quantity of contents on pickles and 
pickle products, including relishes but excluding one or two whole 
pickles in clear plastic bags which may be declared by count, shall be 
expressed in terms of the U.S. gallon of 231 cubic inches and quart, 
pint, and fluid ounce subdivisions thereof.
    (s) On a multiunit retail package, a statement of the quantity of 
contents shall appear on the outside of the package and shall include 
the number of individual units, the quantity of each individual unit, 
and, in parentheses, the total quantity of contents of the multiunit 
package in terms of avoirdupois or fluid ounces, except that such 
declaration of total quantity need not be followed by an additional 
parenthetical declaration in terms of the largest whole units and 
subdivisions thereof, as required by paragraph (j)(1) of this section. A 
multiunit retail package may thus be properly labeled: ``6-16 oz 
bottles--(96 fl oz)'' or ``3-16 oz cans--(net wt. 48 oz)''. For the 
purposes of this section, ``multiunit retail package'' means a package 
containing two or more individually packaged units of the identical 
commodity and in the

[[Page 145]]

same quantity, intended to be sold as part of the multiunit retail 
package but capable of being individually sold in full compliance with 
all requirements of the regulations in this part. Open multiunit retail 
packages that do not obscure the number of units or prevent examination 
of the labeling on each of the individual units are not subject to this 
paragraph if the labeling of each individual unit complies with the 
requirements of paragraphs (f) and (i) of this section. The provisions 
of this section do not apply to that butter or margarine covered by the 
exemptions in Sec. 1.24(a) (10) and (11) of this chapter.
    (t) Where the declaration of net quantity of contents is in terms of 
net weight and/or drained weight or volume and does not accurately 
reflect the actual quantity of the contents or the product falls below 
the applicable standard of fill of container because of equipment 
malfunction or otherwise unintentional product variation, and the label 
conforms in all other respects to the requirements of this chapter 
(except the requirement that food falling below the applicable standard 
of fill of container shall bear the general statement of substandard 
fill specified in Sec. 130.14(b) of this chapter), the mislabeled food 
product, including any food product that fails to bear the general 
statement of substandard fill specified in Sec. 130.14(b) of this 
chapter, may be sold by the manufacturer or processor directly to 
institutions operated by Federal, State or local governments (schools, 
prisons, hospitals, etc.): Provided, That:
    (1) The purchaser shall sign a statement at the time of sale stating 
that he is aware that the product is mislabeled to include 
acknowledgment of the nature and extent of the mislabeling, (e.g., 
``Actual net weight may be as low as ----% below labeled quantity'') and 
that any subsequent distribution by him of said product except for his 
own institutional use is unlawful. This statement shall be kept on file 
at the principal place of business of the manufacturer or processor for 
2 years subsequent to the date of shipment of the product and shall be 
available to the Food and Drug Administration upon request.
    (2) The product shall be labeled on the outside of its shipping 
container with the statement(s):
    (i) When the variation concerns net weight and/or drained weight or 
volume, ``Product Mislabeled. Actual net weight (drained weight or 
volume where appropriate) may be as low as ----% below labeled quantity. 
This Product Not for Retail Distribution'', the blank to be filled in 
with the maximum percentage variance between the labeled and actual 
weight or volume of contents of the individual packages in the shipping 
container, and
    (ii) When the variation is in regard to a fill of container 
standard, ``Product Mislabeled. Actual fill may be as low as --% below 
standard of fill. This Product Not for Retail Distribution''.
    (3) The statements required by paragraphs (t)(2) (i) and (ii) of 
this section, which may be consolidated where appropriate, shall appear 
prominently and conspicuously as compared to other printed matter on the 
shipping container and in boldface print or type on a clear, contrasting 
background in order to render them likely to be read and understood by 
the purchaser under ordinary conditions of purchase.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 42 FR 15673, Mar. 22, 1977]



Sec. 101.108  Temporary exemptions for purposes of conducting authorized food labeling experiments.

    (a) The food industry is encouraged to experiment voluntarily, under 
controlled conditions and in collaboration with the Food and Drug 
Administration, with graphics and other formats for presenting nutrition 
and other related food labeling information that is consistent with the 
current quantitative system in Secs. 101.9 and 101.25 and with 
Secs. 105.66, 105.67, and 105.69 of this chapter.
    (b) Any firm that intends to undertake a labeling experiment that 
requires exemptions from certain requirements of Secs. 101.9 and 101.25 
and Secs. 105.66, 105.67, and 105.69 of this chapter should submit a 
written proposal containing a thorough discussion of each of the 
following information items that apply to the particular experiment:

[[Page 146]]

    (1) A description of the labeling format to be tested;
    (2) A statement of the criteria to be used in the experiment for 
assigning foods to categories, e.g., nutrient or other values defining 
``low'' and ``reduced'';
    (3) A draft of the material to be used in the store, e.g., shelf 
tags, booklets, posters, etc.;
    (4) The dates on which the experiment will begin and end and on 
which a written report of analysis of the experimental data will be 
submitted to FDA, together with a commitment not to continue the 
experiment beyond the proposed ending date without FDA approval;
    (5) The geographic area or areas in which the experiment is to be 
conducted;
    (6) The mechanism to measure the effectiveness of the experiment;
    (7) The method for conveying to consumers the required nutrition and 
other labeling information that is exempted from the label during the 
experiment;
    (8) The method that will be or has been used to determine the actual 
nutritional characteristics of foods for which a claim is made; and
    (9) A statement of the sections of the regulations for which an 
exemption is sought.
    (c) The written proposal should be sent to the Dockets Management 
Branch (HFA-305), Food and Drug Administration, rm. 1-23, 12420 Parklawn 
Dr., Rockville, MD 20857. The proposal should be clearly identified as a 
request for a temporary exemption for purposes of conducting authorized 
food labeling experiments and submitted as a citizen petition under 
Sec. 10.30 of this chapter.
    (d) Approval for food labeling experiments will be given by FDA in 
writing. Foods labeled in violation of existing regulations will be 
subject to regulatory action unless an FDA-approved exemption to the 
specific regulation has been granted for that specific product.
    (e) Reporting requirements contained in Sec. 101.108(b) have been 
approved by this Office of Management and Budget and assigned number 
0910-0151.

[48 FR 15240, Apr. 8, 1983, as amended at 59 FR 14364, Mar. 28, 1994]

 Appendix A to Part 101--Monier-Williams Procedure (With Modifications) 
for Sulfites in Food, Center for Food Safety and Applied Nutrition, Food 
                 and Drug Administration (November 1985)

    The AOAC official method for sulfites (Official Methods of Analysis, 
14th Edition, 20.123-20.125, Association of Official Analytical 
Chemists) has been modified, in FDA laboratories, to facilitate the 
determination of sulfites at or near 10 ppm in food. Method 
instructions, including modifications, are described below.
    Apparatus--The apparatus shown diagrammatically (Figure 1) is 
designed to accomplish the selective transfer of sulfur dioxide from the 
sample in boiling aqueous hydrochloric acid to a solution of 3% hydrogen 
peroxide. This apparatus is easier to assemble than the official 
apparatus and the back pressure inside the apparatus is limited to the 
unavoidable pressure due to the height of the 3% H2O2 solution 
above the tip of the bubbler (F). Keeping the backpressure as low as 
possible reduces the likelihood that sulfur dioxide will be lost through 
leaks.
    The apparatus should be assembled as shown in Fig. 1 with a thin 
film of stopcock grease on the sealing surfaces of all the joints except 
the joint between the separatory funnel and the flask. Each joint should 
be clamped together to ensure a complete seal throughout the analysis. 
The separatory funnel, B, should have a capacity of 100 ml or greater. 
An inlet adapter, A, with a hose connector (Kontes K-183000 or 
equivalent) is required to provide a means of applying a head of 
pressure above the solution. (A pressure equalizing dropping funnel is 
not recommended because condensate, perhaps with sulfur dioxide, is 
deposited in the funnel and the side arm.) The round bottom flask, C, is 
a 1000 ml flask with three 24/40 tapered joints. The gas inlet tube, D, 
(Kontes K-179000 or equivalent) should be of sufficient length to permit 
introduction of the nitrogen within 2.5 cm of the bottom of the flask. 
The Allihn condenser, E, (Kontes K-431000-2430 or equivalent) has a 
jacket length of 300 mm. The bubbler, F, was fabricated from glass 
according to the dimensions given in Fig. 2. The 3% hydrogen peroxide 
solution can be contained in a vessel, G, with an i.d. of ca. 2.5 cm and 
a depth of 18 cm.
    Buret--A 10 ml buret (Fisher Cat. No. 03-848-2A or equivalent) with 
overflow tube and hose connections for an Ascarite tube or equivalent 
air scrubbing apparatus. This will permit the maintenance of a carbon 
dioxide-free atmosphere over the standardized 0.01N sodium hydroxide.

[[Page 147]]

    Chilled Water Circulator--The condensor must be chilled with a 
coolant, such as 20% methanol-water, maintained at 5  deg.C. A 
circulating pump equivalent to the Neslab Coolflow 33 is suitable.

                                Reagents

    (a) Aqueous hydrochloric acid, 4N.--For each analysis prepare 90 ml 
of hydrochloric acid by adding 30 ml of concentrated hydrochloric acid 
(12N) to 60 ml of distilled water.
    (b) Methyl red indicator.--Dissolve 250 mg of methyl red in 100 ml 
ethanol.
    (c) Hydrogen peroxide solution, 3%--Dilute ACS reagent grade 30% 
hydrogen peroxide to 3% with distilled water. Just prior to use, add 
three drops of methyl red indicator and titrate to a yellow end-point 
using 0.01N sodium hydroxide. If the end-point is exceeded discard the 
solution and prepare another 3% H2O2 solution.
    (d) Standardized titrant, 0.01N NaOH--Certified reagent may be used 
(Fisher SO-5-284). It should be standardized with reference standard 
potassium hydrogen phthalate.
    (e) Nitrogen--A source of high purity nitrogen is required with a 
flow regulator that will maintain a flow of 200 cc per minute. To guard 
against the presence of oxygen in the nitrogen, an oxygen scrubbing 
solution such as an alkaline pyrogallol trap may be used. Prepare 
pyrogallol trap as follows:
    1. Add 4.5 g pyrogallol to the trap.
    2. Purge trap with nitrogen for 2 to 3 minutes.
    3. Prepare a KOH solution prepared by adding 65g KOH to 85 ml 
distilled water (caution: heat).
    4. Add the KOH solution to the trap while maintaining an atmosphere 
of nitrogen in the trap.

                              Determination

    Assemble the apparatus as shown in Fig. 1. The flask C must be 
positioned in a heating mantle that is controlled by a power regulating 
device such as Variac or equivalent. Add 400 ml of distilled water to 
flask C. Close the stopcock of separatory funnel, B, and add 90 ml of 4N 
hydrochloric acid to the separatory funnel. Begin the flow of nitrogen 
at a rate of 20010 cc/min. The condenser coolant flow must 
be initiated at this time. Add 30 ml of 3% hydrogen peroxide, which has 
been titrated to a yellow end-point with 0.01N NaOH, to container G. 
After fifteen minutes the apparatus and the distilled water will be 
thoroughly de-oxygenated and the apparatus is ready for sample 
introduction.
    Sample preparation (solids)--Transfer 50 g of food, or a quantity of 
food with a convenient quantity of SO2 (500 to 1500 mcg SO2), 
to a food processor or blender. Add 100 ml of 5% ethanol in water and 
briefly grind the mixture. Grinding or blending should be continued only 
until the food is chopped into pieces small enough to pass through the 
24/40 point of flask C.
    Sample preparation (liquids)--Mix 50 g of the sample, or a quantity 
with a convenient quantity of SO2 (500 to 1500 mcg SO2), with 
100 ml of 5% ethanol in water.
    Sample introduction and distillation--Remove the separatory funnel 
B, and quantitatively transfer the food sample in aqueous ethanol to 
flask C. Wipe the tapered joint clean with a laboratory tissue, apply 
stopcock grease to the outer joint of the separatory funnel, and return 
the separatory funnel, B, to tapered joint flask C. The nitrogen flow 
through the 3% hydrogen peroxide solution should resume as soon as the 
funnel, B, is re-inserted into the appropriate joint in flask C. Examine 
each joint to ensure that it is sealed.
    Apply a head pressure above the hydrochloric acid solution in B with 
a rubber bulb equipped with a valve. Open the stopcock in B and permit 
the hydrochloric acid solution to flow into flask C. Continue to 
maintain sufficient pressure above the acid solution to force the 
solution into the flask C. The stopcock may be closed, if necessary, to 
pump up the pressure above the acid and then opened again. Close the 
stopcock before the last few milliliters drain out of the separatory 
funnel, B, to guard against the escape of sulfur dioxide into the 
separatory funnel.
    Apply the power to the heating mantle. Use a power setting which 
will cause 80 to 90 drops per minute of condensate to return to the 
flask from condenser, E. After 1.75 hours of boiling the contents of the 
1000 ml flask and remove trap G.
    Titration--Titrate the contents with 0.01N sodium hydroxide. Titrate 
with 0.01N NaOH to a yellow end-point that persists for at least twenty 
seconds. Compute the sulfite content, expressed as micrograms sulfur 
dioxide per gram of food (ppm) as follows:

ppm=(32.03xVBxNx1000)Wt

where 32.03=milliequivalent weight of sulfur dioxide; VB=volume of 
sodium hydroxide titrant of normality, N, required to reach endpoint; 
the factor, 1000, converts milliequivalents to microequivalents and 
Wt=weight (g) of food sample introduced into the 1000 ml flask.

[[Page 148]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.362


    Figure 1. The optimized Monier-Williams apparatus. Component 
identification is given in text.

[[Page 149]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.363


    Figure 2. Diagram of bubbler (F in Figure 1). Lengths are given in 
mm.

[42 FR 14308, Mar. 15, 1977, as amended at 51 FR 25017, July 9, 1986]

[[Page 150]]

      Appendix B to Part 101--Graphic Enhancements Used by the FDA

[[Page 150]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.364



[[Page 151]]

[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TR01JA93.365


[58 FR 17332, Apr. 2, 1993]

[[Page 152]]